71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Energy Meter ICs GENERAL DESCRIPTION BENEFITS AND FEATURES The 71M6541D/71M6541F/71M6541G/71M6542F/71M6542G (71M654x) are * 4th-generation single-phase metering SoCs with a 5MHz 8051compatible MPU core, low-power RTC with digital temperature compensation, flash memory, and LCD driver. Our Single Converter Technology(R) with a 22-bit delta-sigma ADC, three or four analog inputs, digital temperature compensation, precision voltage reference, and a 32-bit computation engine (CE) supports a wide range of metering applications with very few external components. The 71M6541/2 devices support optional interfaces to the 71M6x01 series of isolated sensors, which offer BOM cost reduction, immunity to magnetic tamper, and enhanced reliability. Other features include an SPI interface, advanced power management, ultra-low-power operation in active and battery modes, 3/5KB shared RAM and 32/64/128KB of flash memory that can be programmed in the field with code and/or data during meter operation and the ability to drive up to six LCD segments per SEG driver pin. High processing and sampling rates combined with differential inputs offer a powerful metering platform for residential meters. A complete array of code development tools, demonstration code, and reference designs enable rapid development and certification of meters that meet all ANSI and IEC electricity metering standards worldwide. The 71M654x family operates over the industrial temperature range and comes in 64-pin (71M6541D/F/G) and 100-pin (71M6542F/G) lead(Pb)-free LQFP packages. NEUTRAL Shunt * LOAD Note: This system is referenced to LINE Shunt LINE SoC Integration and Unique Isolation Technique Reduces BOM Cost Without Sacrificing Performance * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 0.1% Typical Accuracy Over 2000:1 Current Range Exceeds IEC 62053/ANSI C12.20 Standards Four-Quadrant Metering 46-64Hz Line Frequency Range with the Same Calibration Phase Compensation (10) Independent 32-Bit Compute Engine 32KB Flash, 3KB RAM (71M6541D) 64KB Flash, 5KB RAM (71M6541F/42F) 128KB Flash, 5KB RAM (71M6541G/42G) Built-In Flash Security SPI interface for Flash Program Capability Up to Four Pulse Outputs with Pulse Count 8-Bit MPU (80515), Up to 5 MIPS Full-Speed MPU Clock in Brownout Mode LCD Driver Allows Up to 6 Commons/Up to 56 Pins 5V LCD Driver with DAC * Up to 51 Multifunction DIO Pins * Hardware Watchdog Timer (WDT) * Two UARTs for IR and AMR * IR LED Driver with Modulation Innovative Isolation Technology (Requires Companion 71M6xxx Sensor, also from Maxim Integrated) Eliminates Current Transformers Two Current Sensor Inputs with Selectable Differential Mode * Selectable Gain of 1 or 8 for One Current Input to Support Shunts * High-Speed Wh/VARh Pulse Outputs with Programmable Width Digital Temperature Compensation Improves System Performance * NEUTRAL POWER SUPPLY LINE Resistor Divider LINE 71M6xx1 MUX and ADC V3P3A V3P3SYS GNDA GNDD PWR MODE CONTROL IAP IAN Pulse Transformer 71M6541D/F/G * WAKE-UP REGULATOR BATTERY VBAT VA IBP IBN TEMPERATURE SENSOR VREF SERIAL PORTS AMR IR TX RX MODUL- RX ATOR TX POWER FAULT COMPARATOR HOST RAM COMPUTE ENGINE FLASH MEMORY MPU RTC TIMERS VBAT_RTC BATTERY MONITOR COM0...5 SEG SEG/DIO LCD DRIVER DIO, PULSES DIO LCD DISPLAY 8888.8888 PULSES, DIO Metrology Compensation Accurate RTC for TOU Functions with Automatic Temperature Compensation for Crystal in All Power Modes Power Management Extends Battery Life During Power Outages * * RTC BATTERY * * 2 V3P3D OSCILLATOR/ PLL XIN I C or Wire EEPROM 32 kHz SPI INTERFACE ICE XOUT * 11/5/2010 * Three Battery-Backup Modes: o Brownout Mode (BRN) o LCD Mode (LCD) o Sleep Mode (SLP) Wake-Up on Pin Events and Wake-On Timer 1A in Sleep Mode Single Converter Technology is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated Products, Inc. For pricing, delivery, and ordering information, please contact Maxim Direct at 1-888-629-4642, or visit Maxim Integrated's website at www.maximintegrated.com. 19-5376; Rev 5; 1/15 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table of Contents 1 2 3 2 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................... 10 Hardware Description ....................................................................................................................... 11 2.1 Hardware Overview ................................................................................................................... 11 2.2 Analog Front End (AFE)............................................................................................................. 12 2.2.1 Signal Input Pins ............................................................................................................ 14 2.2.2 Input Multiplexer............................................................................................................. 15 2.2.3 Delay Compensation ..................................................................................................... 19 2.2.4 ADC Pre-Amplifier ......................................................................................................... 20 2.2.5 A/D Converter (ADC) ..................................................................................................... 20 2.2.6 FIR Filter ........................................................................................................................ 20 2.2.7 Voltage References ....................................................................................................... 20 2.2.8 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface (Remote Sensor Interface) ................................... 22 2.3 Digital Computation Engine (CE) ............................................................................................... 24 2.3.1 CE Program Memory ..................................................................................................... 24 2.3.2 CE Data Memory ........................................................................................................... 24 2.3.3 CE Communication with the MPU ................................................................................. 25 2.3.4 Meter Equations ............................................................................................................. 25 2.3.5 Real-Time Monitor (RTM) .............................................................................................. 25 2.3.6 Pulse Generators ........................................................................................................... 27 2.3.7 CE Functional Overview ................................................................................................ 28 2.4 80515 MPU Core ....................................................................................................................... 31 2.4.1 Memory Organization and Addressing .......................................................................... 31 2.4.2 Special Function Registers (SFRs)................................................................................ 33 2.4.3 Generic 80515 Special Function Registers ................................................................... 34 2.4.4 Instruction Set ................................................................................................................ 37 2.4.5 UARTs ........................................................................................................................... 37 2.4.6 Timers and Counters ..................................................................................................... 39 2.4.7 WD Timer (Software Watchdog Timer) ......................................................................... 41 2.4.8 Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 41 2.5 On-Chip Resources ................................................................................................................... 48 2.5.1 Physical Memory............................................................................................................ 48 2.5.2 Oscillator ........................................................................................................................ 50 2.5.3 PLL and Internal Clocks................................................................................................. 50 2.5.4 Real-Time Clock (RTC) ................................................................................................. 51 2.5.5 71M654x Temperature Sensor ...................................................................................... 56 2.5.6 71M654x Battery Monitor ............................................................................................... 57 2.5.7 UART and Optical Interface ........................................................................................... 58 2.5.8 Digital I/O and LCD Segment Drivers ............................................................................ 59 2.5.9 EEPROM Interface ........................................................................................................ 70 2.5.10 SPI Slave Port................................................................................................................ 73 2.5.11 Hardware Watchdog Timer ............................................................................................ 78 2.5.12 Test Ports (TMUXOUT and TMUX2OUT Pins) ............................................................. 78 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................... 80 3.1 Theory of Operation ................................................................................................................... 80 3.2 Battery Modes ............................................................................................................................ 81 3.2.1 BRN Mode ..................................................................................................................... 83 3.2.2 LCD Mode ...................................................................................................................... 83 3.2.3 SLP Mode ...................................................................................................................... 84 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.3 4 5 Fault and Reset Behavior .......................................................................................................... 85 3.3.1 Events at Power-Down .................................................................................................. 85 3.3.2 IC Behavior at Low Battery Voltage ............................................................................... 86 3.3.3 Reset Sequence ............................................................................................................ 86 3.3.4 Watchdog Timer Reset .................................................................................................. 86 3.4 Wake Up Behavior ..................................................................................................................... 87 3.4.1 Wake on Hardware Events ............................................................................................ 87 3.4.2 Wake on Timer............................................................................................................... 90 3.5 Data Flow and MPU/CE Communication ................................................................................... 91 Application Information .................................................................................................................... 92 4.1 Connecting 5 V Devices............................................................................................................. 92 4.2 Direct Connection of Sensors .................................................................................................... 92 4.3 71M6541D/F/G Using Local Sensors ........................................................................................ 93 4.4 71M6541D/F/G Using 71M6x01and Current Shunts ................................................................. 94 4.5 71M6542F/G Using Local Sensors ............................................................................................ 95 4.6 71M6542F/G Using 71M6x01 and Current Shunts ................................................................... 96 4.7 Metrology Temperature Compensation ..................................................................................... 97 4.7.1 Voltage Reference Precision ......................................................................................... 97 4.7.2 Temperature Coefficients for the 71M654x ................................................................... 97 4.7.3 Temperature Compensation for VREF with Local Sensors ........................................... 98 4.7.4 Temperature Compensation for VREF with Remote Sensor ........................................ 99 2 4.8 Connecting I C EEPROMs ...................................................................................................... 100 4.9 Connecting Three-Wire EEPROMs ......................................................................................... 101 4.10 UART0 (TX/RX) ....................................................................................................................... 101 4.11 Optical Interface (UART1)........................................................................................................ 101 4.12 Connecting the Reset Pin ........................................................................................................ 102 4.13 Connecting the Emulator Port Pins .......................................................................................... 103 4.14 Flash Programming.................................................................................................................. 104 4.14.1 Flash Programming via the ICE Port ........................................................................... 104 4.14.2 Flash Programming via the SPI Port ........................................................................... 104 4.15 MPU Firmware Library ............................................................................................................. 104 4.16 Crystal Oscillator ...................................................................................................................... 104 4.17 Meter Calibration ...................................................................................................................... 104 Firmware Interface .......................................................................................................................... 105 5.1 I/O RAM Map -Functional Order ............................................................................................. 105 5.2 I/O RAM Map - Alphabetical Order ......................................................................................... 111 5.3 CE Interface Description .......................................................................................................... 126 5.3.1 CE Program ................................................................................................................. 126 5.3.2 CE Data Format ........................................................................................................... 126 5.3.3 Constants ..................................................................................................................... 126 5.3.4 Environment ................................................................................................................. 127 5.3.5 CE Calculations ........................................................................................................... 127 5.3.6 CE Front End Data (Raw Data) ................................................................................... 128 5.3.7 FCE Status and Control ............................................................................................... 128 5.3.8 CE Transfer Variables ................................................................................................. 131 5.3.9 Pulse Generation ......................................................................................................... 133 5.3.10 Other CE Parameters .................................................................................................. 135 5.3.11 CE Calibration Parameters .......................................................................................... 136 5.3.12 CE Flow Diagrams ....................................................................................................... 137 Rev 5 3 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6 Electrical Specifications................................................................................................................. 139 6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ..................................................................................................... 139 6.2 Recommended External Components ..................................................................................... 140 6.3 Recommended Operating Conditions ...................................................................................... 140 6.4 Performance Specifications ..................................................................................................... 141 6.4.1 Input Logic Levels ........................................................................................................ 141 6.4.2 Output Logic Levels ..................................................................................................... 141 6.4.3 Battery Monitor............................................................................................................. 142 6.4.4 Temperature Monitor ................................................................................................... 142 6.4.5 Supply Current ............................................................................................................. 143 6.4.6 V3P3D Switch .............................................................................................................. 144 6.4.7 Internal Power Fault Comparators ............................................................................... 144 6.4.8 2.5 V Voltage Regulator - System Power ................................................................... 144 6.4.9 2.5 V Voltage Regulator - Battery Power .................................................................... 145 6.4.10 Crystal Oscillator .......................................................................................................... 145 6.4.11 Phase-Locked Loop (PLL) ........................................................................................... 145 6.4.12 LCD Drivers ................................................................................................................. 146 6.4.13 VLCD Generator .......................................................................................................... 147 6.4.14 VREF ........................................................................................................................... 149 6.4.15 ADC Converter............................................................................................................. 150 6.4.16 Pre-Amplifier for IAP-IAN ............................................................................................. 151 6.5 Timing Specifications ............................................................................................................... 152 6.5.1 Flash Memory .............................................................................................................. 152 6.5.2 SPI Slave ..................................................................................................................... 152 6.5.3 EEPROM Interface ...................................................................................................... 152 6.5.4 RESET Pin ................................................................................................................... 153 6.5.5 RTC.............................................................................................................................. 153 6.6 Package Outline Drawings....................................................................................................... 154 6.6.1 64-Pin LQFP Outline Package Drawing ...................................................................... 154 6.6.2 100-Pin LQFP Package Outline Drawing .................................................................... 155 6.7 Package Markings ................................................................................................................... 156 6.8 Pinout Diagrams ...................................................................................................................... 157 6.8.1 71M6541D/F/G LQFP-64 Package Pinout .................................................................. 157 6.8.2 71M6542F/G LQFP-100 Package Pinout .................................................................... 158 6.9 Pin Descriptions ....................................................................................................................... 159 6.9.1 Power and Ground Pins ............................................................................................... 159 6.9.2 Analog Pins .................................................................................................................. 160 6.9.3 Digital Pins ................................................................................................................... 161 6.9.4 I/O Equivalent Circuits ................................................................................................. 163 7 Ordering Information ...................................................................................................................... 164 7.1 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G ........................................................................................... 164 8 Related Information ........................................................................................................................ 164 9 Contact Information ........................................................................................................................ 164 Appendix A: Acronyms .......................................................................................................................... 165 Appendix B: Revision History................................................................................................................ 166 4 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Figures Figure 1: IC Functional Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... 9 Figure 2. 71M6541D/F/G AFE Block Diagram (Local Sensors) ................................................................. 12 Figure 3. 71M6541D/F/G AFE Block Diagram with 71M6x01 .................................................................... 13 Figure 4. 71M6542F/G AFE Block Diagram (Local Sensors) ..................................................................... 13 Figure 5. 71M6542F/G AFE Block Diagram with 71M6x01 ........................................................................ 14 Figure 6: States in a Multiplexer Frame (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3) ..................................................................... 17 Figure 7: States in a Multiplexer Frame (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4) ..................................................................... 17 Figure 8: General Topology of a Chopped Amplifier .................................................................................. 21 Figure 9: CROSS Signal with CHOP_E = 00 ............................................................................................... 21 Figure 10: RTM Timing ............................................................................................................................... 26 Figure 11: Timing Relationship Between ADC MUX, CE, and RTM Serial Transfer .................................. 26 Figure 12. Pulse Generator FIFO Timing.................................................................................................... 28 Figure 13: Accumulation Interval ................................................................................................................ 29 Figure 14: Samples from Multiplexer Cycle (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3) ............................................................... 30 Figure 15: Samples from Multiplexer Cycle (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4) ............................................................... 30 Figure 16: Interrupt Structure ...................................................................................................................... 47 Figure 17: Automatic Temperature Compensation ..................................................................................... 54 Figure 18: Optical Interface ......................................................................................................................... 58 Figure 19: Optical Interface (UART1) ......................................................................................................... 59 Figure 20: Connecting an External Load to DIO Pins ................................................................................. 60 Figure 21: LCD Waveforms......................................................................................................................... 68 Figure 22: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command, HiZ=0. ............................................................................... 72 Figure 23: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command, HiZ=1 ................................................................................ 72 Figure 24: 3-Wire Interface. Read Command. ........................................................................................... 72 Figure 25: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command when CNT=0 ...................................................................... 73 Figure 26: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command when HiZ=1 and WFR=1. .................................................. 73 Figure 27: SPI Slave Port - Typical Multi-Byte Read and Write Operations ............................................... 75 Figure 28: Voltage, Current, Momentary and Accumulated Energy ........................................................... 80 Figure 29: Operation Modes State Diagram ............................................................................................... 81 Figure 30: MPU/CE Data Flow .................................................................................................................... 91 Figure 31: Resistive Voltage Divider (Voltage Sensing) ............................................................................. 92 Figure 32. CT with Single-Ended Input Connection (Current Sensing) ...................................................... 92 Figure 33: CT with Differential Input Connection (Current Sensing) .......................................................... 92 Figure 34: Differential Resistive Shunt Connections (Current Sensing) ..................................................... 92 Figure 35. 71M6541D/F/G with Local Sensors ........................................................................................... 93 Figure 36: 71M6541D/F/G with 71M6x01 isolated Sensor ......................................................................... 94 Figure 37: 71M6542F/G with Local Sensors............................................................................................... 95 Figure 38: 71M6542F/G with 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor ............................................................................ 96 2 Figure 39: I C EEPROM Connection ........................................................................................................ 100 Figure 40: Connections for UART0 ........................................................................................................... 101 Figure 41: Connection for Optical Components ........................................................................................ 102 Figure 42: External Components for the RESET Pin: Push-Button (Left), Production Circuit (Right) ......... 102 Figure 43: External Components for the Emulator Interface .................................................................... 103 Figure 44: CE Data Flow: Multiplexer and ADC........................................................................................ 137 Figure 45: CE Data Flow: Scaling, Gain Control, Intermediate Variables ................................................ 137 Figure 46: CE Data Flow: Squaring and Summation Stages .................................................................... 138 Figure 47: 64-pin LQFP Package Outline ................................................................................................. 154 Figure 48: 100-pin LQFP Package Outline ............................................................................................... 155 Figure 49. Package Markings (Examples) ................................................................................................ 156 Figure 50: Pinout for the 71M6541D/F/G (LQFP-64 Package)................................................................. 157 Figure 51: Pinout for the 71M6542F/G (LQFP-100 Package) .................................................................. 158 Figure 52: I/O Equivalent Circuits ............................................................................................................. 163 Rev 5 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Tables Table 1. Required CE Code and Settings for Local Sensors...................................................................... 15 Table 2. Required CE Code and Settings for 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor ................................................... 16 Table 3: ADC Input Configuration .............................................................................................................. 17 Table 4: Multiplexer and ADC Configuration Bits....................................................................................... 19 Table 5. RCMD[4:0] Bits ............................................................................................................................. 23 Table 6: Remote Interface Read Commands ............................................................................................ 23 Table 7: I/O RAM Control Bits for Isolated Sensor .................................................................................... 23 Table 8: Inputs Selected in Multiplexer Cycles ........................................................................................... 25 Table 9: CKMPU Clock Frequencies .......................................................................................................... 31 Table 10: Memory Map ............................................................................................................................... 32 Table 11: Internal Data Memory Map ......................................................................................................... 33 Table 12: Special Function Register Map ................................................................................................... 33 Table 13: Generic 80515 SFRs - Location and Reset Values .................................................................... 34 Table 14: PSW Bit Functions (SFR 0xD0) ..................................................................................................... 35 Table 15: Port Registers (SEGDIO0-15) ..................................................................................................... 36 Table 16: Stretch Memory Cycle Width ...................................................................................................... 36 Table 17: Baud Rate Generation ................................................................................................................ 37 Table 18: UART Modes ............................................................................................................................... 37 Table 19: The S0CON (UART0) Register (SFR 0x98) ................................................................................. 38 Table 20: The S1CON (UART1) Register (SFR 0x9B) ................................................................................ 39 Table 21: PCON Register Bit Description (SFR 0x87) ............................................................................... 39 Table 22: Timers/Counters Mode Description ............................................................................................ 40 Table 23: Allowed Timer/Counter Mode Combinations .............................................................................. 40 Table 24: TMOD Register Bit Description (SFR 0x89) ................................................................................ 40 Table 25: The TCON Register Bit Functions (SFR 0x88) ............................................................................ 41 Table 26: The IEN0 Bit Functions (SFR 0xA8)............................................................................................ 42 Table 27: The IEN1 Bit Functions (SFR 0xB8)............................................................................................ 42 Table 28: The IEN2 Bit Functions (SFR 0x9A)............................................................................................ 42 Table 29: TCON Bit Functions (SFR 0x88) ................................................................................................. 42 Table 30: The T2CON Bit Functions (SFR 0xC8) ....................................................................................... 43 Table 31: The IRCON Bit Functions (SFR 0xC0) ........................................................................................ 43 Table 32: External MPU Interrupts .............................................................................................................. 44 Table 33: Interrupt Enable and Flag Bits ................................................................................................... 45 Table 34: Interrupt Priority Level Groups .................................................................................................... 45 Table 35: Interrupt Priority Levels ............................................................................................................... 45 Table 36: Interrupt Priority Registers (IP0 and IP1) .................................................................................... 46 Table 37: Interrupt Polling Sequence .......................................................................................................... 46 Table 38: Interrupt Vectors.......................................................................................................................... 46 Table 39: Flash Memory Access ................................................................................................................. 48 Table 40: Flash Security ............................................................................................................................. 49 Table 41: Clock System Summary.............................................................................................................. 51 Table 42: RTC Control Registers ................................................................................................................ 52 Table 43: I/O RAM Registers for RTC Temperature Compensation .......................................................... 53 Table 44: NV RAM Temperature Table Structure ....................................................................................... 54 Table 45: I/O RAM Registers for RTC Interrupts ........................................................................................ 55 Table 46: I/O RAM Registers for Temperature and Battery Measurement ................................................ 56 Table 47: Selectable Resources using the DIO_Rn[2:0] Bits ..................................................................... 60 Table 48: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO14 (71M6541D/F/G) ................................... 61 Table 49: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO19 to SEGDIO27 (71M6541D/F/G) ................................. 62 Table 50: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO36-39 to SEGDIO44-45 (71M6541D/F/G) ....................... 62 Table 51: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO51 and SEGDIO55 (71M6541D/F/G) .............................. 62 Table 52: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO15 (71M6542F/G) ....................................... 63 6 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 53: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO16 to SEGDIO31 (71M6542F/G) ..................................... 64 Table 54: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO32 to SEGDIO45 (71M6542F/G) ..................................... 64 Table 55: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO51 to SEGDIO55 (71M6542F/G) ..................................... 64 Table 56: LCD_VMODE[1:0] Configurations .............................................................................................. 65 Table 57: LCD Configurations .................................................................................................................... 67 Table 58: 71M6541D/F/G LCD Data Registers for SEG46 to SEG50 ........................................................ 69 Table 59: 71M6542F/G LCD Data Registers for SEG46 to SEG50 ........................................................... 70 Table 60: EECTRL Bits for 2-pin Interface ................................................................................................... 71 Table 61: EECTRL Bits for the 3-Wire Interface .......................................................................................... 71 Table 62: SPI Transaction Fields ................................................................................................................ 74 Table 63: SPI Command Sequences .......................................................................................................... 75 Table 64: SPI Registers .............................................................................................................................. 76 Table 65: TMUX[5:0] Selections ................................................................................................................. 79 Table 66: TMUX2[4:0] Selections ............................................................................................................... 79 Table 67: Available Circuit Functions .......................................................................................................... 82 Table 68: VSTAT[2:0] (SFR 0xF9[2:0]) ......................................................................................................... 85 Table 69: Wake Enables and Flag Bits ....................................................................................................... 88 Table 70: Wake Bits .................................................................................................................................... 89 Table 71: Clear Events for WAKE flags ...................................................................................................... 90 Table 72: GAIN_ADJn Compensation Channels ........................................................................................ 98 Table 73: GAIN_ADJn Compensation Channels ...................................................................................... 100 Table 74: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order, Basic Configuration ............................................................ 105 Table 75: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order ............................................................................................. 107 Table 76: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order ............................................................................................. 111 Table 77. Standard CE Codes .................................................................................................................. 126 Table 78: CE EQU Equations and Element Input Mapping ...................................................................... 127 Table 79: CE Raw Data Access Locations ............................................................................................... 128 Table 80: CESTATUS Register ................................................................................................................... 128 Table 81: CESTATUS (CE RAM 0x80) Bit Definitions .................................................................................. 129 Table 82: CECONFIG Register .................................................................................................................. 129 Table 83: CECONFIG (CE RAM 0x20) Bit Definitions ................................................................................. 129 Table 84: Sag Threshold and Gain Adjust Control ................................................................................... 130 Table 85: CE Transfer Variables (with Local Sensors) ............................................................................. 131 Table 86: CE Transfer Variables (with Remote Sensor) ........................................................................... 131 Table 87: CE Energy Measurement Variables (with Local Sensors) ........................................................ 132 Table 88: CE Energy Measurement Variables (with Remote Sensor) ..................................................... 132 Table 89: Other Transfer Variables ........................................................................................................... 133 Table 90: CE Pulse Generation Parameters............................................................................................. 134 Table 91: CE Parameters for Noise Suppression and Code Version ....................................................... 135 Table 92: CE Calibration Parameters ....................................................................................................... 136 Table 93: Absolute Maximum Ratings ...................................................................................................... 139 Table 94: Recommended External Components ...................................................................................... 140 Table 95: Recommended Operating Conditions ....................................................................................... 140 Table 96: Input Logic Levels ..................................................................................................................... 141 Table 97: Output Logic Levels .................................................................................................................. 141 Table 98: Battery Monitor Performance Specifications (TEMP_BAT= 1) .................................................. 142 Table 99. Temperature Monitor ................................................................................................................ 142 Table 100: Supply Current Performance Specifications ........................................................................... 143 Table 101: V3P3D Switch Performance Specifications ............................................................................ 144 Table 102. Internal Power Fault Comparator Specifications .................................................................... 144 Table 103: 2.5 V Voltage Regulator Performance Specifications ............................................................. 144 Table 104: Low-Power Voltage Regulator Performance Specifications ................................................... 145 Table 105: Crystal Oscillator Performance Specifications ........................................................................ 145 Rev 5 7 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 106: PLL Performance Specifications ............................................................................................. 145 Table 107: LCD Driver Performance Specifications ................................................................................. 146 1 Table 108: LCD Driver Performance Specifications ................................................................................ 147 Table 109: VREF Performance Specifications.......................................................................................... 149 Table 110. ADC Converter Performance Specifications ........................................................................... 150 Table 111: Pre-Amplifier Performance Specifications .............................................................................. 151 Table 112: Flash Memory Timing Specifications ...................................................................................... 152 Table 113. SPI Slave Timing Specifications ............................................................................................. 152 Table 114: EEPROM Interface Timing ...................................................................................................... 152 Table 115: RESET Pin Timing .................................................................................................................. 153 Table 116: RTC Range for Date ............................................................................................................... 153 Table 117. 71M6541 Package Markings .................................................................................................. 156 Table 118. 71M6542 Package Markings .................................................................................................. 156 Table 119: Power and Ground Pins .......................................................................................................... 159 Table 120: Analog Pins ............................................................................................................................. 160 Table 121: Digital Pins .............................................................................................................................. 161 Table 122. Ordering Information ............................................................................................................... 164 8 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet VREF IAP IAN IBP IBN V3P3A GNDA GNDD V3P3SYS VLCD DS AD CONVERTER VBIAS MUX and PREAMP VBIAS VLCD Voltage Boost FIR V3P3A - V3P3D + VREF VA VB* VREF VBAT MUX MUX CTRL CROSS Voltage Regulator CK32 XIN XOUT MCK PLL RTCLK (32KHz) Oscillator CK32 32KHz 32 KHz DIV ADC 4.9 MHZ CKADC VDD 4.9 MHz CKFIR 22 2.5V to logic CLOCK GEN CK_4X MUX LCD_GEN CKMPU_2x WPULSE STRT VARPULSE CKCE < 4.9MHz LCD DRIVER RTM 32-bit Compute Engine TEST MODE CEDATA 32 0x000...0x2FF CE CONTROL 0x0000...0x13FF COM0..5 6 SPI TEST VLC2 VLC1 VLC0 MEMORY SHARE MPU RAM 3/5 KB CE MUX_SYNC SEG Pins 8 PROG 0x000...0x3FF SEGDIO Pins DIGITAL I/O 16 EEPROM INTERFACE CKMPU 2 VARPULSE I/O RAM CE_BUSY XFER BUSY WPULSE PB VBAT_RTC RTC < 4.9MHz RTCLK SDCK RX MPU (80515) UART0 SDOUT Non-Volatile CONFIGURATION RAM SDIN TX OPT_RX/ SEGDIO55 OPTICAL INTERFACE CONFIGURATION RAM (I/O RAM) DATA 0x0000...0xFFFF 0x2000...0x20FF 8 OPT_TX/ SEGDIO51/ WPULSE/ VARPULSE PROGRAM 0x0000...0xFFFF VBIAS 8 MEMORY SHARE 0x0000... 0xFFFF MPU_RSTZ CKMPU_2x 16 CONFIGURATION PARAMETERS EMULATOR PORT WAKE RTM FAULTZ 3 VSTAT * 71M6542F/G only TEMP SENSOR FLASH 32/64/128 KB 8 POWER FAULT DETECTION RESET E_RXTX/SEG48 E_TCLK/SEG49 E_RST/SEG50 BAT TEST TEST MUX TEST MUX 2 E_RXTX E_TCLK E_RST ICE_E 10/11/2011 Figure 1: IC Functional Block Diagram Rev 5 9 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 1 Introduction This data sheet covers the 71M6541D (32KB), 71M6541F (64KB), 71M6541G (128KB), 71M6542F (64KB), and 71M6542G (128KB) fourth-generation energy measurement SoCs. The term "71M654x" is used when discussing a device feature or behavior that is applicable to all four part numbers. The appropriate part number is indicated when a device feature or behavior is being discussed that applies only to a specific part number. This data sheet also covers basic details about the companion 71M6x01 isolated current sensor device. For more complete information on the 71M6x01 sensors, refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet. This document covers the use of the 71M654x with locally connected sensors as well when it is used in conjunction with the 71M6x01 isolated current sensor. The 71M654x and 71M6x01 chipset make it possible to use one non-isolated and one isolated shunt current sensor to create single-phase and twophase energy meters using inexpensive shunt resistors, while achieving unprecedented performance with this type of sensor technology. The 71M654x SoCs also support configurations involving one locally connected shunt and one locally connected Current Transformer (CT), or two CTs. To facilitate document navigation, hyperlinks are often used to reference figures, tables and section headings that are located in other parts of the document. All hyperlinks in this document are highlighted in blue. Hyperlinks are used extensively to increase the level of detail and clarity provided within each section by referencing other relevant parts of the document. To further facilitate document navigation, this document is published as a PDF document with bookmarks enabled. The reader is also encouraged to obtain and review the documents listed in 8 Related Information on page 164 of this document. 10 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2 Hardware Description 2.1 Hardware Overview The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G single-chip energy meter ICs integrate all primary functional blocks required to implement a solid-state residential electricity meter. Included on the chip are: * * * * * * * * * * * * * An analog front end (AFE) featuring a 22-bit second-order sigma-delta ADC An independent 32-bit digital computation engine (CE) to implement DSP functions An 8051-compatible microprocessor (MPU) which executes one instruction per clock cycle (80515) A precision voltage reference (VREF) A temperature sensor for digital temperature compensation: - Metrology digital temperature compensation (MPU) - Automatic RTC digital temperature compensation operational in all power states LCD drivers RAM and Flash memory A real time clock (RTC) A variety of I/O pins A power failure interrupt A zero-crossing interrupt Selectable current sensor interfaces for locally-connected sensors as well as isolated sensors (i.e., using the 71M6x01 companion IC with a shunt resistor sensor) Resistive Shunt and Current Transformers are supported Resistive Shunts and Current Transformers (CT) current sensors are supported. Resistive shunt current sensors may be connected directly to the 71M654x device or isolated using a companion 71M6x01 isolator IC in order to implement a variety of single-phase / split-phase (71M6541D/F) or two-phase (71M6542F/G) metering configurations. An inexpensive, small size pulse transformer is used to isolate the 71M6x01 isolated sensor from the 71M654x. The 71M654x performs digital communications bidirectionally with the 71M6x01 and also provides power to the 71M6x01 through the isolating pulse transformer. Isolated (remote) shunt current sensors are connected to the differential input of the 71M6x01. Included on the 71M6x01 companion isolator chip are: * * * * * * * Digital isolation communications interface An analog front end (AFE) A precision voltage reference (VREF) A temperature sensor (for digital temperature compensation) A fully differential shunt resistor sensor input A pre-amplifier to optimize shunt current sensor performance Isolated power circuitry obtains dc power from pulses sent by the 71M654x In a typical application, the 32-bit compute engine (CE) of the 71M654x sequentially processes the samples from the voltage inputs on analog input pins and from the external 71M6x01 isolated sensors and performs 2 2 calculations to measure active energy (Wh) and reactive energy (VARh), as well as A h, and V h for fourquadrant metering. These measurements are then accessed by the MPU, processed further and output using the peripheral devices available to the MPU. In addition to advanced measurement functions, the clock function allows the 71M6541D/F and 71M6542F/G to record time-of-use (TOU) metering information for multi-rate applications and to timestamp tamper or other events. Measurements can be displayed on 3.3 V LCDs commonly used in low-temperature environments. An on-chip charge pump is available to drive 5 V LCDs. Flexible mapping of LCD display segments facilitate integration of existing custom LCDs. Design trade-off between the number of LCD segments and DIO pins can be implemented in software to accommodate various requirements. In addition to the temperature-trimmed ultra-precision voltage reference, the on-chip digital temperature compensation mechanism includes a temperature sensor and associated controls for correction of unwanted temperature effects on measurement and RTC accuracy, e.g., to meet the requirements of ANSI and IEC standards. Temperature-dependent external components such as crystal oscillator, resistive shunts, current Rev 5 11 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet transformers (CTs) and their corresponding signal conditioning circuits can be characterized and their correction factors can be programmed to produce electricity meters with exceptional accuracy over the industrial temperature range. One of the two internal UARTs is adapted to support an Infrared LED with internal drive and sense configuration and can also function as a standard UART. The optical output can be modulated at 38 kHz. This flexibility makes it possible to implement AMR meters with an IR interface. A block diagram of the IC is shown in Figure 1. 2.2 Analog Front End (AFE) The AFE functions as a data acquisition system, controlled by the MPU. When used with locally connected sensors, as seen in Figure 2, the analog input signals (IAP-IAN, VA and IBP-IBN) are multiplexed to the ADC input and sampled by the ADC. The ADC output is decimated by the FIR filter and stored in CE RAM where it can be accessed and processed by the CE. See Figure 6 for the multiplexer sequence corresponding to Figure 2. See Figure 35 for the meter configuration corresponding to Figure 2. VREF ILINE ILINE IAP CT Local or hunt MUX VREF AC CONVERTER VREF IAN VAC FIR CE RAM 22 VAC10 (VA) IN* IBP CT IBN 71M6541/F *IN = Optional Neutral Current 11/5/2010 Figure 2. 71M6541D/F/G AFE Block Diagram (Local Sensors) 12 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Figure 3 shows the 71M6541D/F/G multiplexer interface with one local and one remote resistive shunt sensor. As seen in Figure 3, when a remote isolated shunt sensor is connected via the 71M6x01, the samples associated with this current channel are not routed to the multiplexer, and are instead transferred digitally to the 71M6541D/F/G via the digital isolation interface and are directly stored in CE RAM. See Figure 6 for the multiplexer timing sequence corresponding to Figure 3. See Figure 36 for the meter configurations corresponding to Figure 3. VREF ILINE IAP Local hunt AC CONVERTER MUX VREF VREF IAN FIR VAC VAC10 (VA) 22 CE RAM IN* INP P Remote hunt IBP 71M6x01 N IBN igital Isolation Interface 22 INN 71M6541/F 11/5/2010 * IN = Optional Neutral Current Figure 3. 71M6541D/F/G AFE Block Diagram with 71M6x01 Figure 4 shows the 71M6542F/G AFE with locally connected sensors. The analog input signals (IAP-IAN, VA, IBP-IBN and VB) are multiplexed to the ADC input and sampled by the ADC. The ADC output is decimated by the FIR filter and stored in CE RAM where it can be accessed and processed by the CE. See Figure 7 for the multiplexer timing sequence corresponding to Figure 4. See Figure 37 for the meter configuration corresponding to Figure 4. VREF IA IA IAP CT Local or hunt MUX VREF AC CONVERTER VREF IAN VAC FIR CE RAM 22 VAC10 (VA) VAC9 (VB) IB IBP CT IBN 71M6542F 11/5/2010 Figure 4. 71M6542F/G AFE Block Diagram (Local Sensors) Rev 5 13 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Figure 5 shows the 71M6542F/G multiplexer interface with one local and one remote resistive shunt sensor. As seen in Figure 5, when a remote isolated shunt sensor is connected via the 71M6x01, the samples associated with this current channel are not routed to the multiplexer, and are instead transferred digitally to the 71M6542F/G via the digital isolation interface and are directly stored in CE RAM. See Figure 6 for the multiplexer timing sequence corresponding to Figure 5. See Figure 38 for the meter configurations corresponding to Figure 5. VREF IA IAP Local hunt MUX VREF AC CONVERTER VREF IAN FIR VAC VAC10 (VA) 22 VAC9 (VB) CE RAM IB INP Remote hunt P IBP 71M6x01 N IBN igital Isolation Interface 22 INN 71M6542F 11/5/2010 Figure 5. 71M6542F/G AFE Block Diagram with 71M6x01 2.2.1 Signal Input Pins The 71M6541D/F/G features five ADC inputs. The 71M6542F/G features six ADC inputs. IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN are intended for use as current sensor inputs. These four current sensor inputs can be configured as two single-ended inputs, or can be paired to form two differential inputs. For best performance, it is recommended to configure the current sensor inputs as differential inputs (i.e., IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN). The first differential input (IAP-IAN) features a pre-amplifier with a selectable gain of 1 or 8, and is intended for direct connection to a shunt resistor sensor, and can also be used with a Current Transformer (CT). The remaining differential pair (i.e., IBP-IBN) may be used with CTs, or may be enabled to interface to a remote 71M6x01 isolated current sensor providing isolation for a shunt resistor sensor using a low cost pulse transformer. The remaining input in the 71M6541D/F (VA) is single-ended, and is intended for sensing the line voltage in a single-phase meter application using Equation 0 or 1 (see 2.3.4 Meter Equations on page 25). The 71M6542F/G features an additional single-ended voltage sensing input (VB) to support bi-phase applications using Equation 2. These single-ended inputs are referenced to the V3P3A pin. All analog signal input pins measure voltage. In the case of shunt current sensors, currents are sensed as a voltage drop in the shunt resistor sensor. Referring to Figure 3, shunt sensors can be connected directly to the 71M654x (referred to as a `local' shunt sensor) or connected via an isolated 71M6x01 (referred to as a `remote' shunt sensor). In the case of Current Transformers (CT), the current is measured as a voltage across a burden resistor that is connected to the secondary winding of the CT. Meanwhile, line voltages are sensed through resistive voltage dividers. The VA and VB pins (VB is available in the 71M6542F/G only) are single-ended and their common return is the V3P3A pin. Pins IAP-IAN can be programmed individually to be differential or single-ended as determined by the DIFFA_E (I/O RAM 0x210C[4]) control bit. However, for most applications, IAP-IAN are configured as a differential input to work with a shunt or CT directly interfaced to the IAP-IAN differential input with the appropriate external signal conditioning components (see 4.2 Direct Connection of Sensors on page 92). 14 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The performance of the IAP-IAN pins can be enhanced by enabling a pre-amplifier with a fixed gain of 8, using the I/O RAM control bit PRE_E (I/O RAM 0x2704[5]). When PRE_E = 1, IAP-IAN become the inputs to the 8x pre-amplifier, and the output of this amplifier is supplied to the multiplexer. The 8x amplification is useful when current sensors with low sensitivity, such as shunt resistors, are used. With PRE_E set, the IAP-IAN input signal amplitude is restricted to 31.25 mV peak. For the 71M654x application utilizing two shunt resistor sensors (Figure 3), the IAP-IAN pins are configured for differential mode to interface to a local shunt by setting the DIFFA_E control bit. Meanwhile, the IBP-IBN pins are re-configured as digital balanced pair to communicate with a 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor interface by setting the RMT_E control bit (I/O RAM 0x2709[3]). The 71M6x01 communicates with the 71M654x using a bi-directional digital data stream through an isolating low-cost pulse transformer. The 71M654x also supplies power to the 71M6x01 through the isolating transformer. This type of interface is further described at the end of this chapter (see 2.2.8 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface (Remote Sensor Interface)). For use with Current Transformers (CTs), as shown in Figure 2, the RMT_E control bit is reset, so that the IBP-IBN pins are configured as local analog inputs. The IAP-IAN pins cannot be configured as a remote sensor interface. 2.2.2 Input Multiplexer When operating with local sensors, the input multiplexer sequentially applies the input signals from the analog input pins to the input of the ADC (see Figure 2 and Figure 4). One complete sampling sequence is called a multiplexer frame. The multiplexer of the 71M6541D/F can select up to three input signals (IAP-IAN, VA, and IBP-IBN) per multiplexer frame as controlled by the I/O RAM control field MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]) (see Figure 6). The multiplexer of the 71M6542F/G adds the VB signal to achieve a total of four inputs (see Figure 7). The multiplexer always starts at state 1 and proceeds until as many states as determined by MUX_DIV[3:0] have been converted. The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G each require a unique CE code that is written for the specific application. Moreover, each CE code requires specific AFE and MUX settings in order to function properly. Table 1 provides the CE code and settings corresponding to the local sensor configurations shown in Figure 2 and Figure 4. Table 2 provides the CE code and settings corresponding to the local/remote sensor configuration utilizing the 71M6x01 as shown in Figure 3 and Figure 5. Table 1. Required CE Code and Settings for Local Sensors 71M6542F/G I/O RAM I/O RAM 71M6541D/F/G (hex) Mnemonic Location (hex) Eq. 0 or 1 Eq. 2 FIR_LEN[1:0] 210C[2:1] 1 1 2 ADC_DIV 2200[5] 1 1 0 PLL_FAST 2200[4] 1 1 1 MUX_DIV[3:0] 1 2100[7:4] 3 3 4 MUX0_SEL[3:0] 2105[3:0] 0 0 0 MUX1_SEL[3:0] 2105[7:4] A A A MUX2_SEL[3:0] 2104[3:0] 2 2 2 MUX3_SEL[3:0] 2104[7:4] 1 1 9 RMT_E 2709[3] 0 0 0 DIFFA_E 210C[4] 1 1 1 DIFFB_E 210C[5] 1 1 1 EQU[2:0] 2106[7:5] 0 or 1 0 or 1 2 CE Code -CE41A01 CE41A01 CE41A04 Equations -0 or 1 0 or 1 2 1 Shunt and 1 CT 1 Shunt and 1 CT 1 Shunt and 1 CT -or or or Current Sensor Types Applicable Figure -- 2 CTs 2 CTs 2 CTs Figure 2 Figure 4 Figure 4 Notes: 1. MUX_DIV[3:0] must be set to 0 while writing the other RAM locations in this table. Maxim updates the CE code periodically. Contact your local Maxim representative to obtain the latest CE code and the associated settings. The configuration presented in this table is set by the MPU demonstration code during initialization. Rev 5 15 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 2. Required CE Code and Settings for 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor I/O RAM I/O RAM 71M6541D/F/G 71M6542F/G Mnemonic Location (hex) (hex) FIR_LEN[1:0] 210C[2:1] 1 1 ADC_DIV 2200[5] 1 1 PLL_FAST 2200[4] 1 1 MUX_DIV[3:0] 4 2100[7:4] 3 3 MUX0_SEL[3:0] 2105[3:0] 0 0 MUX1_SEL[3:0] 2105[7:4] A A MUX2_SEL[3:0] 1 2104[3:0] 1 9 MUX3_SEL[3:0] 1 2104[7:4] 1 1 RMT_E 2709[3] 1 1 DIFFA_E 210C[4] 1 1 DIFFB_E 210C[5] 0 0 EQU[2:0] 2106[7:5] 0 or 1 0, 1 or 2 2 CE41B016201 CE Code -3 CE41B016601 Equations -0, 1 0, 1 and 2 1 Local Shunt 1 Local Shunt Current Sensor Type -and and 1 Remote Shunt 1 Remote Shunt Applicable Figure -Figure 3 Figure 5 Notes: 1. Although not used, set to 1 (the sample data is ignored by the CE) 2. 71M654x with 71M6201 remote sensor (200 Amps) 3. 71M654x with 71M6601 remote sensor (60 Amps) 4. MUX_DIV[3:0] must be set to 0 while writing the other RAM locations in this table. Maxim updates the CE code periodically. Contact your local Maxim representative to obtain the latest CE code and the associated settings. The configuration presented in this table is set by the MPU demonstration code during initialization. Using settings for the I/O RAM Mnemonics listed in Table 1 and Table 2 that do not match those required by the corresponding CE code being used results in undesirable side effects and must not be selected by the MPU. Consult your local Maxim representative to obtain the correct CE code and AFE / MUX settings corresponding to the application. For a basic single-phase application, the IAP-IAN current input is configured for differential mode, whereas the VA pin is single-ended and is typically connected to the phase voltage via a resistor divider. The IBP-IBN differential input may be optionally used to sense the Neutral current. This configuration implies that the multiplexer applies a total of three inputs to the ADC. For this configuration, the multiplexer sequence is as shown in Figure 6. In this configuration IAP-IAN, IBP-IBN and VA are sampled, the extra conversion time slot (i.e., slot 2) is the optional Neutral current, and the physical current sensor for the Neutral current measurement may be omitted if not required. For a standard single-phase application with tamper sensor in the neutral path, two current inputs can be configured for differential mode, using the pin pairs IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN. This means that the multiplexer applies a total of three inputs to the ADC. In this application, the system design may use two locally connected current sensors via IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN, as shown in Figure 2, and configured as differential inputs. Alternately, the IAP-IAN pin pair is configured as a differential input and connected to a local current shunt, and IBP-IBN is configured to connect to an isolated 71M6x01 isolated sensor (i.e., RMT_E = 1), as shown in Figure 3. The VA pin is typically connected to the phase voltage via resistor dividers. For this configuration, the multiplexer frame is also as shown in Figure 6 and time slot 2 is unused and ignored by the CE, as the samples corresponding to the remote sensor (IBP-IBN) do not pass through the multiplexer and are stored directly in CE RAM. The remote current sensor channel is sampled during the second half of the multiplexer frame and its timing relationship to the VA voltage is precisely known so that delay compensation can be properly applied. The 71M6542F adds the ability to sample a second phase voltage (applied at the VB pin), which makes it suitable for meters with two voltage and two current sensors, such as meters implementing Equation 2 for dual-phase operation (P = VA*IA+VB*IB). Figure 7 shows the multiplexer sequence when four inputs are 16 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet processed with locally connected sensors, as shown in Figure 3. When using one local and one remote sensor (Figure 5), the multiplexer sequence is also as shown in Figure 7. For both multiplexer sequences shown in Figure 6 and Figure 7, the frame duration is 13 CK32 cycles (where CK32 = 32768 Hz), therefore, the resulting sample rate is 32768 Hz / 13 = 2520.6 Hz. Table 3 summarizes the various AFE input configurations. Multiplexer Frame Settle MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3 Conversions CK32 MUX STATE S Fig. 2: Fig. 3: Fig. 5: 0 IA IA IA 1 VA VA VA 2 IB Not Used VB S 0 CROSS MUX_SYNC 11/5/2010 Figure 6: States in a Multiplexer Frame (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3) Multiplexer Frame Settle MUX_DIV = 4 Conversions CK32 MUX STATE S Fig. 4: 0 1 2 3 IA VA IB VB S 0 CROSS MUX_SYNC 11/5/2010 Figure 7: States in a Multiplexer Frame (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4) Table 3: ADC Input Configuration Rev 5 Pin ADC Channel IAP ADC0 IAN ADC1 IBP ADC2 IBN ADC3 VA ADC10 VB ADC9 Required Setting Comment Differential mode must be selected with DIFFA_E = 1 (I/O RAM 0x210C[4]). The ADC results are stored in CE RAM DIFFA_E = 1 location ADC0 (CE RAM 0x0), and ADC1 (CE RAM 0x1) is not disturbed. For locally connected sensors (Figure 2 and Figure 4), the differential input must be enabled by setting DIFFB_E (I/O RAM 0x210C[5]. DIFFB_E = 1 For the remote connected sensor (Figure 3 and Figure 5) with a remote shunt sensor, RMT_E (I/O RAM 0x2709[3]) or RMT_E = 1 must be set. In both cases, the ADC results are stored in RAM location ADC2 (CE RAM 0x2), and ADC3 (CE RAM 0x3) is not disturbed. Single-ended mode only. The ADC result is stored in RAM -location ADC10 (CE RAM 0xA). Single-ended mode only (71M6542F only). The ADC result -is stored in RAM location ADC9 (CE RAM 0x9). 17 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Multiplexer advance, FIR initiation and chopping of the ADC reference voltage (using the internal CROSS signal, see 2.2.7 Voltage References) are controlled by the internal MUX_CTRL circuit. Additionally, MUX_CTRL launches each pass of the CE through its code. Conceptually, MUX_CTRL is clocked by CK32, the 32768 Hz clock from the PLL block. The behavior of the MUX_CTRL circuit is governed by: * * * * CHOP_E[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[3:2]) MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]) FIR_LEN[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x210C[2:1]) ADC_DIV (I/O RAM 0x2200[5]) The duration of each multiplexer state depends on the number of ADC samples processed by the FIR as determined by the FIR_LEN[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x210C[2:1] control field. Each multiplexer state starts on the rising edge of CK32, the 32-kHz clock. It is required that MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]) be set to zero while changing the ADC configuration to minimize system transients. After all configuration bits are set, MUX_DIV[3:0] should be set to the required value. Additionally, the ADC can be configured to operate at one-half rate (32768*75=2.46MHz). In this mode, the bias current to the ADC amplifiers is reduced and overall system power is reduced. The ADC_DIV (I/O RAM 0x2200[5]) bit selects full speed or half speed. At half speed, if FIR_LEN[1:0] is set to 01 (288), each conversion requires 4 XTAL cycles, resulting in a 2520Hz sample rate when MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3. Note that in order to work with these power-reducing settings, a corresponding CE code is required. The duration of each time slot in CK32 cycles depends on FIR_LEN[1:0], ADC_DIV and PLL_FAST: Time_Slot_Duration (PLL_FAST = 1) = (FIR_LEN[1:0]+1) * (ADC_DIV+1) Time_Slot_Duration (PLL_FAST = 0) = 3*(FIR_LEN[1:0]+1) * (ADC_DIV+1) The duration of a multiplexer frame in CK32 cycles is: MUX_Frame_Duration = 3-2*PLL_FAST + Time_Slot_Duration * MUX_DIV[3:0] The duration of a multiplexer frame in CK_FIR cycles is: MUX frame duration (CK_FIR cycles) = [3-2*PLL_FAST + Time_Slot_Duration * MUX_DIV] * (48+PLL_FAST*102) The ADC conversion sequence is programmable through the MUXx_SEL control fields (I/O RAM 0x2100 to 0x2105). As stated above, there are three ADC time slots in the 71M6541D/F/G and four ADC time slots in the 71M6542F/G, as set by MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]). In the expression MUXx_SEL[3:0] = n, `x' refers to the multiplexer frame time slot number and n refers to the desired ADC input number or ADC handle (i.e., ADC0 to ADC10, or simply 0 to 10 decimal). Thus, there are a total of 11 valid ADC handles in the 71M654x devices. For example, if MUX0_SEL[3:0] = 0, then ADC0, corresponding to the sample from the IAP-IAN input (configured as a differential input), is positioned in the multiplexer frame during time slot 0. See Table 1 and Table 2 for the appropriate MUXx_SEL[3:0] settings and other settings applicable to a particular CE code. Note that when the remote sensor interface is enabled, and even though the samples corresponding to the remote sensor current (IBP-IBN) do not pass through the multiplexer, the MUX2_SEL[3:0] and MUX3_SEL[3:0] control fields must be written with a valid ADC handle that is not being used. Typically, ADC1 is used for this purpose (see Table 2). In this manner, the ADC1 handle, which is not used in the 71M6541D/F/G or 71M6542F/G, is used as a place holder in the multiplexer frame, in order to generate the correct multiplexer frame sequence and the correct sample rate. The resulting sample data stored in CE RAM 0x1 is undefined and is ignored by the CE code. Meanwhile, the digital isolation interface takes care of automatically storing the samples for the remote interface current (IBP-IBN) in CE RAM 0x2. 18 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Delay compensation and other functions in the CE code require the settings for MUX_DIV[3:0], MUXx_SEL[3:0], RMT_E, FIR_LEN[1:0], ADC_DIV and PLL_FAST to be fixed for a given CE code. Refer to Table 1 and Table 2 for the settings that are applicable to the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G. Table 4 summarizes the I/O RAM registers used for configuring the multiplexer, signals pins, and ADC. All listed registers are 0 after reset and wake from battery modes, and are readable and writable. Table 4: Multiplexer and ADC Configuration Bits Name MUX0_SEL[3:0] MUX1_SEL[3:0] MUX2_SEL[3:0] MUX3_SEL[3:0] MUX4_SEL[3:0] MUX5_SEL[3:0] MUX6_SEL[3:0] MUX7_SEL[3:0] MUX8_SEL[3:0] MUX9_SEL[3:0] MUX10_SEL[3:0] ADC_DIV MUX_DIV[3:0] PLL_FAST FIR_LEN[1:0] DIFFA_E DIFFB_E Location Description Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 0. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 1. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 2. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 3. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 4. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 5. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 6. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 7. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 8. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 9. Selects the ADC input converted during time slot 10. Controls the rate of the ADC and FIR clocks. The number of ADC time slots in each multiplexer frame (maximum = 11). Controls the speed of the PLL and MCK. Determines the number of ADC cycles in the ADC decimation FIR filter. Enables the differential configuration for analog input pins IAP-IAN. Enables the differential configuration for analog input pins IBP-IBN. Enables the remote sensor interface transforming pins IBP-IBN into a RMT_E 2709[3] digital balanced differential pair for communications with the 71M6x01 sensor. PRE_E 2704[5] Enables the 8x pre-amplifier. Refer to Table 76 starting on page 111 for more complete details about these I/O RAM locations. 2.2.3 2105[3:0] 2105[7:4] 2104[3:0] 2104[7:4] 2103[3:0] 2103[7:4] 2102[3:0] 2102[7:0] 2101[3:0] 2101[7:0] 2100[3:0] 2200[5] 2100[7:4] 2200[4] 210C[1] 210C[4] 210C[5] Delay Compensation When measuring the energy of a phase (i.e., Wh and VARh) in a service, the voltage and current for that phase must be sampled at the same instant. Otherwise, the phase difference, , introduces errors. f= t delay T 360 o = t delay f 360 o Where f is the frequency of the input signal, T = 1/f and tdelay is the sampling delay between current and voltage. Traditionally, sampling is accomplished by using two A/D converters per phase (one for voltage and the other one for current) controlled to sample simultaneously. Maxim's Single-Converter Technology, however, exploits the 32-bit signal processing capability of its CE to implement "constant delay" all-pass filters. The all-pass filter corrects for the conversion time difference between the voltage and the corresponding current samples that are obtained with a single multiplexed A/D converter. The "constant delay" all-pass filter provides a broad-band delay 360 - , which is precisely matched to the difference in sample time between the voltage and the current of a given phase. This digital filter does not affect the amplitude of the signal, but provides a precisely controlled phase response. o The recommended ADC multiplexer sequence samples the current first, immediately followed by sampling of the corresponding phase voltage, thus the voltage is delayed by a phase angle relative to Rev 5 19 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet the current. The delay compensation implemented in the CE aligns the voltage samples with their corresponding current samples by first delaying the current samples by one full sample interval (i.e., o 360 ), then routing the voltage samples through the all-pass filter, thus delaying the voltage samples by o 360 - , resulting in the residual phase error between the current and its corresponding voltage of - . The residual phase error is negligible, and is typically less than 1.5 milli-degrees at 100Hz, thus it does not contribute to errors in the energy measurements. When using remote sensors, the CE performs the same delay compensation described above to align each voltage sample with its corresponding current sample. Even though the remote current samples do not pass through the 71M654x multiplexer, their timing relationship to their corresponding voltages is fixed and precisely known, provided that the MUXn_SEL[3:0] slot assignment fields are programmed as shown in Table 1 and Table 2. 2.2.4 ADC Pre-Amplifier The ADC pre-amplifier is a low-noise differential amplifier with a fixed gain of 8 available only on the IAPIAN sensor input pins. A gain of 8 is enabled by setting PRE_E = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2704[5]). When disabled, the supply current of the pre-amplifier is <10 nA and the gain is unity. With proper settings of the PRE_E and DIFFA_E (I/O RAM 0x210C[4]) bits, the pre-amplifier can be used whether differential mode is selected or not. For best performance, the differential mode is recommended. In order to save power, the bias current of the pre-amplifier and ADC is adjusted according to the ADC_DIV control bit (I/O RAM 0x2200[5]). 2.2.5 A/D Converter (ADC) nd A single 2 order delta-sigma A/D converter digitizes the voltage and current inputs to the device. The resolution of the ADC, including the sign bit, is 21 bits (FIR_LEN[1:0] = 1, I/O RAM 0x210C[2:1]), or 22 bits (FIR_LEN[1:0] = 2). The ADC is clocked by CKADC. Initiation of each ADC conversion is controlled by MUX_CTRL internal circuit as described above. At the end of each ADC conversion, the FIR filter output data is stored into the CE RAM location determined by the multiplexer selection. FIR data is stored LSB justified, but shifted left 9 bits. 2.2.6 FIR Filter The finite impulse response filter is an integral part of the ADC and it is optimized for use with the multiplexer. The purpose of the FIR filter is to decimate the ADC output to the desired resolution. At the end of each ADC conversion, the output data is stored into the fixed CE RAM location determined by the multiplexer selection as shown in Table 1 and Table 2. 2.2.7 Voltage References A bandgap circuit provides the reference voltage to the ADC. The amplifier within the reference is chopper stabilized, i.e., the chopper circuit can be enabled or disabled by the MPU using the I/O RAM control field CHOP_E[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[3:2]). The two bits in the CHOP_E[1:0] field enable the MPU to operate the chopper circuit in regular or inverted operation, or in toggling modes (recommended). When the chopper circuit is toggled in between multiplexer cycles, dc offsets on VREF are automatically be averaged out, therefore the chopper circuit should always be configured for one of the toggling modes. Since the VREF band-gap amplifier is chopper-stabilized, the dc offset voltage, which is the most significant long-term drift mechanism in the voltage references (VREF), is automatically removed by the chopper circuit. Both the 71M654x and the 71M6x01 feature chopper circuits for their respective VREF voltage reference. The general topology of a chopped amplifier is shown in Figure 8. The CROSS signal is an internal onchip signal and is not accessible on any pin or register. 20 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet A Vinp B A Vinn B A + G - Voutp B A Voutn B CROSS Figure 8: General Topology of a Chopped Amplifier It is assumed that an offset voltage Voff appears at the positive amplifier input. With all switches, as controlled by CROSS (an internal signal), in the A position, the output voltage is: Voutp - Voutn = G (Vinp + Voff - Vinn) = G (Vinp - Vinn) + G Voff With all switches set to the B position by applying the inverted CROSS signal, the output voltage is: Voutn - Voutp = G (Vinn - Vinp + Voff) = G (Vinn - Vinp) + G Voff, or Voutp - Voutn = G (Vinp - Vinn) - G Voff Thus, when CROSS is toggled, e.g., after each multiplexer cycle, the offset alternately appears on the output as positive and negative, which results in the offset effectively being eliminated, regardless of its polarity or magnitude. When CROSS is high, the connection of the amplifier input devices is reversed. This preserves the overall polarity of that amplifier gain; it inverts its input offset. By alternately reversing the connection, the amplifier's offset is averaged to zero. This removes the most significant long-term drift mechanism in the voltage reference. The CHOP_E[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[3:2]) control field controls the behavior of CROSS. The CROSS signal reverses the amplifier connection in the voltage reference in order to negate the effects of its offset. On the first CK32 rising edge after the last multiplexer state of its sequence, the multiplexer waits one additional CK32 cycle before beginning a new frame. At the beginning of this cycle, the value of CROSS is updated according to the CHOP_E[1:0] field. The extra CK32 cycle allows time for the chopped VREF to settle. During this cycle, MUXSYNC is held high. The leading edge of MUXSYNC initiates a pass through the CE program sequence. The beginning of the sequence is the serial readout of the four RTM words. CHOP_E[1:0] has four states: positive, reverse, and two toggle states. In the positive state, CHOP_E[1:0] = 01, CROSS is held low. In the reverse state, CHOP_E[1:0] = 10, CROSS is held high. Figure 9: CROSS Signal with CHOP_E = 00 Figure 9 shows CROSS over two accumulation intervals when CHOP_E[1:0] = 00: At the end of the first interval, CROSS is high, at the end of the second interval, CROSS is low. Operation with CHOP_E[1:0] = 00 does not require control of the chopping mechanism by the MPU. In the second toggle state, CHOP_E[1:0] = 11, CROSS does not toggle at the end of the last multiplexer cycle in an accumulation interval. A second, low-power voltage reference is used in the LCD system and for the comparators that support transitions to and from the battery modes. Rev 5 21 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.2.8 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface (Remote Sensor Interface) 2.2.8.1 General Description Non-isolating sensors, such as shunt resistors, can be connected to the inputs of the 71M654x via a combination of a pulse transformer and a 71M6x01 IC (a top-level block diagram of this sensor interface is shown in Figure 36). The 71M6x01 receives power directly from the 71M654x via a pulse transformer and does not require a dedicated power supply circuit. The 71M6x01 establishes 2-way communication with the 71M654x, supplying current samples and auxiliary information such as sensor temperature via a serial data stream. One 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor can be supported by the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G. When remote interface IBP-IBN is enabled, the two analog current inputs pins IBP and IBN become a digital balanced differential interface to the remote sensor. See Table 3 for details. Each 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor consists of the following building blocks: * * * * * * Power supply for power pulses received from the 71M654x Digital communications interface Shunt signal pre-amplifier Delta-Sigma ADC Converter with precision bandgap reference (chopping amplifier) Temperature sensor Fuse system containing part-specific information During an ordinary multiplexer cycle, the 71M654x internally determines which other channels are enabled with MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]). At the same time, it decimates the modulator output from the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensors. Each result is written to CE RAM during one of its CE access time slots. See Table 3 for the CE RAM locations of the sampled signals. 2.2.8.2 Communication between 71M654x and 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor The ADC of the 71M6x01 derives its timing from the power pulses generated by the 71M654x and as a result, operates its ADC slaved to the frequency of the power pulses. The generation of power pulses, as well as the communication protocol between the 71M654x and 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor is automatic and transparent to the user. Details are not covered in this data sheet. 2.2.8.3 Control of the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor The 71M654x can read or write certain types of information from each 71M6x01 isolated sensor. The data to be read is selected by a combination of the RCMD[4:0] and TMUXRn[2:0]. To perform a read transaction from one of the 71M6x01 devices, the MPU first writes the TMUXRn[2:0] field (where n = 2, 4, 6, located at I/O RAM 0x270A[2:0], 0x270A[6:4] and 0x2709[2:0], respectively). Next, the MPU writes RCMD[4:0] (SFR 0xFC[4:0]) with the desired command and phase selection. When the RCMD[4:2] bits have cleared to zero, the transaction has been completed and the requested data is available in RMT_RD[15:0] (I/O RAM 0x2602[7:0] is the MSB and 0x2603[7:0] is the LSB). The read parity error bit, PERR_RD (SFR 0xFC[6]) is also updated during the transaction. If the MPU writes to RCMD[4:0] before a previously initiated read transaction is completed, the command is ignored. Therefore, the MPU must wait for RCMD[4:2]=0 before proceeding to issue the next remote sensor read command. The RCMD[4:0] field is divided into two sub-fields, COMMAND=RCMD[4:2] and PHASE=RCMD[1:0], as shown in Table 5. 22 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 5. RCMD[4:0] Bits Command Phase Selector Associated TMUXRn RCMD[4:2] RCMD[1:0] Control Field --000 Invalid 00 Invalid IBP-IBN TMUXRB [2:0] 001 Command 1 01 010 Command 2 011 Reserved 100 Reserved 101 Invalid 110 Reserved 111 Reserved Notes: 1. Only two codes of RCMD[4:2] (SFR 0xFC[4:2]) are relevant for normal operation. These are RCMD[4:2] = 001 and 010. Codes 000 and 101 are invalid and will be ignored if used. The remaining codes are reserved and must not be used. 2. For the RCMD[1:0] control field, codes 01, 10 and 11 are valid and 00 is invalid and must not be used. Table 6 shows the allowable combinations of values in RCMD[4:2] and TMUXRn[2:0], and the corresponding data type and format sent back by the 71M6x01 isolated sensor and how the data is stored in RMT_RD[15:8] and RMT_RD[7:0]. The MPU selects which of the three phases is read by asserting the proper code in the RCMD[1:0] field, as shown in Table 5. Table 6: Remote Interface Read Commands RCMD[4:2] TMUXRn[2:0] 001 00X Read Operation TRIMT[7:0] 010 00X STEMP[10:0] 010 01X VSENSE[7:0] 010 10X VERSION[7:0] (trim fuse for all 71M6x01) (sensed 71M6x01 temperature) (sensed 71M6x01 supply voltage) (chip version) RMT_RD [15:8] RMT_RD [7:0] TRIMT[7]=RMT_RD[8] TRIMT[6:0]=RMT_RD[7:1] STEMP[10:8]=RMT_RD[10:8] STEMP[7:0] (RMT_RD[15:11] are sign extended) All zeros VSENSE[7:0] VERSION[7:0] All zeros Notes: 1. TRIMT[7:0] is the VREF trim value for all 71M6x01 devices. Note that the TRIMT[7:0] 8-bit value is formed by RMT_RD[8] and RMT_RD[7:1]. See the 71M6xxx Data sheet for more information on TRIMT[7:0] 2. See the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for the equation to calculate temperature from the STEMP[7:0] value read from the 71M6x01. 3. See the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for the equation to calculate temperature from the VSENSE[7:0] value read from the 71M6x01. With hardware and trim-related information on each connected 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor available to the 71M6541D/F/G, the MPU can implement temperature compensation of the energy measurement based on the individual temperature characteristics of the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor. See 4.7 Metrology Temperature Compensation on page 97 for details. Table 7 shows all I/O RAM registers used for control of the external 71M6x01 Isolated Sensors. See the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for additional details. Table 7: I/O RAM Control Bits for Isolated Sensor Name RCMD[4:0] Rev 5 Address SFR FC[4:0] RST WAKE Default Default 0 0 R/W Description When the MPU writes a non-zero value to RCMD, the 71M654x issues a command to the corR/W responding isolated sensor selected with RCMD[1:0]. When the command is complete, the 71M654x clears RCMD[4:2]. The command code 23 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Address RST WAKE Default Default PERR_RD PERR_WR SFR FC[6] SFR FC[5] 0 0 CHOPR[1:0] 2709[7:6] 00 00 TMUXRB[2:0] 270A[2:0] RMT_RD[15:8] 2602[7:0] RMT_RD[7:0] 2603[7:0] 000 000 0 0 R/W Description itself is in RCMD[4:2]. The 71M654x sets these bits to indicate that a parity error on the isolated sensor has been deR/W tected. Once set, the bits are remembered until they are cleared by the MPU. The CHOP settings for the isolated sensors. 00 - Auto chop. Change every multiplexer frame. R/W 01 - Positive 10 - Negative 11 - Same as 00 R/W The TMUX bits for control of the isolated sensor. R The read buffer for 71M6x01 read operations. Controls how the 71M654x drives the 71M6x01 power pulse. When set, the power pulse is driven 210C[3] RFLY_DIS 0 0 R/W high and low. When cleared, it is driven high followed by an open circuit flyback interval. Enables the isolated remote sensor interface and RMT_E 2709[3] 0 0 R/W re-configures pins IBP-IBN as a balanced pair digital remote interface. Refer to Table 76 starting on page 111 for more complete details about these I/O RAM locations. 2.3 Digital Computation Engine (CE) The CE, a dedicated 32-bit signal processor, performs the precision computations necessary to accurately measure energy. The CE calculations and processes include: * * * * * * * * Multiplication of each current sample with its associated voltage sample to obtain the energy per sample (when multiplied with the constant sample time). Frequency-insensitive delay cancellation on all four channels (to compensate for the delay between samples caused by the multiplexing scheme). 90 phase shifter (for VAR calculations). Pulse generation. Monitoring of the input signal frequency (for frequency and phase information). Monitoring of the input signal amplitude (for sag detection). Scaling of the processed samples based on calibration coefficients. Scaling of samples based on temperature compensation information. 2.3.1 CE Program Memory The CE program resides in flash memory. Common access to flash memory by the CE and MPU is controlled by a memory share circuit. Each CE instruction word is two bytes long. Allocated flash space for the CE program cannot exceed 4096 16-bit words (8 KB). The CE program counter begins a pass through the CE code each time multiplexer state 0 begins. The code pass ends when a HALT instruction is executed. For proper operation, the code pass must be completed before the multiplexer cycle ends. The CE program must begin on a 1 KB boundary of the flash address. The I/O RAM control field CE_LCTN[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2109[5:0]) defines which 1 KB boundary contains the CE code. Thus, the first CE instruction is located at 1024*CE_LCTN[5:0]. 2.3.2 CE Data Memory The CE and MPU share data memory (RAM). Common access to XRAM by the CE and MPU is controlled by a memory share circuit. The CE can access up to 3 KB of the 3 KB data RAM (XRAM), i.e., from RAM address 0x0000 to 0x0C00. 24 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The XRAM can be accessed by the FIR filter block, the RTM circuit, the CE, and the MPU. Assigned time slots are reserved for FIR and MPU, respectively, to prevent bus contention for XRAM data access by the CE. The MPU reads and writes the XRAM shared between the CE and MPU as the primary means of data communication between the two processors. Table 3 shows the CE addresses in XRAM allocated to analog inputs from the AFE. The CE is aided by support hardware to facilitate implementation of equations, pulse counters, and accumulators. This hardware is controlled through the I/O RAM control field EQU[2:0], equation assist (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]), bit DIO_PV (I/O RAM 0x2457[6]), bit DIO_PW, pulse count assist (I/O RAM 0x2457[7]), and SUM_SAMPS[12:0], accumulation assist (I/O RAM 0x2107[4:0] and 0x2108[7:0]). SUM_SAMPS[12:0] supports an accumulation scheme where the incremental energy values from up to SUM_SAMPS[12:0] multiplexer frames are added up over one accumulation interval. The integration time for each energy output is, for example, SUM_SAMPS[12:0]/2520.6 (with MUX_DIV[3:0] = 011, I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4] and FIR_LEN[1:0] = 10, I/O RAM 0x210C[2:1]). CE hardware issues the XFER_BUSY interrupt when the accumulation is complete. 2.3.3 CE Communication with the MPU The CE outputs six signals to the MPU: CE_BUSY, XFER_BUSY, XPULSE, YPULSE, WPULSE and VPULSE. These are connected to the MPU interrupt service. CE_BUSY indicates that the CE is actively processing data. This signal occurs once every multiplexer frame. XFER_BUSY indicates that the CE is updating to the output region of the CE RAM, which occurs whenever an accumulation cycle has been completed. Both, CE_BUSY and XFER_BUSY are cleared when the CE executes a HALT instruction. XPULSE, YPULSE, VPULSE, and WPULSE can be configured to interrupt the MPU and indicate zero crossings of the mains voltage, sag failures, or other significant events. Additionally, these signals can be connected directly to DIO pins to provide direct outputs for the CE. Interrupts associated with these signals always occur on the leading edge (see "External" interrupt source No. 2 in Figure 16). 2.3.4 Meter Equations The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G provide hardware assistance to the CE in order to support various meter equations. This assistance is controlled through I/O RAM register EQU[2:0] (equation assist). The Compute Engine (CE) firmware for industrial configurations can implement the equations listed in Table 8. EQU[2:0] specifies the equation to be used based on the meter configuration and on the number of phases used for metering. Table 8: Inputs Selected in Multiplexer Cycles Wh and VARh formula EQU Description 0 1-element, 2-W, 1f with neutral current sense 1 1-element, 3-W, 1f 2 2-element, 3-W, 3f Delta Element 2 Recommended Multiplexer Sequence VA * IB N/A IA VA IB VA(IA-IB)/2 N/A N/A IA VA IB VA * IA VB * IB N/A IA VA IB VB Element 0 Element 1 VA * IA 1 1 Note: 1. Optionally, IB may be used to measure neutral current 71M6542F/G only 2.3.5 Real-Time Monitor (RTM) The CE contains a Real-Time Monitor (RTM), which can be programmed to monitor four selectable XRAM locations at full sample rate. The four monitored locations, as selected by the I/O RAM registers RTM0[9:8], RTM0[7:0], RTM1[9:8], RTM1[7:0], RTM2[9:8], RTM2[7:0], RTM3[9:8], and RTM3[7:0], are serially output to the TMUXOUT pin via the digital output multiplexer at the beginning of each CE code pass. The RTM can be enabled and disabled with control bit RTM_E (I/O RAM 0x2106[1]). The RTM output is clocked by CKTEST. Each RTM word is clocked out in 35 CKCE cycles (1 CKCE cycle is Rev 5 25 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet equivalent to 203 ns) and contains a leading flag bit. See Figure 10 for the RTM output format. RTM is low when not in use. Figure 11 summarizes the timing relationships between the input MUX states, the CE_BUSY signal, and the RTM serial output stream. In this example, MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4 (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]) and FIR_LEN[1:0] = 10 (I/O RAM 0x210C[1]), (384), resulting in 4 ADC conversions. An ADC conversion always consumes an integer number of CK32 clocks. Followed by the conversions is a single CK32 cycle. Figure 11 also shows that the RTM serial data stream begins transmitting at the beginning of state S. RTM, consisting of 140 CK cycles, always finishes before the next CE code pass starts. CK32 MUX_SYNC S MUX_STATE CKTEST 31 0 FLAG 1 30 31 0 FLAG 1 30 31 SIG N 30 LSB 1 SIG N 0 FLAG LSB RTM DATA0 (32 bits) RTM DATA1 (32 bits) RTM DATA2 (32 bits) RTM DATA3 (32 bits) 31 SIG N 30 LSB 1 LSB 0 FLAG SIG N RTM Figure 10: RTM Timing ADC MUX Frame ADC TIMING MUX_DIV Conversions, MUX_DIV=4 is shown Settle CK32 150 MUX_SYNC MUX STATE 0 S 1 2 S 3 ADC EXECUTION ADC0 CE TIMING 0 ADC1 450 900 ADC2 ADC3 1350 1800 CE_EXECUTION CK COUNT = CE_CYCLES + 1CK for each ADC transfer MAX CK COUNT CE_BUSY XFER_BUSY INITIATED BY A CE OPCODE AT END OF SUM INTERVAL RTM TIMING 140 RTM NOTES: 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE 5MHZ CK COUNTS. 2. THE PRECISE FREQUENCY OF CK IS 150*CRYSTAL FREQUENCY = 4.9152MHz. 3. XFER_BUSY OCCURS ONCE EVERY SUM_SAMPS CODE PASSES. Figure 11: Timing Relationship Between ADC MUX, CE, and RTM Serial Transfer 26 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.3.6 Pulse Generators The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G provide four pulse generators, VPULSE, WPULSE, XPULSE and YPULSE, as well as hardware support for the VPULSE and WPULSE pulse generators. The pulse generators can be used to output CE status indicators, SAG for example, to DIO pins. All pulses can be configured to generate interrupts to the MPU. The polarity of the pulses may be inverted with control bit PLS_INV (I/O RAM 0x210C[0]). When this bit is set, the pulses are active high, rather than the more usual active low. PLS_INV inverts all four pulse outputs. The function of each pulse generator is determined by the CE code and the MPU code must configure the corresponding pulse outputs in agreement with the CE code. For example, standard CE code produces a mains zero-crossing pulse on XPULSE and a SAG pulse on YPULSE. A common use of the zero-crossing pulses is to generate interrupt in order to drive real-time clock software in places where the mains frequency is sufficiently accurate to do so and also to adjust for crystal aging. A common use for the SAG pulse is to generate an interrupt that alerts the MPU when mains power is about to fail, so that the MPU code can store accumulated energy and other data to EEPROM before the V3P3SYS supply voltage actually drops. 2.3.6.1 XPULSE and YPULSE Pulses generated by the CE may be exported to the XPULSE and YPULSE pulse output pins. Pins SEGDIO6 and SEGDIO7 are used for these pulses, respectively. Generally, the XPULSE and YPULSE outputs can be updated once on each pass of the CE code. See 5.3 CE Interface Description on page 126 for details. 2.3.6.2 VPULSE and WPULSE Referring to Figure 12, during each CE code pass the hardware stores exported WPULSE and VPULSE sign bits in an 8-bit FIFO and outputs them at a specified interval. This permits the CE code to calculate the VPULSE and WPULSE outputs at the beginning of its code pass and to rely on hardware to spread them over the multiplexer frame. As seen in Figure 12, the FIFO is reset at the beginning of each multiplexer frame. As also seen in Figure 12, the I/O RAM register PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x210B[7:0]) controls the delay to the first pulse update and the interval between subsequent updates. The LSB of the PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] register is equivalent to 4 CK_FIR cycles (CK_FIR is typically 4.9152MHz if PLL_FAST=1 and ADC_DIV=0, but other CK_FIR frequencies are possible; see the ADC_DIV definition in Table 76.) If PLS_INTERVAL[7:0]=0, the FIFO is deactivated and the pulse outputs are updated immediately. The MUX frame duration in units of CK_FIR clock cycles is given by: If PLL_FAST=1: MUX frame duration in CK_FIR cycles = [1 + (FIR_LEN+1) * (ADC_DIV+1) * (MUX_DIV)] * [150 / (ADC_DIV+1)] If PLL_FAST=0: MUX frame duration in CK_FIR cycles = [3 + 3*(FIR_LEN+1) * (ADC_DIV+1) * (MUX_DIV)] * [48 / (ADC_DIV+1)] PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] in units of CK_FIR clock cycles is calculated by: PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] = floor (Mux frame duration in CK_FIR cycles / CE pulse updates per Mux frame / 4 ) Since the FIFO resets at the beginning of each multiplexer frame, the user must specify PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] so that all of the possible pulse updates occurring in one CE execution are output before the multiplexer frame completes. For instance, the 71M654x CE code outputs six updates per multiplexer interval, and if the multiplexer interval is 1950 CK_FIR clock cycles long, the ideal value for the interval is 1950/6/4 = 81.25. However, if PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] = 82, the sixth output occurs too late and would be lost. In this case, the proper value for PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] is 81 (i.e., round down the result). Since one LSB of PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] is equal to 4 CK_FIR clock cycles, the pulse time interval TI in units of CK_FIR clock cycles is: TI = 4*PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] Rev 5 27 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet If the FIFO is enabled (i.e., PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] 0), hardware also provides a maximum pulse width feature in control register PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x210A) . By default, WPULSE and VPULSE are negative pulses (i.e., low level pulses, designed to sink current through an LED). PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] determines the maximum negative pulse width TMAX in units of CK_FIR clock cycles based on the pulse interval T I according to the formula: TMAX = (2 * PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] + 1) * TI If PLS_MAXWIDTH = 255 or PLS_INTERVAL=0, no pulse width checking is performed, and the pulses default to 50% duty cycle. TMAX is typically programmed to 10 ms., which works well with most calibration systems. The polarity of the pulses may be inverted with the control bit PLS_INV (I/O RAM 0x210C[0]). When PLS_INV is set, the pulses are active high. The default value for PLS_INV is zero, which selects active low pulses. The WPULSE and VPULSE pulse generator outputs are available on pins SEGDIO0/WPULSE and SEGDIO1/VPULSE, respectively (pins 45 and 44). The pulses can also be output on OPT_TX pin 53 (see OPT_TXE[1:0], I/O RAM 0x2456[3:2] for details). ADC MUX Frame MUX_DIVConversions MUX_DIV ( =6 is shown) Settle CK32 150 MUX_SYNC CE CODE S S 0 1 S 2 S 3 S 4 S 5 W_FIFO S RST WPULSE S 0 S 2 S S 4*PLS_INTERVAL 4*PLS_INTERVAL 0 4*PLS_INTERVAL S 1 1 S 3 S 5 S S 4*PLS_INTERVAL 4*PLS_INTERVAL 2 4*PLS_INTERVAL S 4 3 4 S 5 1. This example shows how the FIFO distributes 6 pulse generator updates over one MUX frame. 2. If WPULSE is low longer than (2*PLS_MAXWIDTH+1) updates , WPULSE will be raised until the next low-going pulse begins. 3. Only the WPULSE circuit is shown. The VARPULSE circuit behaves identically. 4. All dimensions are in CK_FIR cycles (4.92MHz). 5. If PLS_INTERVAL =0, FIFO does not perform delay. Figure 12. Pulse Generator FIFO Timing 2.3.7 CE Functional Overview The 71M654x provides an ADC and multiplexer to sample the analog currents and voltages as seen in Figure 2 and Figure 3. The VA and VB voltage sensors are formed by resistive voltage dividers directly connected to the 71M654x device, and therefore always use the ADC and multiplexer facilities in the 71M654x device. Current sensors, however, may be connected directly to the 71M654x or remotely connected through an isolated 71M6x01 device. The remote 71M6x01 sensor has its own separate ADC and voltage reference. When a current sensor is connected via a 71M6x01 isolated sensor, the 71M654x places the sample data received digitally over the isolation interface (via the pulse transformer) in the appropriate CE RAM location, as shown in Figure 3. The ADCs (i.e., ADC in the 71M654x and the ADC in the 71M6x01) process their corresponding sensor channels providing one sample per channel per multiplexer cycle. Figure 14 (71M6541D/F/G) and Figure 15 (71M6542F/G) show the sampling sequence when both current sensors (IA and IB) are connected directly to the 71M6541D/F/G as seen in Figure 2. However, when the 28 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet IB channel is a 71M6x01 isolated sensor, the sample data does not pass through the 71M6541D/F/G multiplexer, as seen in Figure 3. In this case, the sample is taken during the second half of the multiplexer cycle and the data is directly stored in the corresponding CE RAM location as indicated in Figure 3. The timing relationship between the remote current sensor channel and its corresponding voltage is precisely defined so that delay compensation can be properly applied by the CE. Referring to Figure 15, the 71M6542F/G features an additional voltage input (VB) permitting the implementation of a two-phase meter. As with VA, the VB voltage divider is directly connected to the 71M6542F/G and uses the ADC and multiplexer facilities in the 71M6542F/G. MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4 configures the multiplexer to provide an additional time slot to accommodate the additional VB voltage sample. As with the 71M6541D/F/G, IA samples are obtained from a current sensor that is directly connected to the 71M6542F/G, while IB samples may be obtained from a directly connected CT or a remotely connected shunt using a 71M6x01 isolated device as seen in Figure 2 and Figure 3. The number of samples processed during one accumulation cycle is controlled by the I/O RAM register SUM_SAMPS[12:0] (I/O RAM 0x2107[4:0], 0x2108[7:0]). The integration time for each energy output is: SUM_SAMPS / 2520.6, where 2520.6 is the sample rate in Hz For example, SUM_SAMPS = 2100 establishes 2100 samples per accumulation cycle, which has a duration of 833 ms. After an accumulation cycle is completed, the XFER_BUSY interrupt signals to the MPU that accumulated data are available. The end of each multiplexer cycle is signaled to the MPU by the CE_BUSY interrupt. At the end of each multiplexer cycle, status information, such as sag data and the digitized input signal, is available to the MPU. Figure 13 shows the accumulation interval resulting from SUM_SAMPS = 2100, consisting of 2100 samples of 397 s each, followed by the XFER_BUSY interrupt. The sampling in this example is applied to a 50 Hz signal. There is no correlation between the line signal frequency and the choice of SUM_SAMPS. Furthermore, sampling does not have to start when the line voltage crosses the zero line, and the length of the accumulation interval need not be an integer multiple of the signal cycles. 833ms 20ms XFER_BUSY Interrupt to MPU Figure 13: Accumulation Interval Rev 5 29 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet IB VA IA 122.07 s 30.5 s 122.07 s 122.07 s Multiplexer Frame (13 x 30.518 s = 396.7 s -> 2520.6 Hz) MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3 Conversions Settle CK32 (32768 Hz) MUX STATE S 0 1 S 2 Figure 14: Samples from Multiplexer Cycle (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3) VB IB VA IA 91.5 s 91.5 s 91.5 s 30.5 s 91.5 s Multiplexer Frame (13 x 30.518 s = 396 s 2520Hz) MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4 Conversions Settle CK32 (32768 Hz) MUX STATE S 0 1 2 3 S Figure 15: Samples from Multiplexer Cycle (MUX_DIV[3:0] = 4) 30 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.4 80515 MPU Core The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G include an 80515 MPU (8-bit, 8051-compatible) that processes most instructions in one clock cycle. Using a 4.9 MHz clock results in a processing throughput of 4.9 MIPS. The 80515 architecture eliminates redundant bus states and implements parallel execution of fetch and execution phases. Normally, a machine cycle is aligned with a memory fetch, therefore, most of the 1-byte instructions are performed in a single machine cycle (MPU clock cycle). This leads to an 8x average performance improvement (in terms of MIPS) over the Intel 8051 device running at the same clock frequency. Table 9 shows the CKMPU frequency as a function of the MCK clock (19.6608 MHz) divided by the MPU clock divider which is set in the I/O RAM control field MPU_DIV[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2200[2:0]). Actual processor clocking speed can be adjusted to the total processing demand of the application (metering calculations, AMR management, memory management, LCD driver management and I/O management) using MPU_DIV[2:0], as shown in Table 9. Table 9: CKMPU Clock Frequencies MPU_DIV [2:0] 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 CKMPU Frequency 4.9152 MHz 2.4576 MHz 1.2288 MHz 614.4 kHz 307.2 kHz Typical measurement and metering functions based on the results provided by the internal 32-bit compute engine (CE) are available for the MPU as part of the Maxim standard library. Maxim provides demonstration source code to help reduce the design cycle. 2.4.1 Memory Organization and Addressing The 80515 MPU core incorporates the Harvard architecture with separate code and data spaces. Memory organization in the 80515 is similar to that of the industry standard 8051. There are three memory areas: Program memory (Flash, shared by MPU and CE), external RAM (Data RAM, shared by the CE and MPU, Configuration or I/O RAM), and internal data memory (Internal RAM). Table 10 shows the memory map. Program Memory The 80515 can address up to 64 KB of program memory space (0x0000 to 0xFFFF). Program memory is read when the MPU fetches instructions or performs a MOVC operation. After reset, the MPU starts program execution from program memory location 0x0000. The lower part of the program memory includes reset and interrupt vectors. The interrupt vectors are spaced at 8-byte intervals, starting from 0x0003. MPU External Data Memory (XRAM) Both internal and external memory is physically located on the 71M654x device. The external memory referred in this documentation is only external to the 80515 MPU core. 3 KB of RAM starting at address 0x0000 is shared by the CE and MPU. The CE normally uses the first 1 KB, leaving 2 KB for the MPU. Different versions of the CE code use varying amounts. Consult the documentation for the specific code version being used for the exact limit. If the MPU overwrites the CE's working RAM, the CE's output may be corrupted. If the CE is disabled, the first 0x40 bytes of RAM are still unusable while MUX_DIV[3:0] 0 because the 71M654x ADC writes to these locations. Setting MUX_DIV[3:0] = 0 disables the ADC output preventing the CE from writing the first 0x40 bytes of RAM. Rev 5 31 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet To change the slot assignments established by MUXn_SEL[3:0], first set MUX_DIV[3:0] to zero, then change the MUXn_SEL[3:0] slot assignments, and finally set MUX_DIV[3:0] to the number of active MUX frame slots. The 80515 writes into external data memory when the MPU executes a MOVX @Ri,A or MOVX @DPTR,A instruction. The MPU reads external data memory by executing a MOVX A,@Ri or MOVX A,@DPTR instruction (PDATA, SFR 0xBF, provides the upper 8 bytes for the MOVX A,@Ri instruction). Internal and External Memory Map Table 10 shows the address, type, use and size of the various memory components. Table 10: Memory Map Address (hex) 0000-7FFF Memory Technology Flash Memory Memory Type Typical Usage Memory Size (bytes) MPU Program and non-volatile data 128/64/32 KB CE program (on 1 KB boundary) 3 KB max. Name Program memory Non-volatile for MPU and CE 0000-0BFF Static RAM Volatile External RAM (XRAM) Shared by CE and MPU 5/3 KB 2000-27FF Static RAM Volatile Configuration RAM (I/O RAM) Hardware control 2 KB 2800-287F Static RAM Non-volatile (battery) Configuration RAM (I/O RAM) Battery-buffered memory 128 0000-00FF Static RAM Volatile Internal RAM Part of 80515 Core 256 Memory size depends on IC. See 2.5.1 Physical Memory for details. MOVX Addressing There are two types of instructions differing in whether they provide an 8-bit or 16-bit indirect address to the external data RAM. In the first type, MOVX A,@Ri, the contents of R0 or R1 in the current register bank provide the eight lower-ordered bits of address. The eight high-ordered bits of the address are specified with the PDATA SFR. This method allows the user paged access (256 pages of 256 bytes each) to all ranges of the external data RAM. In the second type of MOVX instruction, MOVX A,@DPTR, the data pointer generates a 16-bit address. This form is faster and more efficient when accessing very large data arrays (up to 64 KB), since no additional instructions are needed to set up the eight high ordered bits of the address. It is possible to mix the two MOVX types. This provides the user with four separate data pointers, two with direct access and two with paged access, to the entire external memory range. Dual Data Pointer The Dual Data Pointer accelerates the block moves of data. The standard DPTR is a 16-bit register that is used to address external memory or peripherals. In the 80515 core, the standard data pointer is called DPTR, the second data pointer is called DPTR1. The data pointer select bit, located in the LSB of the DPS register (DPS[0], SFR 0x92), chooses the active pointer. DPTR is selected when DPS[0] = 0 and DPTR1 is selected when DPS[0] = 1. The user switches between pointers by toggling the LSB of the DPS register. The values in the data pointers are not affected by the LSB of the DPS register. All DPTR related instructions use the currently selected DPTR for any activity. The second data pointer may not be supported by certain compilers. 32 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet DPTR1 is useful for copy routines, where it can make the inner loop of the routine two instructions faster compared to the reloading of DPTR from registers. Any interrupt routine using DPTR1 must save and restore DPS, DPTR and DPTR1, which increases stack usage and slows down interrupt latency. By selecting the R80515 core in the Keil compiler project settings and by using the compiler directive "MODC2", dual data pointers are enabled in certain library routines. An alternative data pointer is available in the form of the PDATA register (SFR 0xBF), sometimes referred to as USR2). It defines the high byte of a 16-bit address when reading or writing XDATA with the instruction MOVX A,@Ri or MOVX @Ri,A. Internal Data Memory Map and Access The Internal data memory provides 256 bytes (0x00 to 0xFF) of data memory. The internal data memory address is always 1 byte wide. Table 11 shows the internal data memory map. The Special Function Registers (SFR) occupy the upper 128 bytes. The SFR area of internal data memory is available only by direct addressing. Indirect addressing of this area accesses the upper 128 bytes of Internal RAM. The lower 128 bytes contain working registers and bit addressable memory. The lower 32 bytes form four banks of eight registers (R0-R7). Two bits on the program memory status word (PSW, SFR 0xD0 ) select which bank is in use. The next 16 bytes form a block of bit addressable memory space at addresses 0x00-0x7F. All the bytes in the lower 128 bytes are accessible through direct or indirect addressing. Table 11: Internal Data Memory Map Address Range 0x80 2.4.2 0xFF Direct Addressing Indirect Addressing Special Function Registers (SFRs) RAM 0x30 0x7F Byte addressable area 0x20 0x00 0x2F 0x1F Bit addressable area Register banks R0...R7 Special Function Registers (SFRs) A map of the Special Function Registers is shown in Table 12. Only a few addresses in the SFR memory space are occupied, the others are not implemented. A read access to unimplemented addresses returns undefined data, while a write access has no effect. SFRs specific to the 71M654x are shown in bold print on a shaded field. The registers at 0x80, 0x88, 0x90, etc., are bit addressable, all others are byte addressable. Table 12: Special Function Register Map Hex/ Bin F8 F0 E8 E0 D8 D0 C8 C0 B8 B0 A8 A0 Rev 5 Bit Addressable Byte Addressable X000 X001 FLAG1 B IFLAGS A WDCON PSW T2CON IRCON IEN1 P3 (DIO12:15) IEN0 P2 (DIO8:11) STAT IP1 IP0 X010 S0RELH FLSHCTL S0RELL X011 S1RELH X100 X101 REMOTE0 SPI1 X110 X111 PDATA FL_BANK PGADR Bin/ Hex FF F7 EF E7 DF D7 CF C7 BF B7 AF A7 33 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Bit Addressable Hex/ Bin X000 S0CON P1(DIO4:7) TCON P0 (DIO0:3) 98 90 88 80 2.4.3 Byte Addressable X001 S0BUF TMOD SP X010 IEN2 DPS TL0 DPL X011 S1CON TL1 DPH X100 S1BUF ERASE TH0 DPL1 X101 S1RELL TH1 DPH1 X110 X111 EEDATA EECTRL CKCON PCON Bin/ Hex 9F 97 8F 87 Generic 80515 Special Function Registers Table 13 shows the location, description and reset or power-up value of the generic 80515 SFRs. Additional descriptions of the registers can be found at the page numbers listed in the table. Table 13: Generic 80515 SFRs - Location and Reset Values Name P0 SP DPL DPH DPL1 DPH1 PCON TCON TMOD TL0 TL1 TH0 TH1 CKCON P1 DPS S0CON S0BUF IEN2 S1CON S1BUF S1RELL P2 IEN0 IP0 S0RELL P3 IEN1 IP1 S0RELH S1RELH PDATA IRCON 34 Address (Hex) 0x80 0x81 0x82 0x83 0x84 0x85 0x87 0x88 0x89 0x8A 0x8B 0x8C 0x8D 0x8E 0x90 0x92 0x98 0x99 0x9A 0x9B 0x9C 0x9D 0xA0 0xA8 0xA9 0xAA 0xB0 0xB8 0xB9 0xBA 0xBB 0xBF 0xC0 Reset value Description (Hex) 0xFF Port 0 0x07 Stack Pointer 0x00 Data Pointer Low 0 0x00 Data Pointer High 0 0x00 Data Pointer Low 1 0x00 Data Pointer High 1 0x00 UART Speed Control 0x00 Timer/Counter Control 0x00 Timer Mode Control 0x00 Timer 0, low byte 0x00 Timer 1, high byte 0x00 Timer 0, low byte 0x00 Timer 1, high byte 0x01 Clock Control (Stretch=1) 0xFF Port 1 0x00 Data Pointer select Register 0x00 Serial Port 0, Control Register 0x00 Serial Port 0, Data Buffer 0x00 Interrupt Enable Register 2 0x00 Serial Port 1, Control Register 0x00 Serial Port 1, Data Buffer 0x00 Serial Port 1, Reload Register, low byte 0xFF Port 2 0x00 Interrupt Enable Register 0 0x00 Interrupt Priority Register 0 0xD9 Serial Port 0, Reload Register, low byte 0xFF Port 3 0x00 Interrupt Enable Register 1 0x00 Interrupt Priority Register 1 0x03 Serial Port 0, Reload Register, high byte 0x03 Serial Port 1, Reload Register, high byte High address byte for MOVX@Ri - also called USR2 0x00 0x00 Interrupt Request Control Register Page 36 35 35 35 35 35 39 42 40 40 40 40 40 36 36 32 38 37 42 39 37 37 36 42 45 37 36 42 45 37 37 32 43 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name T2CON PSW WDCON A B Address (Hex) 0xC8 0xD0 0xD8 0xE0 0xF0 Reset value Description (Hex) 0x00 Polarity for INT2 and INT3 0x00 Program Status Word 0x00 Baud Rate Control Register (only WDCON[7] bit used) 0x00 Accumulator 0x00 B Register Page 43 35 37 35 35 Accumulator (ACC, A, SFR 0x E0): ACC is the accumulator register. Most instructions use the accumulator to hold the operand. The mnemonics for accumulator-specific instructions refer to accumulator as A, not ACC. B Register (SFR 0xF0): The B register is used during multiply and divide instructions. It can also be used as a scratch-pad register to hold temporary data. Program Status Word (PSW, SFR 0xD0 ): This register contains various flags and control bits for the selection of the register banks (see Table 14). Table 14: PSW Bit Functions (SFR 0xD0) PSW Bit Symbol 7 6 5 CV AC F0 Function Carry flag. Auxiliary Carry flag for BCD operations. General purpose Flag 0 available for user. F0 is not to be confused with the F0 flag in the CESTATUS register. 4 RS1 3 RS0 2 1 0 OV - P Register bank select control bits. The contents of RS1 and RS0 select the working register bank: Bank selected Location RS1/RS0 00 Bank 0 0x00 - 0x07 01 Bank 1 0x08 - 0x0F 10 Bank 2 0x10 - 0x17 11 Bank 3 0x18 - 0x1F Overflow flag. User defined flag. Parity flag, affected by hardware to indicate odd or even number of one bits in the Accumulator, i.e., even parity. Stack Pointer (SP, SFR 0x81): The stack pointer is a 1-byte register initialized to 0x07 after reset. This register is incremented before PUSH and CALL instructions, causing the stack to begin at location 0x08. Data Pointer: The data pointers (DPTR and DPRT1) are 2 bytes wide. The lower part is DPL (SFR 0x82) and DPL1 (SFR 0x84), respectively. The highest is DPH (SFR 0x83) and DPH1 (SFR 0x85), respectively. The data pointers can be loaded as two registers (e.g., MOV DPL,#data8). They are generally used to access external code or data space (e.g., MOVC A,@A+DPTR or MOVX A,@DPTR respectively). Program Counter: The program counter (PC) is 2 bytes wide and initialized to 0x0000 after reset. This register is incremented when fetching operation code or when operating on data from program memory. Rev 5 35 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Port Registers: SEGDIO0 through SEGDIO15 are controlled by Special Function Registers P0, P1, P2 and P3 as shown in Table 15. Above SEGDIO15, the LCD_SEGDIOn[ ] registers in I/O RAM are used. Since the direction bits are contained in the upper nibble of each SFR Pn register and the DIO bits are contained in the lower nibble, it is possible to configure the direction of a given DIO pin and set its output value with a single write operation, thus facilitating the implementation of bit-banged interfaces. Writing a 1 to a DIO_DIR bit configures the corresponding DIO as an output, while writing a 0 configures it as an input. Writing a 1 to a DIO bit causes the corresponding pin to be at high level (V3P3), while writing a 0 causes the corresponding pin to be held at a low level (GND). See 2.5.8 Digital I/O for additional details. Table 15: Port Registers (SEGDIO0-15) SFR Name SFR Address P0 P1 P2 P3 0x80 0x90 0xA0 0xB0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 DIO_DIR[3:0] DIO_DIR[7:4] DIO_DIR[11:8] DIO_DIR[15:12] D1 D0 DIO[3:0] DIO[7:4] DIO[11:8] DIO[15:11] Ports P0-P3 on the chip are bi-directional and control SEGDIO0-15. Each port consists of a Latch (SFR P0 to P3), an output driver and an input buffer, therefore the MPU can output or read data through any of these ports. Even if a DIO pin is configured as an output, the state of the pin can still be read by the MPU, for example when counting pulses issued via DIO pins that are under CE control. At power-up SEGDIO0-15 are configured as outputs, but the pins are in a high-impedance state because PORT_E=0 (I/O RAM 0x270C[5]). Host firmware should first configure SEGDIO0-15 to the desired state, then set PORT_E=1 to enable the function. Clock Stretching (CKCON) The three low order bits of the CKCON[2:0] (SFR 0x8E) register define the stretch memory cycles that are used for MOVX instructions when accessing external peripherals. The practical value of this register for the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G is to guarantee access to XRAM between CE, MPU, and SPI. Table 16 shows how the signals of the External Memory Interface change when stretch values are set from 0 to 7. The widths of the signals are counted in MPU clock cycles. The post-reset state of the CKCON[2:0] (001), which is shown in bold in the table, performs the MOVX instructions with a stretch value equal to 1. Table 16: Stretch Memory Cycle Width 36 Read Signal Width Write Signal Width CKCON[2:0] Stretch Value memaddr memrd memaddr memwr 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.4.4 Instruction Set All instructions of the generic 8051 microcontroller are supported. A complete list of the instruction set and of the associated op-codes is contained in the 71M654X Software User's Guide (SUG). 2.4.5 UARTs The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G include a UART (UART0) that can be programmed to communicate with a variety of AMR modules and other external devices. A second UART (UART1) is connected to the optical port, as described in 2.5.7 UART and Optical Interface. The UARTs are dedicated 2-wire serial interfaces, which can communicate with an external host processor at up to 38,400 bits/s (with MPU clock = 1.2288 MHz). The operation of the RX and TX UART0 pins is as follows: * * UART0 RX: Serial input data are applied at this pin. Conforming to RS-232 standard, the bytes are input LSB first. UART0 TX: This pin is used to output the serial data. The bytes are output LSB first. Several UART-related registers are available for the control and buffering of serial data. A single SFR register serves as both the transmit buffer and receive buffer (S0BUF, SFR 0x99 for UART0 and S1BUF, SFR 0x9C for UART1). When written by the MPU, SxBUF acts as the transmit buffer, and when read by the MPU, it acts as the receive buffer. Writing data to the transmit buffer starts the transmission by the associated UART. Received data are available by reading from the receive buffer. Both UARTs can simultaneously transmit and receive data. WDCON[7] (SFR 0xD8) selects whether timer 1 or the internal baud rate generator is used. All UART transfers are programmable for parity enable, parity, 2 stop bits/1 stop bit and XON/XOFF options for variable communication baud rates from 300 to 38400 bps. Table 17 shows how the baud rates are calculated. Table 18 shows the selectable UART operation modes. Table 17: Baud Rate Generation Using Timer 1 (WDCON[7] = 0) smod UART0 2 UART1 N/A * fCKMPU/ (384 * (256-TH1)) Using Internal Baud Rate Generator (WDCON[7] = 1) smod 2 10 * fCKMPU/(64 * (2 -S0REL)) 10 fCKMPU/(32 * (2 -S1REL)) S0REL and S1REL are 10-bit values derived by combining bits from the respective timer reload registers. (S0RELL, S0RELH, S1RELL, S1RELH are SFR 0xAA, SFR 0xBA, SFR 0x9D and SFR 0xBB, respectively) SMOD is the SMOD bit in the SFR PCON register (SFR 0x87). TH1(SFR 0x8D) is the high byte of timer 1. Table 18: UART Modes UART 0 Mode 0 Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 N/A Start bit, 8 data bits, stop bit, variable baud rate (internal baud rate generator or timer 1) Start bit, 8 data bits, parity, stop bit, fixed baud rate 1/32 or 1/64 of fCKMPU Start bit, 8 data bits, parity, stop bit, variable baud rate (internal baud rate generator or timer 1) UART 1 Start bit, 8 data bits, parity, stop bit, variable baud rate (internal baud rate generator) Start bit, 8 data bits, stop bit, variable baud rate (internal baud rate generator) N/A N/A Parity of serial data is available through the P flag of the accumulator. 7-bit serial modes with parity, such as those used by the FLAG protocol, can be simulated by setting and reading bit 7 of Rev 5 37 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 8-bit output data. 7-bit serial modes without parity can be simulated by setting bit 7 to a constant th 1. 8-bit serial modes with parity can be simulated by setting and reading the 9 bit, using the control bits TB80 (S0CON[3]) and TB81 (S1CON[3]) in the S0CON (SFR 0x98) and S1CON (SFR 0x9B) registers for transmit and RB81 bit in S1CON[2] for receive operations. The feature of receiving 9 bits (Mode 3 for UART0, Mode A for UART1) can be used as handshake signals for inter-processor communication in multi-processor systems. In this case, the slave processors have bit SM20 (S0CON[5]) for UART0, or SM21 (S1CON[5] for UART1, set to 1. When the master processor outputs th the slave's address, it sets the 9 bit to 1, causing a serial port receive interrupt in all the slaves. The slave processors compare the received byte with their address. If there is a match, the addressed slave clears SM20 or SM21 and receive the rest of the message. The rest of the slave's ignores the th message. After addressing the slave, the host outputs the rest of the message with the 9 bit set to 0, so no additional serial port receive interrupts are generated. UART Control Registers: The functions of UART0 and UART1 depend on the setting of the Serial Port Control Registers S0CON and S1CON shown in Table 19 and Table 20, respectively, and the PCON register shown in Table 21. Since the TI0, RI0, TI1 and RI1 bits are in an SFR bit addressable byte, common practice would be to clear them with a bit operation, but this must be avoided. The hardware implements bit operations as a byte wide read-modify-write hardware macro. If an interrupt occurs after the read, but before the write, its flag is cleared unintentionally. The proper way to clear these flag bits is to write a byte mask consisting of all ones except for a zero in the location of the bit to be cleared. The flag bits are configured in hardware to ignore ones written to them. Table 19: The S0CON (UART0) Register (SFR 0x98) Bit S0CON[7] Symbol SM0 S0CON[6] SM1 S0CON[5] S0CON[4] S0CON[3] SM20 REN0 TB80 S0CON[2] RB80 S0CON[1] TI0 S0CON[0] RI0 38 Function The SM0 and SM1 bits set the UART0 mode: Mode Description SM0 SM1 0 N/A 0 0 1 8-bit UART 0 1 2 9-bit UART 1 0 3 9-bit UART 1 1 Enables the inter-processor communication feature. If set, enables serial reception. Cleared by software to disable reception. The 9th transmitted data bit in Modes 2 and 3. Set or cleared by the MPU, depending on the function it performs (parity check, multiprocessor communication etc.) th In Modes 2 and 3 it is the 9 data bit received. In Mode 1, SM20 is 0, RB80 is the stop bit. In mode 0, this bit is not used. Must be cleared by software. Transmit interrupt flag; set by hardware after completion of a serial transfer. Must be cleared by software (see Caution above). Receive interrupt flag; set by hardware after completion of a serial reception. Must be cleared by software (see Caution above). Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 20: The S1CON (UART1) Register (SFR 0x9B) Bit S1CON[7] Symbol Function Sets the baud rate and mode for UART1. SM SM 0 1 S1CON[5] S1CON[4] S1CON[3] SM21 REN1 TB81 S1CON[2] RB81 S1CON[1] TI1 S1CON[0] RI1 Mode A B Description 9-bit UART 8-bit UART Baud Rate variable variable Enables the inter-processor communication feature. If set, enables serial reception. Cleared by software to disable reception. th The 9 transmitted data bit in Mode A. Set or cleared by the MPU, depending on the function it performs (parity check, multiprocessor communication etc.) th In Modes A and B, it is the 9 data bit received. In Mode B, if SM21 is 0, RB81 is the stop bit. Must be cleared by software Transmit interrupt flag, set by hardware after completion of a serial transfer. Must be cleared by software (see Caution above). Receive interrupt flag, set by hardware after completion of a serial reception. Must be cleared by software (see Caution above). Table 21: PCON Register Bit Description (SFR 0x87) Bit PCON[7] 2.4.6 Symbol SMOD Function The SMOD bit doubles the baud rate when set Timers and Counters The 80515 has two 16-bit timer/counter registers: Timer 0 and Timer 1. These registers can be configured for counter or timer operations. In timer mode, the register is incremented every machine cycle, i.e., it counts up once for every 12 periods of the MPU clock. In counter mode, the register is incremented when the falling edge is observed at the corresponding input signal T0 or T1 (T0 and T1 are the timer gating inputs derived from certain DIO pins, see 2.5.8 Digital I/O). Since it takes 2 machine cycles to recognize a 1-to-0 event, the maximum input count rate is 1/2 of the clock frequency (CKMPU). There are no restrictions on the duty cycle, however to ensure proper recognition of the 0 or 1 state, an input should be stable for at least 1 machine cycle. Four operating modes can be selected for Timer 0 and Timer 1, as shown in Table 22 and Table 23. The TMOD (SFR 0x89) Register, shown in Table 24, is used to select the appropriate mode. The timer/counter operation is controlled by the TCON (SFR 0x88) Register, which is shown in Table 25. Bits TR1 (TCON[6]) and TR0 (TCON[4]) in the TCON register start their associated timers when set. Rev 5 39 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 22: Timers/Counters Mode Description M1 M0 Mode 0 0 Mode 0 0 1 1 0 Mode 1 Mode 2 1 1 Mode 3 Function 13-bit Counter/Timer mode with 5 lower bits in the TL0 or TL1 (SFR 0x8A or SFR 0x8B) register and the remaining 8 bits in the TH0 or TH1 (SFR 0x8C or SFR 0x8D) register (for Timer 0 and Timer 1, respectively). The 3 high order bits of TL0 and TL1 are held at zero. 16-bit Counter/Timer mode. 8-bit auto-reload Counter/Timer. The reload value is kept in TH0 or TH1, while TL0 or TL1 is incremented every machine cycle. When TL(x) overflows, a value from TH(x) is copied to TL(x) (where x is 0 for counter/timer 0 or 1 for counter/timer 1. If Timer 1 M1 and M0 bits are set to 1, Timer 1 stops. If Timer 0 M1 and M0 bits are set to 1, Timer 0 acts as two independent 8-bit Timer/Counters. In Mode 3, TL0 is affected by TR0 and gate control bits, and sets the TF0 flag on overflow, while TH0 is affected by the TR1 bit, and the TF1 flag is set on overflow. Table 23 specifies the combinations of operation modes allowed for Timer 0 and Timer 1. Table 23: Allowed Timer/Counter Mode Combinations Timer 1 Timer 0 - mode 0 Timer 0 - mode 1 Timer 0 - mode 2 Mode 0 Mode 1 Mode 2 Yes Yes Not allowed Yes Yes Not allowed Yes Yes Yes Table 24: TMOD Register Bit Description (SFR 0x89) Bit Symbol Function Timer/Counter 1 TMOD[7] Gate If TMOD[7] is set, external input signal control is enabled for Counter 1. The TR1 bit in the TCON register (SFR 0x88) must also be set in order for Counter 1 to increment. With these settings, Counter 1 increments on every falling edge of the logic signal applied to one or more of the SEGDIO2-11 pins, as specified by the contents of the DIO_R2 through DIO_R11 registers. See 2.5.8 Digital I/O and LCD Segment Drivers and Table 47. TMOD[6] C/T Selects timer or counter operation. When set to 1, a counter operation is performed. When cleared to 0, the corresponding register functions as a timer. TMOD[5:4] M1:M0 Selects the mode for Timer/Counter 1, as shown in Table 22. Timer/Counter 0: TMOD[3] Gate If TMOD[3] is set, external input signal control is enabled for Counter 0. The TR0 bit in the TCON register (SFR 0x88) must also be set in order for Counter 0 to increment. With these settings, Counter 0 is incremented on every falling edge of the logic signal applied to one or more of the SEGDIO2-11 pins, as specified by the contents of the DIO_R2 through DIO_R11 registers. See 2.5.8 Digital I/O and LCD Segment Drivers and Table 47. TMOD[2] C/T Selects timer or counter operation. When set to 1, a counter operation is performed. When cleared to 0, the corresponding register functions as a timer. TMOD[1:0] M1:M0 Selects the mode for Timer/Counter 0 as shown in Table 22. 40 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 25: The TCON Register Bit Functions (SFR 0x88) Bit TCON[7] TCON[6] TCON[5] TCON[4] TCON[3] TCON[2] TCON[1] TCON[0] 2.4.7 Symbol Function TF1 The Timer 1 overflow flag is set by hardware when Timer 1 overflows. This flag can be cleared by software and is automatically cleared when an interrupt is processed. TR1 Timer 1 run control bit. If cleared, Timer 1 stops. TF0 Timer 0 overflow flag set by hardware when Timer 0 overflows. This flag can be cleared by software and is automatically cleared when an interrupt is processed. TR0 Timer 0 Run control bit. If cleared, Timer 0 stops. IE1 Interrupt 1 edge flag is set by hardware when the falling edge on external pin int1 is observed. Cleared when an interrupt is processed. IT1 Interrupt 1 type control bit. Selects either the falling edge or low level on input pin to cause an interrupt. IE0 Interrupt 0 edge flag is set by hardware when the falling edge on external pin int0 is observed. Cleared when an interrupt is processed. IT0 Interrupt 0 type control bit. Selects either the falling edge or low level on input pin to cause interrupt. WD Timer (Software Watchdog Timer) There is no internal software watchdog timer. Use the standard hardware watchdog timer instead (see 2.5.11 Hardware Watchdog Timer). 2.4.8 Interrupts The 80515 provides 11 interrupt sources with four priority levels. Each source has its own interrupt request flag(s) located in a special function register (TCON, IRCON, and SCON). Each interrupt requested by the corresponding interrupt flag can be individually enabled or disabled by the interrupt enable bits in the IEN0 (SFR 0xA8), IEN1 (SFR 0xB8), and IEN2 (SFR 0x9A). Figure 16 shows the device interrupt structure. Referring to Figure 16, interrupt sources can originate from within the 80515 MPU core (referred to as Internal Sources) or can originate from other parts of the 71M654x SoC (referred to as External Sources). There are seven external interrupt sources, as seen in the leftmost part of Figure 16, and in Table 26 and Table 27 (i.e., EX0-EX6). Interrupt Overview When an interrupt occurs, the MPU vectors to the predetermined address as shown in Table 38. Once the interrupt service has begun, it can be interrupted only by a higher priority interrupt. The interrupt service is terminated by a return from interrupt instruction, RETI. When a RETI instruction is performed, the processor returns to the instruction that would have been next when the interrupt occurred. When the interrupt condition occurs, the processor also indicates this by setting a flag bit. This bit is set regardless of whether the interrupt is enabled or disabled. Each interrupt flag is sampled once per machine cycle, and then samples are polled by the hardware. If the sample indicates a pending interrupt when the interrupt is enabled, then the interrupt request flag is set. On the next instruction cycle, the interrupt is acknowledged by hardware forcing an LCALL to the appropriate vector address, if the following conditions are met: * * * No interrupt of equal or higher priority is already in progress. An instruction is currently being executed and is not completed. The instruction in progress is not RETI or any write access to the registers IEN0, IEN1, IEN2, IP0 or IP1. Special Function Registers for Interrupts The following SFR registers control the interrupt functions: * * * * The interrupt enable registers: IEN0, IEN1 and IEN2 (see Table 26, Table 27 and Table 28). The Timer/Counter control registers, TCON and T2CON (see Table 29 and Table 30). The interrupt request register, IRCON (see Table 31). Rev 5 41 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet * The interrupt priority registers: IP0 and IP1 (see Table 36). Table 26: The IEN0 Bit Functions (SFR 0xA8) Bit IEN0[7] IEN0[6] IEN0[5] IEN0[4] IEN0[3] IEN0[2] IEN0[1] IEN0[0] Symbol EAL - - ES0 ET1 EX1 ET0 EX0 Function EAL = 0 disables all interrupts. Not used. Not used. ES0 = 0 disables serial channel 0 interrupt. ET1 = 0 disables timer 1 overflow interrupt. EX1 = 0 disables external interrupt 1: DIO status change ET0 = 0 disables timer 0 overflow interrupt. EX0 = 0 disables external interrupt 0: DIO status change Table 27: The IEN1 Bit Functions (SFR 0xB8) Bit IEN1[7] IEN1[6] IEN1[5] IEN1[4] IEN1[3] IEN1[2] IEN1[1] IEN1[0] Bit IEN2[0] Symbol - - EX6 Function Not used. Not used. EX6 = 0 disables external interrupt 6: XFER_BUSY, RTC_1S, RTC_1M or RTC_T EX5 EX5 = 0 disables external interrupt 5: EEPROM or SPI EX4 EX4 = 0 disables external interrupt 4: VSTAT EX3 EX3 = 0 disables external interrupt 3: CE_BUSY EX2 EX2 = 0 disables external interrupt 2: XPULSE, YPULSE, WPULSE or VPULSE - Not used. Table 28: The IEN2 Bit Functions (SFR 0x9A) Symbol ES1 Function ES1 = 0 disables the serial channel 1 interrupt. Table 29: TCON Bit Functions (SFR 0x88) 42 Bit TCON[7] TCON[6] TCON[5] TCON[4] TCON[3] TCON[2] Symbol TF1 TR1 TF0 TR0 IE1 IT1 TCON[1] TCON[0] IE0 IT0 Function Timer 1 overflow flag. Not used for interrupt control. Timer 0 overflow flag. Not used for interrupt control. External interrupt 1 flag: DIO status changed External interrupt 1 type control bit: 0 = interrupt on low level. 1 = interrupt on falling edge. External interrupt 0 flag: DIO status changed External interrupt 0 type control bit: 0 = interrupt on low level. 1 = interrupt on falling edge. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 30: The T2CON Bit Functions (SFR 0xC8) Bit T2CON[7] T2CON[6] Symbol - I3FR T2CON[5] I2FR T2CON[4:0] - Function Not used. Polarity control for external interrupt 3: CE_BUSY 0 = falling edge. 1 = rising edge. Polarity control for external interrupt 2: XPULSE, YPULSE, WPULSE and VPULSE 0 = falling edge. 1 = rising edge. Not used. Table 31: The IRCON Bit Functions (SFR 0xC0) Bit IRCON[7] Symbol - Function Not used IRCON[6] - Not used IRCON[5] IEX6 IRCON[4] IEX5 IRCON[3] IEX4 IRCON[2] IEX3 IRCON[1] IEX2 IRCON[0] - 1 = External interrupt 6 flag: XFER_BUSY, RTC_1S, RTC_1M or RTC_T 1 = External interrupt 5 flag: EEPROM or SPI 1 = External interrupt 4 flag: VSTAT 1 = External interrupt 3 flag: CE_BUSY 1 = External interrupt 2 flag: XPULSE, YPULSE, WPULSE or VPULSE Not used. TF0 and TF1 (Timer 0 and Timer 1 overflow flags) are automatically cleared by hardware when the service routine is called (Signals T0ACK and T1ACK - port ISR - active high when the service routine is called). IE0, IE1 and IEX2-IEX6 are cleared automatically when hardware causes execution to vector to the interrupt service routine. Rev 5 43 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet External MPU Interrupts The seven external interrupts are the interrupts external to the 80515 core, i.e., signals that originate in other parts of the 71M654x, for example the CE, DIO, RTC, or EEPROM interface. The external interrupts are connected as shown in Table 32. The polarity of interrupts 2 and 3 is programmable in the MPU via the I3FR and I2FR bits in T2CON (SFR 0xC8). Interrupts 2 and 3 should be programmed for falling sensitivity (I3FR = I2FR = 0). The generic 8051 MPU literature states that interrupts 4 through 6 are defined as rising-edge sensitive. Thus, the hardware signals attached to interrupts 5 and 6 are inverted to achieve the edge polarity shown in Table 32. Table 32: External MPU Interrupts External Interrupt 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Connection Digital I/O (IE0) Digital I/O (IE1) CE_PULSE (IE_XPULSE, IE_YPULSE, IE_WPULSE, IE_VPULSE) CE_BUSY (IE3) VSTAT (VSTAT[2:0] changed) (IE4) EEPROM busy (falling), SPI (rising) (IE_EEX, IE_SPI) XFER_BUSY (falling), RTC_1SEC, RTC_1MIN, RTC_T (IE_XFER, IE_RTC1S, IE_RTC1M, IE_RTCT) Polarity Flag Reset see 2.5.8 see 2.5.8 automatic automatic rising manual falling rising -- automatic automatic manual falling manual External interrupt 0 and 1 can be mapped to pins on the device using DIO resource maps. See 2.5.8 Digital I/O for more information. SFR enable bits must be set to permit any of these interrupts to occur. Likewise, each interrupt has its own flag bit, which is set by the interrupt hardware, and reset by the MPU interrupt handler. XFER_BUSY, RTC_1SEC, RTC_1MIN, RTC_T, SPI, PLLRISE and PLLFALL have their own enable and flag bits in addition to the interrupt 6, 4 and enable and flag bits (see Table 33: Interrupt Enable and Flag Bits). IE0 through IEX6 are cleared automatically when the hardware vectors to the interrupt handler. The other flags, IE_XFER through IE_VPULSE, are cleared by writing a zero to them. Since these bits are in an SFR bit addressable byte, common practice would be to clear them with a bit operation, but this must be avoided. The hardware implements bit operations as a byte wide read-modify-write hardware macro. If an interrupt occurs after the read, but before the write, its flag cleared unintentionally. The proper way to clear the flag bits is to write a byte mask consisting of all ones except for a zero in the location of the bit to be cleared. The flag bits are configured in hardware to ignore ones written to them. 44 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 33: Interrupt Enable and Flag Bits Interrupt Enable Name EX0 EX1 EX2 EX3 EX4 EX5 EX6 EX_XFER EX_RTC1S EX_RTC1M EX_RTCT EX_SPI EX_EEX EX_XPULSE EX_YPULSE EX_WPULSE EX_VPULSE Interrupt Flag Location SFR 0xA8[[0] SFR 0xA8[2] SFR 0xB8[1] SFR 0xB8[2] SFR 0xB8[3] SFR 0xB8[4] SFR 0xB8[5] 0x2700[0] 0x2700[1] 0x2700[2] 0x2700[4] 0x2701[7] 0x2700[7] 0x2700[6] 0x2700[5] 0x2701[6] 0x2701[5] Name IE0 IE1 IEX2 IEX3 IEX4 IEX5 IEX6 IE_XFER IE_RTC1S IE_RTC1M IE_RTCT IE_SPI IE_EEX IE_XPULSE IE_YPULSE IE_WPULSE IE_VPULSE Location SFR 0x88[1] SFR 0x88[3] SFR 0xC0[1] SFR 0xC0[2] SFR 0xC0[3] SFR 0xC0[4] SFR 0xC0[5] SFR 0xE8[0] SFR 0xE8[1] SFR E0x8[2] SFR 0xE8[4] SFR 0xF8[7] SFR 0xE8[7] SFR 0xE8[6] SFR 0xE8[5] SFR 0xF8[6] SFR 0xF8[5] Interrupt Description External interrupt 0 External interrupt 1 External interrupt 2 External interrupt 3 External interrupt 4 External interrupt 5 External interrupt 6 XFER_BUSY interrupt (int 6) RTC_1SEC interrupt (int 6) RTC_1MIN interrupt (int 6) RTC_T alarm clock interrupt (int 6) SPI interrupt EEPROM interrupt CE_XPULSE interrupt (int 2) CE_YPULSE interrupt (int 2) CE_WPULSE interrupt (int 2) CE_VPULSE interrupt (int 2) Interrupt Priority Level Structure All interrupt sources are combined in groups, as shown in Table 34. Table 34: Interrupt Priority Level Groups Group 0 1 2 3 4 5 Group Members External interrupt 0 Timer 0 interrupt External interrupt 1 Timer 1 interrupt Serial channel 0 interrupt -- Serial channel 1 interrupt External interrupt 2 External interrupt 3 External interrupt 4 External interrupt 5 External interrupt 6 Each group of interrupt sources can be programmed individually to one of four priority levels (as shown in Table 35) by setting or clearing one bit in the SFR interrupt priority register IP0 (SFR 0xA9) and one in IP1 (SFR 0xB9) (Table 36). If requests of the same priority level are received simultaneously, an internal polling sequence as shown in Table 37 determines which request is serviced first. Changing interrupt priorities while interrupts are enabled can easily cause software defects. It is best to set the interrupt priority registers only once during initialization before interrupts are enabled. Table 35: Interrupt Priority Levels Rev 5 IP1[x] IP0[x] 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Priority Level Level 0 (lowest) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 (highest) 45 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 36: Interrupt Priority Registers (IP0 and IP1) Register Address Bit 7 (MSB) Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 (LSB) IP0 IP1 SFR 0xA9 SFR 0xB9 - - - - IP0[5] IP1[5] IP0[4] IP1[4] IP0[3] IP1[3] IP0[2] IP1[2] IP0[1] IP1[1] IP0[0] IP1[0] External interrupt 0 Serial channel 1 interrupt Timer 0 interrupt External interrupt 2 External interrupt 1 External interrupt 3 Timer 1 interrupt External interrupt 4 Serial channel 0 interrupt External interrupt 5 External interrupt 6 Polling sequence Table 37: Interrupt Polling Sequence Interrupt Sources and Vectors Table 38 shows the interrupts with their associated flags and vector addresses. Table 38: Interrupt Vectors Interrupt Request Flag IE0 TF0 IE1 TF1 RI0/TI0 RI1/TI1 IEX2 IEX3 IEX4 IEX5 IEX6 46 Description External interrupt 0 Timer 0 interrupt External interrupt 1 Timer 1 interrupt Serial channel 0 interrupt Serial channel 1 interrupt External interrupt 2 External interrupt 3 External interrupt 4 External interrupt 5 External interrupt 6 Interrupt Vector Address 0x0003 0x000B 0x0013 0x001B 0x0023 0x0083 0x004B 0x0053 0x005B 0x0063 0x006B Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Figure 16: Interrupt Structure Rev 5 47 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.5 On-Chip Resources 2.5.1 Physical Memory 2.5.1.1 Flash Memory The device includes 128KB (71M6541G, 71M6542G), 64KB (71M6542F, 71M6541F) or 32KB (71M6541D) of on-chip flash memory. The flash memory primarily contains MPU and CE program code. It also contains images of the CE RAM and I/O RAM. On power-up, before enabling the CE, the MPU copies these images to their respective locations. Flash space allocated for the CE program is limited to 4096 16-bit words (8 KB). The CE program must begin on a 1-KB boundary of the flash address space. The CE_LCTN[5:0] field (I/O RAM 0x2109[5:0]) defines which 1 KB boundary contains the CE code. Thus, the first CE instruction is located at 1024*CE_LCTN[5:0]. Flash memory can be accessed by the MPU, the CE, and by the SPI interface (R/W). Table 39: Flash Memory Access Access by Access Type MPU CE SPI R/W/E R R/W/E Condition W/E only if CE is disabled. Access only when SFM is invoked (MPU halted). Flash Write Procedures If the FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2702[7:4] key is correctly programmed, the MPU may write to the flash memory. This is one of the non-volatile storage options available to the user in addition to external EEPROM. The flash program write enable bit, FLSH_PWE (SFR 0xB2[0]), differentiates 80515 data store instructions (MOVX@DPTR,A) between Flash and XRAM writes. This bit is automatically cleared by hardware after each byte write operation. Write operations to this bit are inhibited when interrupts are enabled. If the CE bit is enabled (CE_E = 1, I/O RAM 0x2106[0]), flash write operations must not be attempted unless FLSH_PSTWR (SFR 0xB2[2]) is set. This bit enables the "posted flash write" capability. FLSH_PSTWR has no effect when CE_E = 0). When CE_E = 1, however, FLSH_PSTWR delays a flash write until the time interval between the CE code passes. During this delay time, the FLSH_PEND bit (SFR 0xB2[3]) is high, and the MPU continues to execute commands. When the CE code pass ends (CE_BUSY falls), the FLSH_PEND bit falls and the write operation occurs. The MPU can query the FLSH_PEND bit to determine when the write operation has been completed. While FLSH_PEND = 1, further flash write requests are ignored. Updating Individual Bytes in Flash Memory The original state of a flash byte is 0xFF (all bits are 1). Once a value other than 0xFF is written to a flash memory cell, overwriting with a different value usually requires that the cell be erased first. Since cells cannot be erased individually, the page has to be copied to RAM, followed by a page erase. After this, the page can be updated in RAM and then written back to the flash memory. Flash Erase Procedures Flash erasure is initiated by writing a specific data pattern to specific SFR registers in the proper sequence. These special pattern/sequence requirements prevent inadvertent erasure of the flash memory. The mass erase sequence is: * * Write 1 to the FLSH_MEEN bit (SFR 0xB2[1]). Write the pattern 0xAA to the FLSH_ERASE register (SFR 0x94). The mass erase cycle can only be initiated when the ICE port is enabled. 48 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The page erase sequence is: * * Write the page address to FLSH_PGADR[5:0] (SFR 0xB7[7:2]). Write the pattern 0x55 to the FLSH_ERASE register (SFR 0x94). Program Security When enabled, the security feature limits the ICE to global flash erase operations only. All other ICE operations are blocked. This guarantees the security of the user's MPU and CE program code. Security is enabled by MPU code that is executed in a 64 CKMPU cycle pre-boot interval before the primary boot sequence begins. Once security is enabled, the only way to disable it is to perform a global erase of the flash, followed by a chip reset. The first 64 cycles of the MPU boot code are called the pre-boot phase because during this phase the ICE is inhibited. A read-only status bit, PREBOOT (SFR 0xB2[7]), identifies these cycles to the MPU. Upon completion of pre-boot, the ICE can be enabled and is permitted to take control of the MPU. The security enable bit, SECURE (SFR 0xB2[6]), is reset whenever the chip is reset. Hardware associated with the bit permits only ones to be written to it. Thus, pre-boot code may set SECURE to enable the security feature but may not reset it. Once SECURE is set, the pre-boot code is protected and no external read of program code is possible. Specifically, when the SECURE bit is set, the following applies: * * * The ICE is limited to bulk flash erase only. Page zero of flash memory, the preferred location for the user's pre-boot code, may not be page-erased by either MPU or ICE. Page zero may only be erased with global flash erase. Write operations to page zero, whether by MPU or ICE are inhibited. The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G also include hardware to protect against unintentional Flash write and erase. To enable flash write and erase operations, a 4-bit hardware key that must be written to the FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] field. The key is the binary number `0010'. If FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] is not `0010', the Flash erase and write operation is inhibited by hardware. Proper operation of this security key requires that there be no firmware function that writes `0010' to FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0]. The key should be written by the external SPI master, in the case of SPI flash programming (SFM mode), or through the ICE interface in the case of ICE flash programming. When a boot loader is used, the key should be sent to the boot load code which then writes it to FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0]. FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] is not automatically reset. It should be cleared when the SPI or ICE has finished changing the Flash. Table 40 summarizes the I/O RAM registers used for flash security. Table 40: Flash Security Name FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] Location Rst Wk 2702[7:4] 0 0 SECURE SFR B2[6] 0 0 Dir Description R/W Must be a 2 to enable any flash modification. See the description of Flash security for more details. R/W Inhibits erasure of page 0 and flash addresses above the beginning of CE code as defined by CE_LCTN[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2109[5:0]). Also inhibits the read of flash via the ICE and SPI ports. SPI Flash Mode In normal operation, the SPI slave interface cannot read or write the flash memory. However, the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G contain a Special Flash Mode (SFM) that facilitates initial (production) programming of the flash memory. When the 71M654x is in SFM mode, the SPI interface can erase, read, and write the flash. Other memory elements such as XRAM and I/O RAM are not accessible to the SPI in this mode. In order to protect the flash contents, several operations are required before the SFM mode is successfully invoked. Rev 5 49 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet While operating in SPI Flash Mode (SFM), SPI single-byte transactions are used to write to FL_BANK[1:0]. During an SPI single-byte transaction, SPI_CMD[1:0] will overwrite the contents of FL_BANK[1:0]. This will allow for access of the entire 128 KB Flash memory while operating in SFM on the 71M6541G/71M6542G. If the SPI port is used for code updates (in lieu of a programmer that uses the ICE port), then a code that disables the flash access via SPI can potentially lock out flash program updates. Details on the SFM are in 2.5.10 (SPI Slave Port). 2.5.1.2 MPU/CE RAM The 71M6541D includes 3 KB of static RAM memory on-chip (XRAM) plus 256 bytes of internal RAM in the MPU core. The 71M6541D/F/G and the 71M6542F/G include 5 KB of static RAM memory on-chip (XRAM) plus 256 bytes of internal RAM in the MPU core. The static RAM is used for data storage for both MPU and CE operations. 2.5.1.3 I/O RAM (Configuration RAM) The I/O RAM can be seen as a series of hardware registers that control basic hardware functions. I/O RAM address space starts at 0x2000. The registers of the I/O RAM are listed in Table 74. The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G include 128 bytes non-volatile RAM memory on-chip in the I/O RAM address space (addresses 0x2800 to 0x287F). This memory section is supported by the voltage applied at VBAT_RTC and the data in it are preserved in BRN, LCD, and SLP modes as long as the voltage at VBAT_RTC is within specification. 2.5.2 Oscillator The oscillator drives a standard 32.768 kHz watch crystal. This type of crystal is accurate and does not require a high-current oscillator circuit. The oscillator has been designed specifically to handle watch crystals and is compatible with their high impedance and limited power handling capability. The oscillator power dissipation is very low to maximize the lifetime of any battery attached to VBAT_RTC. Oscillator calibration can improve the accuracy of both the RTC and metering. Refer to 2.5.4, Real-Time Clock (RTC) for more information. The oscillator is powered from the V3P3SYS pin or from the VBAT_RTC pin, depending on the V3OK internal bit (i.e., V3OK = 1 if V3P3SYS 2.8 VDC and V3OK = 0 if V3P3SYS < 2.8 VDC). The oscillator requires approximately 100 nA, which is negligible compared to the internal leakage of a battery. 2.5.3 PLL and Internal Clocks Timing for the device is derived from the 32.768 kHz crystal oscillator output that is multiplied by a PLL by 600 to produce 19.660800 MHz, the master clock (MCK). All on-chip timing, except for the RTC clock, is derived from MCK. Table 41 provides a summary of the clock functions and their controls. The two general-purpose counter/timers contained in the MPU are controlled by CKMPU (see 2.4.6 Timers and Counters). The master clock can be boosted to 19.66 MHz by setting the PLL_FAST bit = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2200[4]) and can be reduced to 6.29 MHz by PLL_FAST = 0. The MPU clock frequency CKMPU is determined by another divider controlled by the I/O RAM control field MPU_DIV[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2200[2:0]) and can be -(MPU_DIV+2) , where MPU_DIV[2:0] may vary from 0 to 4. The 71M654x V3P3SYS supply set to MCK*2 current is reduced by reducing the MPU clock frequency. When the ICE_E pin is high, the circuit also generates the 9.83 MHz clock for use by the emulator. The PLL is only turned off in SLP mode or in LCD mode when LCD_BSTE is disabled. The LCD_BSTE value depends on the setting of the LCD_VMODE [1:0] field (see Table 56). When the part is waking up from SLP or LCD modes, the PLL is turned on in 6.29 MHz mode, and the PLL frequency is not be accurate until the PLL_OK flag (SFR 0xF9[4]) rises. Due to potential overshoot, the MPU should not change the value of PLL_FAST until PLL_OK is true. 50 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 41: Clock System Summary Clock OSC Crystal MCK Crystal/PLL CKCE MCK CKADC MCK CKMPU MCK CKICE MCK CKOPTMOD MCK CK32 MCK 2.5.4 Fixed Frequency or Range Derived From PLL_FAST=1 PLL_FAST=0 Controlled by Function 32.768 kHz - Crystal clock 19.660800 MHz 6.291456 MHz PLL_FAST Master clock (600*CK32) (192*CK32) 4.9152 MHz 1.5728 MHz - CE clock 1.572864 MHz, 4.9152 MHz, ADC_DIV ADC clock 2.4576 MHz 0.786432 MHz 4.9152 MHz ... 1.572864 MHz... MPU_DIV[2:0] MPU clock 307.2 kHz 98.304 kHz 9.8304 MHz... 3.145728 MHz ... MPU_DIV[2:0] ICE clock 196.608 kHz 614.4 kHz Optical UART 38.40 kHz 38.6 kHz - Modulation 32.768 kHz - 32 kHz clock Real-Time Clock (RTC) 2.5.4.1 RTC General Description The RTC is driven directly by the crystal oscillator and is powered by either the V3P3SYS pin or the VBAT_RTC pin, depending on the V3OK internal bit. The RTC consists of a counter chain and output registers. The counter chain consists of registers for seconds, minutes, hours, day of week, day of month, month, and year. The chain registers are supported by a shadow register that facilitates read and write operations. Table 42 shows the I/O RAM registers for accessing the RTC. 2.5.4.2 Accessing the RTC Two bits, RTC_RD (I/O RAM 0x2890[6]) and RTC_WR (I/O RAM 0x2890[7]), control the behavior of the shadow register. When RTC_RD is low, the shadow register is updated by the RTC after each two milliseconds. When RTC_RD is high, this update is halted and the shadow register contents become stationary and are suitable to be read by the MPU. Thus, when the MPU wishes to read the RTC, it freezes the shadow register by setting the RTC_RD bit, reads the shadow register, and then lowers the RTC_RD bit to let updates to the shadow register resume. Since the RTC clock is only 500Hz, there may be a delay of approximately 2 ms from when the RTC_RD bit is lowered until the shadow register receives its first update. Reads to RTC_RD continue to return a one until the first shadow update occurs. When RTC_WR is high, the update of the shadow register is also inhibited. During this time, the MPU may overwrite the contents of the shadow register. When RTC_WR is lowered, the shadow register is written into the RTC counter on the next 500Hz RTC clock. A change bit is included for each word in the shadow register to ensure that only programmed words are updated when the MPU writes a zero to RTC_WR. Reads of RTC_WR returns one until the counter has actually been updated by the register. The sub-second register of the RTC, RTC_SBSC (I/O RAM 0x2892), can be read by the MPU after the one second interrupt and before reaching the next one second boundary. The RTC_SBSC register is expressed as a count of 1/128 second periods remaining until the next one second boundary. Writing 0x00 to RTC_SBSC resets the counter re-starting the count from 0 to 127. Reading and resetting the sub-second counter can be used as part of an algorithm to accurately set the RTC. The RTC is capable of processing leap years. Each counter has its own output register. The RTC chain registers are not affected by the reset pin, watchdog timer resets, or by transitions between the battery modes and mission mode. Rev 5 51 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 42: RTC Control Registers Name Location Rst Wk Dir Description RTCA_ADJ[6:0] RTC_P[16:14] RTC_P[13:6] RTC_P[5:0] RTC_Q[1:0] 2504[6:0] 289B[2:0] 289C[7:0] 289D[7:2] 289D[1:0] 64 4 0 0 0 - 4 0 0 0 R/W R/W Register for analog RTC frequency adjustment. R/W RTC_RD 2890[6] 0 0 R/W RTC_WR 2890[7] 0 0 R/W RTC_FAIL 2890[4] 0 0 R RTC_SBSC[7:0] 2892[7:0] Register for digital RTC adjustment. Freezes the RTC shadow register so it is suitable for MPU reads. When RTC_RD is read, it returns the status of the shadow register: 0 = up to date, 1 = frozen. Freezes the RTC shadow register so it is suitable for MPU write operations. When RTC_WR is cleared, the contents of the shadow register written to the RTC counter on the next RTC clock (~500 Hz). When RTC_WR is read, it returns 1 as long as RTC_WR is set. It continues to return one until the RTC counter is updated. Indicates that a count error has occurred in the RTC and that the time is not trustworthy. This bit can be cleared by writing a 0. Time remaining since the last 1 second boundary. LSB = 1/128 second. R Registers for digital RTC adjustment. 0x0FFBF RTC_P 0x10040 2.5.4.3 RTC Rate Control Two rate adjustment mechanisms are available: * * The first rate adjustment mechanism is an analog rate adjustment, using the I/O RAM register RTCA_ADJ[6:0] (I/O RAM 0x2504[6:0]), that trims the crystal load capacitance. The second rate adjustment mechanism is a digital rate adjust that affects the way the clock frequency is processed in the RTC. Setting RTCA_ADJ[6:0] to 00 minimizes the load capacitance, maximizing the oscillator frequency. Setting RTCA_ADJ[6:0] to 7F maximizes the load capacitance, minimizing the oscillator frequency. The adjustable capacitance is approximately: C ADJ = RTCA _ ADJ 16.5 pF 128 The precise amount of adjustment depends on the crystal properties, the PCB layout and the value of the external crystal capacitors. The adjustment may occur at any time, and the resulting clock frequency should be measured over a one-second interval. The second rate adjustment is digital, and can be used to adjust the clock rate up to 988ppm, with a resolution of 3.8 ppm (1.9 ppm). Note that 3.8 ppm corresponds to 1-LSB of the 19-bit quantity formed by 4*RTCP+RTCQ and 1.9 ppm corresponds to 1/2-LSB. The rate adjustment is implemented starting at the next second-boundary following the adjustment. Since the LSB results in an adjustment every four seconds, the frequency should be measured over an interval that is a multiple of four seconds. The clock rate is adjusted by writing the appropriate values to RTC_P[16:0] (I/O RAM 0x289B[2:0], 0x289C, 0x289D[7:2]) and RTC_Q[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x289D[1:0]). Updates to RTC rate adjust registers, RTC_P and RTC_Q, are done through the shadow register described above. The new values are loaded into the counters when RTC_WR (I/O RAM 0x2890[7]) is lowered. The default frequency is 32,768 RTCLK cycles per second. To shift the clock frequency by D ppm, RTC_P and RTC_Q are calculated using the following equation: 52 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 32768 8 4 RTC_P + RTC_Q = floor + 0.5 -6 1 + 10 Conversely, the amount of ppm shift for a given value of 4RTC_P+RTC_Q is: () = 32768 8 - 1 106 4 + For example, for a shift of -988 ppm, 4RTC_P + RTC_Q = 262403 = 0x40103. RTC_P = 0x10040, and RTC_Q = 0x03. The default values of RTC_P and RTC_Q, corresponding to zero adjustment, are 0x10000 and 0x0, respectively. Two settings for the TMUX2OUT test pin, PULSE_1S and PULSE_4S, are available for measuring and calibrating the RTC clock frequency. These are waveforms of approximately 25% duty cycle with 1s or 4s period. Default values for RTCA_ADJ, RTC_P and RTC_Q should be nominal values, at the center of the adjustment range. Un-calibrated extreme values (zero, for example) can cause incorrect operation. If the crystal temperature coefficient is known, the MPU can integrate temperature and correct the RTC time as necessary. Alternatively, the characteristics can be loaded into an NV RAM and the OSC_COMP bit (I/O RAM 0x28A0[5]) may be set. In this case, the oscillator is adjusted automatically, even in SLP mode. See the Real Time RTC Temperature Compensation section for details. 2.5.4.4 RTC Temperature Compensation The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G can be configured to regularly measure die temperature, including in SLP and LCD modes and while the MPU is halted. If enabled by the OSC_COMP bit, the temperature information is automatically used to correct for the temperature variation of the crystal. A table look-up method is used which generates the required digital compensation without involvement from the MPU. Storage for the look-up table is in a dedicated 128 byte NV RAM. Table 43 shows the I/O RAM registers involved in automatic RTC temperature compensation. Table 43: I/O RAM Registers for RTC Temperature Compensation Name OSC_COMP Location 28A0[5] Rst Wk Dir Description 0 0 R/W Enables the automatic update of RTC_P and RTC_Q every time the temperature is measured. STEMP[10:3] STEMP[2:0] 2881[7:0] 2882[7:5] - - R LKPADDR[6:0] 2887[6:0] 0 0 R/W LKPAUTOI 2887[7] 0 0 R/W LKPDAT[7:0] 2888[7:0] 0 0 R/W LKP_RD LKP_WR 2889[1] 2889[0] 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W Rev 5 The result of the temperature measurement (10-bits of magnitude data plus a sign bit). The complete STEMP[10:0] value can be read and shifted right in a single 16-bit read operation as shown in the following code fragment. volatile int16_t xdata STEMP _at_0x2881; fa = (float)(STEMP/32); The address for reading and writing the RTC lookup RAM. Auto-increment flag. When set, LKPADDR[6:0] auto increments every time LKP_RD or LKP_WR is pulsed. The incremented address can be read at LKPADDR[6:0]. The data for reading and writing the RTC lookup RAM. Strobe bits for the RTC lookup RAM read and write. When set, the LKPADDR and LKPDAT registers are used in a read or write operation. When a strobe is set, it stays set until the operation completes, at which time the strobe is cleared and LKPADDR is incremented if LKPAUTOI is set. 53 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Referring to Figure 17, the table lookup method uses the 10-bits plus sign-bit value in STEMP[10:0] rightshifted by two bits to obtain an 8-bit plus sign value (i.e., NV RAM Address = STEMP/4). A limiter ensures that the resulting look-up address is in the 6-bit plus sign range of -64 to +63 (decimal). The 8-bit NV RAM content pointed to by the address is added as a 2's complement value to 0x40000, the nominal value of 4*RTC_P + RTC_Q. Refer to 2.5.4.3 RTC Rate Control for information on the rate adjustments performed by registers RTC_P[16:0] (I/O RAM 0x289B[2:0], 0x289C, 0x289D[7:2]) and RTC_Q[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2891[1:0]. The 8-bit values loaded in to NV RAM must be scaled correctly to produce rate adjustments that are consistent with the equations given in 2.5.4.3 RTC Rate Control for RTC_P and RTC_Q. Note that the sum of the 8-bit 2's complement value looked-up and 0x40000 form a 19-bit value, which is equal to 4*RTC_P+RTC_Q, as shown in Figure 17. The output of the Temperature Compensation is automatically loaded into the RTC_P[16:0] and RTC_Q[1:0] locations after each look-up and summation operation. LIMIT TEMP 10+ >>2 8+ Look Up RAM 63 ADDR -256 -64 63 255 6+ Q -64 7+ 19 4*RTC_P+RTC_Q 19 0x40000 Figure 17: Automatic Temperature Compensation The 128 NV RAM locations are organized in 2's complement format as shown in Table 44. As mentioned above, the STEMP[10:0] digital temperature values are scaled such that the corresponding NV RAM addresses are equal to STEMP[10:0]/4 (limited in the range of -64 to +63). See 2.5.5 71M654x Temperature Sensor on page 56 for the equations to calculate temperature in degrees C from the STEMP[10:0] reading. The temperature equation is used to calculate the two temperature columns in Table 44 (the second column and the rightmost column). The second column uses the full 11-bit values of STEMP[10:0], while the values in the rightmost column are calculated using the post-limiter (6+S) values multiplied by 4. Since each look-up table address step corresponds to a 4 x 0.325 C temperature step, two is added to the post-limiter 6+S value after multiplying by 4 to calculate the temperature values in the rightmost column. This method ensures that the compensation data is loaded into the look-up table in a manner that minimizes quantization error. Table 44 shows the numerical values corresponding to each node in Figure 17. The values of STEMP[10:0] outside the -256 to +255 range are not shown in this table. The limiter output is confined to the range of -64 to +63, which is directly the desired address of the 128-byte look-up table. The rightmost column gives the nominal temperature corresponding to each address cell in the 128-byte compensation table Table 44: NV RAM Temperature Table Structure STEMP[10:0] (10+S) (decimal) 54 Temp (oC) (Equation) -256 -61.71 -255 -61.39 -254 -61.06 -253 ... -4 -60.73 ... 20.69 -3 21.02 -2 21.35 -1 21.67 STEMP[10:0]>>2 (8+S) (decimal) Limiter Output (6+S) (decimal) Temp (oC) (LU Table) -64 -64 -61.06 ... ... ... -1 -1 21.35 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet STEMP[10:0] (10+S) (decimal) Temp (oC) (Equation) 0 22.00 1 22.33 2 22.65 3 22.98 4 23.31 5 23.64 6 23.96 7 ... 252 24.29 ... 104.40 253 104.73 254 105.06 255 105.39 STEMP[10:0]>>2 (8+S) (decimal) Limiter Output (6+S) (decimal) Temp (oC) (LU Table) 0 0 22.65 1 1 23.96 ... ... ... 63 63 105.06 For proper operation, the MPU must load the lookup table with values that reflect the crystal properties with respect to temperature, which is typically done once during initialization. Since the lookup table is not directly addressable, the MPU uses the following procedure to load the entire NV RAM table: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Set the LKPAUTOI bit (I/O RAM 0x2887[7]) to enable address auto-increment. Write zero into the I/O RAM register LKPADDR[6:0] (I/O RAM 0x2887[6:0]). Write the 8-bit datum into I/O RAM register LKPDAT (I/O RAM 0x2888). Set the LKP_WR bit (I/O RAM 0x2889[0]) to write the 8-bit datum into NV_RAM Wait for LKP_WR to clear (LKP_WR auto-clears when the data has been copied to NV RAM). Repeat steps 3 through 5 until all data has been written to NV RAM. The NV RAM table can also be read by writing a 1 into the LKP_RD bit (I/O RAM 0x2889[1]). The process of reading from and writing to the NV RAM is accelerated by setting the LKPAUTOI bit (I/O RAM 0x2887[7]). When LKPAUTOI is set, LKPADDR[6:0] auto-incremented every time LKP_RD or LKP_WR is pulsed. It is also possible to perform random access of the NV RAM by writing a 0 to the LKPAUTOI bit and loading the desired address into LKPADDR[6:0]. If the oscillator temperature compensation feature is not being used, it is possible to use the NV RAM storage area as ordinary NV storage space using the procedure described above to read and write NV RAM data. In this case, keep the OSC_COMP bit (I/O RAM 0x28A0[5]) reset to disable the automatic oscillator temperature compensation feature. 2.5.4.5 RTC Interrupts The RTC generates interrupts each second and each minute. These interrupts are called RTC_1SEC and RTC_1MIN. In addition, the RTC functions as an alarm clock by generating an interrupt when the minutes and hours registers both equal their respective target counts as defined in Table 45. The alarm clock interrupt is called RTC_T. All three interrupts appear in the MPU's external interrupt 6. See Table 33 in the interrupt section for the enable bits and flags for these interrupts. The target registers for minutes and hours are listed in Table 45. Table 45: I/O RAM Registers for RTC Interrupts Name RTC_TMIN[5:0] RTC_THR[4:0] Rev 5 Location Rst 289E[5:0] 0 289F[4:0] 0 Wk 0 0 Dir Description R/W The target minutes register. See RTC_THR[4:0] below. R/W The target hours register. The RTC_T interrupt occurs when RTC_MIN becomes equal to RTC_TMIN and RTC_HR becomes equal to RTC_THR. 55 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.5.5 71M654x Temperature Sensor The 71M654x includes an on-chip temperature sensor for determining the temperature of its bandgap reference. The primary use of the temperature data is to determine the magnitude of compensation required to offset the thermal drift in the system for the compensation of current, voltage and energy measurement and the RTC. See 4.7 Metrology Temperature Compensation on page 97. Also see 2.5.4.4 RTC Temperature Compensation on page 53. Unlike earlier generation Maxim SoCs, the 71M654x does not use the ADC to read the temperature sensor. Instead, it uses a technique that is operational in SLP and LCD mode, as well as BRN and MSN modes. This means that the temperature sensor can be used to compensate for the frequency variation of the crystal, even in SLP mode while the MPU is halted. See 2.5.4.4 RTC Temperature Compensation on page 53. In MSN and BRN modes, the temperature sensor is awakened on command from the MPU by setting the TEMP_START (I/O RAM 0x28B4[6]) control bit. The MPU must wait for the TEMP_START bit to clear before reading STEMP[10:0] and before setting the TEMP_START bit once again. In SLP and LCD modes, it is awakened at a regular rate set by TEMP_PER[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x28A0[2:0]). The result of the temperature measurement can be read from the two I/O RAM locations STEMP[10:3] (I/O RAM 0x2881) and STEMP[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2882[7:5]). Note that both of these I/O RAM locations must be read and properly combined to form the STEMP[10:0] 11-bit value (see STEMP in Table 46). The resulting 11-bit value is in 2's complement form and ranges from -1024 to +1023 (decimal). The equations below are used to calculate the sensed temperature from the 11-bit STEMP[10:0] reading. The equations below are used to calculate the sensed temperature. The first equation applies when the 71M654x is in MSN mode and TEMP_PWR = 1. The second equation applies when the 71M654x is in BRN mode, and in this case, the TEMP_PWR and TEMP_BSEL bits must both be set to the same value, so that the battery that supplies the temperature sensor is also the battery that is measured and reported in BSENSE. Thus, the second equation requires reading STEMP and BSENSE. In the second equation, BSENSE (the sensed battery voltage) is used to obtain a more accurate temperature reading when the IC is in BRN mode. For the 71M654x in MSN Mode (with TEMP_PWR = 1): Temp(C ) = 0.325 STEMP + 22 For the 71M654x in BRN Mode, (with TEMP_PWR=TEMP_BSEL): Temp(oC ) = 0.325 STEMP + 0.00218 BSENSE 2 - 0.609 BSENSE + 64.4 Table 46 shows the I/O RAM registers used for temperature and battery measurement. If TEMP_PWR selects VBAT_RTC when the battery is nearly discharged, the temperature measurement may not finish. In this case, firmware may complete the measurement by selecting V3P3D (TEMP_PWR = 1). Table 46: I/O RAM Registers for Temperature and Battery Measurement Name TBYTE_BUSY TEMP_PER[2:0] 56 Location Rst Wk Dir 28A0[3] 0 0 R 28A0[2:0] 0 - R/W Description Indicates that hardware is still writing the 0x28A0 byte. Additional writes to this byte are locked out while it is one. Write duration could be as long as 6 ms. Sets the period between temperature measurements. Automatic measurements can be enabled in any mode (MSN, BRN, LCD, or SLP). TEMP_PER 0 1-6 7 Time Manual updates (see TEMP_START) 2 ^ (3+TEMP_PER) (seconds) Continuous Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location Rst Wk TEMP_BAT 28A0[4] 0 - TEMP_START 28B4[6] 0 - TEMP_PWR 28A0[6] 0 - TEMP_BSEL 28A0[7] 0 - 0 - TEMP_TEST[1:0] 2500[1:0] Dir Description Causes VBAT to be measured whenever a temperature measurement is performed. TEMP_PER[2:0] must be zero in order for TEMP_START to function. If TEMP_PER[2:0] = 0, then setting TEMP_START starts a temperature measurement. Ignored in SLP and LCD modes. Hardware clears R/W TEMP_START when the temperature measurement is complete. The MPU must wait for TEMP_START to clear before reading STEMP[10:0] and before setting TEMP_START again. Selects the power source for the temperature sensor: 1 = V3P3D, 0 = VBAT_RTC. This bit is ignored in R/W SLP and LCD modes, where the temperature sensor is always powered by VBAT_RTC. Selects which battery is monitored by the R/W temperature sensor: 1 = VBAT, 0 = VBAT_RTC Test bits for the temperature monitor VCO. TEMP_TEST must be 00 in regular operation. Any other value causes the VCO to run continuously with the control voltage described below. R/W TEMP_TEST Function R/W 00 01 1X STEMP[10:3] STEMP[2:0] 2881[7:0] 2882[7:5] BSENSE[7:0] 2885[7:0] - - 2704[3] 0 0 BCURR Normal operation Reserved for factory test Reserved for factory test R R The result of the temperature measurement. To correctly form STEMP[10:0], the MPU must read 0x2881[7:0], shift it left by three bit positions (padding LSBs with zeros), then read 0x2882[7:5], shift it right by 5-bits (padding the 5 MSBs with zeros), and then logically OR the two quantities together. R The result of the battery measurement. Connects a 100 A load to the battery selected by R/W TEMP_BSEL. Refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for information on reading the temperature sensor in the 71M6x01 devices. 2.5.6 71M654x Battery Monitor The 71M654x temperature measurement circuit can also monitor the batteries at the VBAT and VBAT_RTC pins. The battery to be tested (i.e., VBAT or VBAT_RTC pin) is selected by TEMP_BSEL (I/O RAM 0x28A0[7]). When TEMP_BAT (I/O RAM 0x28A0[4]) is set, a battery measurement is performed as part of each temperature measurement. The value of the battery reading is stored in register BSENSE[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x2885). The following equation is used to calculate the voltage measured on the VBAT pin (or VBAT_RTC pin) from the BSENSE[7:0] and STEMP[10:0] values. The result of the equation below is in volts. VBAT (orVBAT _ RTC ) = 3.293V + ( BSENSE[7 : 0] - 142) 0.0246V + STEMP[10 : 0] 0.000276V In MSN mode, a 100 A de-passivation load can be applied to the selected battery (i.e., selected by the TEMP_BSEL bit) by setting the BCURR (I/O RAM 0x2704[3]) bit. Battery impedance can be measured by taking a battery measurement with and without BCURR. Regardless of the BCURR bit setting, the battery load is never applied in BRN, LCD, and SLP modes. Rev 5 57 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for information on reading the VCC sensor in the 71M6x01 devices. 2.5.7 UART and Optical Interface The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G provide two asynchronous interfaces, UART0 and UART1. Both can be used to connect to AMR modules, user interfaces, etc., and also support a mechanism for programming the on-chip flash memory. Referring to Figure 19, UART1 includes an interface to implement an IR/optical port. The pin OPT_TX is designed to directly drive an external LED for transmitting data on an optical link. The pin OPT_RX has the same threshold as the RX pin, but can also be used to sense the input from an external photo detector used as the receiver for the optical link. OPT_TX and OPT_RX are connected to a dedicated UART port (UART1). The OPT_TX and OPT_RX pins can be inverted with configuration bits OPT_TXINV (I/O RAM 0x2456[0]) and OPT_RXINV (I/O RAM 0x2457[1]), respectively. Additionally, the OPT_TX output may be modulated at 38 kHz. Modulation is available in MSN and BRN modes (see Table 67). The OPT_TXMOD bit (I/O RAM 0x2456[1]) enables modulation. The duty cycle is controlled by OPT_FDC[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2457[5:4]) , which can select 50%, 25%, 12.5%, and 6.25% duty cycle. A 6.25% duty cycle means that OPT_TX is low for 6.25% of the period. When not needed for UART1, OPT_TX can alternatively be configured as SEGDIO51. Configuration is via the OPT_TXE[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2456[3:2]) field and LCD_MAP[51] (I/O RAM 0x2405[0]). The OPT_TXE[1:0] field allows the MPU to select VPULSE, WPULSE, SEGDIO51 or the output of the pulse modulator to be sourced onto the OPT_TX pin. Likewise, the OPT_RX pin can alternately be configured as SEGDIO55, and its control is OPT_RXDIS (I/O RAM 0x2457[2]) and LCD_MAP[55] (I/O RAM 0x2405[4]). from OPT_TX UART OPT_TXINV Internal VARPULSE 3 WPULSE 2 0 DIO2 MOD A B 1 EN DUTY OPT_TXE[1:0] OPT_TXMOD OPT_FDC 2 V3P3 OPT_TX OPT_TXMOD = 1, OPT_FDC = 2 (25%) OPT_TXMOD = 0 A A B B 1/38kHz Figure 18: Optical Interface Bit Banged Optical UART (Third UART) As shown in Figure 19, the 71M654x can also be configured to drive the optical UART with a DIO signal in a bit banged configuration. When control bit OPT_BB (I/O RAM 0x2022[0]) is set, the optical port is driven by DIO5 and the SEGDIO5 pin is driven by UART1_TX. This configuration is typically used when the two dedicated UARTs must be connected to high speed clients and a slower optical UART is permissible. 58 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Internal SEG55 DIO55 UART1_RX 1 1 0 0 OPT_RXDIS UART1_TX 0 DIO5 1 EN OPT_TXMOD OPT_FDC 0 2 0 V3P3 SEGDIO51/ OPT_TX 1 DIO51 B DUTY LCD_MAP[55] 3 WPULSE MOD A OPT_TXINV SEG51 VARPULSE SEGDIO55/ OPT_RX 0 LCD_MAP[51] 1 OPT_TXE[1:0] SEG5 2 1 0 SEGDIO5/TX2 1 LCD_MAP[5] OPT_BB OPT_TXMOD=1, OPT_FDC=2 (25%) OPT_TXMOD=0 A B 1/38kHz Figure 19: Optical Interface (UART1) 2.5.8 Digital I/O and LCD Segment Drivers 2.5.8.1 General Information The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G combine most DIO pins with LCD segment drivers. Each SEG/DIO pin can be configured as a DIO pin or as a segment (SEG) driver pin. On reset or power-up, all DIO pins are DIO inputs (except for SEGDIO0-15, see caution note below) until they are configured as desired under MPU control. The pin function can be configured by the I/O RAM registers LCD_MAPn (0x2405 - 0x240B). Setting the bit corresponding to the pin in LCD_MAPn to 1 configures the pin for LCD, setting LCD_MAPn to 0 configures it for DIO. After reset or power up, pins SEGDIO0 through SEGDIO15 are initially DIO outputs, but are disabled by PORT_E = 0 (I/O RAM 0x270C[5]) to avoid unwanted pulses during reset. After configuring pins SEGDIO0 through SEGDIO15 the MPU must enable these pins by setting PORT_E. Once a pin is configured as DIO, it can be configured independently as an input or output. For SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO15, this is done with the SFR registers P0 (SFR 0x80), P1 (SFR 0x90), P2 (SFR 0xA0) and P3 (SFR 0xB0), as shown in Table 48 (71M6541D/F/G) and Table 52 (71M6542F/G). The PB pin is a dedicated digital input and is not part of the SEGDIO system. The CE features pulse counting registers and each pulse counter interrupt output is internally routed to the pulse interrupt logic. Thus, no routing of pulse signals to external pins is required in order to generate pulse interrupts. See interrupt source No. 2 in Figure 16. A 3-bit configuration word, I/O RAM register DIO_Rn (I/O RAM 0x2009[2:0] through 0x200E[6:4]) can be used for pins SEGDIO2 through SEGDIO11 (when configured as DIO) and PB to individually assign an internal resource such as an interrupt or a timer control (DIO_RPB[2:0], I/O RAM 0x2450[2:0], configures the PB pin). This way, DIO pins can be tracked even if they are configured as outputs. Table 47 lists the internal resources which can be assigned using DIO_R2[2:0] through DIO_R11[2:0] and DIO_RPB[2:0]. If more than one input is connected to the same resource, the resources are combined using a logical OR. Rev 5 59 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 47: Selectable Resources using the DIO_Rn[2:0] Bits Resource Selected for SEGDIOn or PB Pin Value in DIO_Rn[2:0] 0 None 1 Reserved 2 T0 (counter0 clock) 3 T1 (counter1 clock) 4 High priority I/O interrupt (INT0) 5 Low priority I/O interrupt (INT1) Note: Resources are selectable only on SEGDIO2 through SEGDIO11 and the PB pin. See Table 48 (71M6541D/F/G) and Table 52 (71M6542F/G). When driving LEDs, relay coils etc., the DIO pins should sink the current into GNDD (as shown in Figure 20, right), not source it from V3P3D (as shown in Figure 20, left). This is due to the resistance of the internal switch that connects V3P3D to either V3P3SYS or VBAT. See 6.4.6 V3P3D Switch on page 144. Sourcing current in or out of DIO pins other than those dedicated for wake functions, for example with pull-up or pull-down resistors, must be avoided. Violating this rule leads to increased quiescent current in sleep and LCD modes. MISSION LCD/SLEEP BROWNOUT V3P3SYS MISSION LCD/SLEEP BROWNOUT VBAT DIO HIGH HIGH-Z LOW DIO GNDD GNDD Not recommended VBAT V3P3D V3P3D HIGH HIGH-Z LOW V3P3SYS Recommended Figure 20: Connecting an External Load to DIO Pins 60 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.5.8.2 Digital I/O for the 71M6541D/F/G A total of 32 combined SEG/DIO pins plus 5 SEG outputs are available for the 71M6541D/F/G. These pins can be categorized as follows: 17 combined SEG/DIO segment pins: o o o o SEGDIO4...SEGDIO5 (2 pins) SEGDIO9...SEGDIO14 (6 pins) SEGDIO19...SEGDIO25 (7 pins) SEGDIO44...SEGDIO45 (2 pins) 15 combined SEG/DIO segment pins shared with other functions: o o o o o o o SEGDIO0/WPULSE, SEGDIO1/VPULSE (2 pins) SEGDIO2/SDCK, SEGDIO3/SDATA (2 pins) SEGDIO6/XPULSE, SEGDIO7/YPULSE (2 pins) SEGDIO8/DI (1 pin) SEGDIO26/COM5, SEGDIO27/COM4 (2 pins) SEGDIO36/SPI_CSZ...SEGDIO39/SPI_CKI (4 pins) SEGDIO51/OPT_TX, SEGDIO55/OPT_RX (2 pins) 5 dedicated SEG segment pins are available: o o ICE Inteface pins: SEG48/E_RXTX, SEG49/E_TCLK, SEG50/E_RST (3 pins) Test Port pins: SEG46/TMUX2OUT, SEG47/TMUXOUT (2 pins) There are four dedicated common segment outputs (COM0...COM3) plus the two additional shared common segment outputs that are listed under combined SEG/DIO shared pins (SEGDIO26/COM5, SEGDIO27/COM4). Thus, in a configuration where none of these pins are used as DIOs, there can be up to 37 LCD segment pins with 4 commons, or 35 LCD segment pins with 6 commons. And in a configuration where LCD segment pins are not used, there can be up to 32 DIO pins. The configuration for pins SEGDIO19 to SEGDIO27 is shown in Table 49, and the configuration for pins SEGDIO36-39 and SEGDIO44-45 is shown in Table 50. SEG46 to SEG50 cannot be configured for DIO. The configuration for pins SEGDIO51 and SEGDIO55 is shown in Table 51. Table 48: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO14 (71M6541D/F/G) SEGDIO Pin # Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output Internal Resources Configurable (see Table 47) Rev 5 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 - 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 LCD_MAP[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x240B) 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 LCD_SEG0[5:0] to LCD_SEG14[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2410[5:0] to 0x241E[5:0] - 1 2 3 4 5 6 LCD_MAP[14:8] (I/O RAM 0x240A) - 0 1 2 3 P0 (SFR 0x80) 0 1 2 3 P1 (SFR 0x90) 0 1 2 3 P2 (SFR 0xA0) 0 - 1 2 P3 (SFR 0xB0) 4 5 6 7 P0 (SFR 0x80) 4 5 6 7 P1 (SFR 0x90) 4 5 6 7 P2 (SFR 0xA0) 4 - 5 6 P3 (SFR 0xB0) - - Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y - - - - 61 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 49: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO19 to SEGDIO27 (71M6541D/F/G) SEGDIO - - - 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 - - - - Pin # - - - 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 - - - - - Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output - - - - - - 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 LCD_MAP[23:19] (I/O RAM 0x2409) LCD_MAP[27:24] (I/O RAM 0x2408) - - - 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 - - - - LCD_SEGDIO19[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO27[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2423[5:0] to 0x242C[5:0]) - - - 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 - - - - LCD_SEGDIO19[0] to LCD_SEGDIO27[0] (I/O RAM 0x2423[0] to 0x242C[0]) - - - 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 - - - - LCD_SEGDIO19[1] to LCD_SEGDIO27[1] (I/O RAM 0x2423[1] to 0x242C[1]) Table 50: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO36-39 to SEGDIO44-45 (71M6541D/F/G) SEGDIO - - - - 36 37 38 39 - - - - 44 45 Pin # - - - - 3 2 1 64 - - - - 63 62 - - 5 - - - - - - - - 4 5 6 7 - - - - 4 LCD_MAP[39:36] LCD_MAP[45:44] (I/O RAM 0x2407) (I/O RAM 0x2406) - - 36 37 38 39 - - - - 44 LCD_SEGDIO36[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO45[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2434-2437[5:0] to 0x243C-243D[5:0]) - - 36 37 38 39 - - - - 44 LCD_SEGDIO32[0] to LCD_SEGDIO45[0] (I/O RAM 0x2434-2437[0] to 0x243C-243D[0]) - - 36 37 38 39 - - - - 44 LCD_SEGDIO32[1] to LCD_SEGDIO45[1] (I/O RAM 0x2434-2437[1] to 0x243C-243D[1]) Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output 45 45 45 Table 51: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO51 and SEGDIO55 (71M6541D/F/G) SEGDIO 51 - - - 55 - - - Pin # 33 - - - 32 - - - 3 - - - 7 - - - Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register LCD_MAP[55], LDC_MAP[51] (I/O RAM 0x2405) - - - - - - 51 55 LCD_SEGDIO51[5:0], LCD_SEGDIO55[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2443[5:0] and 0x2447[5:0]) 51 DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output 62 - - - 55 - - - LCD_SEGDIO51[0] to LCD_SEGDIO55[0] (I/O RAM 0x2443[0] and 0x2447[0]) 51 - - - 55 - - - LCD_SEGDIO51[1] to LCD_SEGDIO55[1] (I/O RAM 0x2443[1] and 0x2447[1]) Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.5.8.3 Digital I/O for the 71M6542F/G A total of 55 combined SEG/DIO pins are available for the 71M6542D/F. These pins can be categorized as follows: 36 combined DIO/LCD segment pins: o SEGDIO4...SEGDIO5 (2 pins) o SEGDIO9...SEGDIO25 (17 pins) o SEGDIO28...SEGDIO35 (8 pins) o SEGDIO40...SEGDIO45 (6 pins) o SEGDIO52...SEGDIO54 (3 pins) 15 combined DIO/LCD segment pins shared with other functions: o o o o o o o SEGDIO0/WPULSE, SEGDIO1/VPULSE (2 pins) SEGDIO2/SDCK, SEGDIO3/SDATA (2 pins) SEGDIO6/XPULSE, SEGDIO7/YPULSE (2 pins) SEGDIO8/DI (1 pin) SEGDIO26/COM5, SEGDIO27/COM4 (2 pins) SEGDIO36/SPI_CSZ...SEGDIO39/SPI_CKI (4 pins) SEGDIO51/OPT_TX, SEGDIO55/OPT_RX (2 pins) 5 dedicated SEG segment pins are available: o o ICE Inteface pins: SEG48/E_RXTX, SEG49/E_TCLK, SEG50/E_RST (3 pins) Test Port pins: SEG46/TMUX2OUT, SEG47/TMUXOUT (2 pins) There are four dedicated common segment outputs (COM0...COM3) plus the two additional shared common segment outputs that are listed under combined SEG/DIO shared pins (SEGDIO26/COM5, SEGDIO27/COM4). Thus, in a configuration where none of these pins are used as DIOs, there can be up to 55 LCD segment pins with 4 commons, or 54 LCD segment pins with 6 commons. And in a configuration where LCD segment pins are not used, there can be up to 50 DIO pins. Example: SEGDIO12 (see pin 32 in Table 52) is configured as a DIO output pin with a value of 1 (high) by writing 0 to bit 4 of LCD_MAP[15:8], and writing 1 to both P3[4]and P3[0]. The same pin is configured as an LCD driver by writing 1 to bit 4 of LCD_MAP[15:8]. The display information is written to bits 0 to 5 of LCD_SEG12. The configuration for pins SEGDIO16 to SEGDIO31 is shown in Table 53, the configuration for pins SEGDIO32 to SEGDIO45 is shown in Table 54. SEG46 through SEG50 cannot be configured as DIO pins. The configuration for pins SEGDIO51 to SEGDIO55 is shown in Table 55. Table 52: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO15 (71M6542F/G) SEGDIO 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Pin # 45 44 43 42 41 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 LCD_MAP[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x240B) 0 0 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 LCD_SEG0[5:0] to LCD_SEG15[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2410[5:0] to 0x241F[5:0] Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output Internal Resources Configurable (see Table 47) Rev 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 LCD_MAP[15:8] (I/O RAM 0x240A) 0 1 2 3 P0 (SFR 0x80) 0 1 2 3 P1 (SFR 0x90) 0 1 2 3 P2 (SFR 0xA0) 0 1 2 3 P3 (SFR 0xB0) 4 5 6 7 P0 (SFR 0x80) 4 5 6 7 P1 (SFR 0x0) 4 5 6 7 P2 (SFR 0xA0) 4 5 6 7 P3 (SFR 0xB0) - - Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y - - - - 63 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 53: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO16 to SEGDIO31 (71M6542F/G) SEGDIO 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Pin # 28 27 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 11 10 9 8 Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD 0 SEG Data Register 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 LCD_MAP[23:16] (I/O RAM 0x2409) LCD_MAP[31:24] (I/O RAM 0x2408) 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 LCD_SEGDIO16[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO31[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2420[5:0] to 0x242F[5:0]) 16 17 18 19 20 27 28 29 30 31 19 LCD_SEGDIO16[0] to LCD_SEGDIO31[0] (I/O RAM 0x2420[0] to 0x242F[0]) 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 LCD_SEGDIO16[1] to LCD_SEGDIO31[1] (I/O RAM 0x2420[1] to 0x242F[1]) 28 29 30 31 DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output 16 17 18 21 22 23 24 25 26 Table 54: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO32 to SEGDIO45 (71M6542F/G) SEGDIO 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 Pin # 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 0 1 5 32 33 32 33 32 33 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 LCD_MAP[39:32] LCD_MAP[45:40] (I/O RAM 0x2407) (I/O RAM 0x2406[5:0]) 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 LCD_SEGDIO32[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO45[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2430[5:0] to 0x243D[5:0]) 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 LCD_SEGDIO32[0] to LCD_SEGDIO45[0] (I/O RAM 0x2430[0] to 0x243D[0]) 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 LCD_SEGDIO32[1] to LCD_SEGDIO45[1] (I/O RAM 0x2430[1] to 0x243D[1]) Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output 45 45 45 Table 55: Data/Direction Registers for SEGDIO51 to SEGDIO55 (71M6542F/G) SEGDIO 51 52 53 54 55 - - - Pin # 53 52 51 47 46 - - - Configuration: 0 = DIO, 1 = LCD SEG Data Register DIO Data Register Direction Register: 0 = input, 1 = output 64 - - - 2 3 4 LCD_MAP[55:51] (I/O RAM 0x2405[7:3]) - - - 51 52 53 54 55 LCD_SEGDIO51[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO55[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2443[5:0] to 0x2447[5:0]) - - - 51 52 53 54 55 LCD_SEGDIO51[0] to LCD_SEGDIO55[0] (I/O RAM 0x2443[0] to 0x2447[0]) - - - 51 52 53 54 55 LCD_SEGDIO51[1] to LCD_SEGDIO55[1] (I/O RAM 0x2443[1] to 0x2447[1]) 0 1 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 2.5.8.4 LCD Drivers The LCD drivers are grouped into up to six commons (COM0 - COM5) and up to 56 segment drivers. The LCD interface is flexible and can drive 7-segment digits, 14-segments digits or enunciator symbols. A voltage doubler and a contrast DAC generate VLCD from either VBAT or V3P3SYS, depending on the V3P3SYS voltage. The voltage doubler, while capable of driving into a 500 k load, is able to generate a maximum LCD voltage that is within 1 V of twice the supply voltage. The doubler and DAC operate from a trimmed low-power reference. The configuration of the VLCD generation is controlled by the I/O RAM field LCD_VMODE[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2401[7:6]). It is decoded into the LCD_EXT, LDAC_E, and LCD_BSTE internal signals. Table 56 details the LCD_VMODE[1:0] configurations. Table 56: LCD_VMODE[1:0] Configurations LCD_VMODE [1:0] LCD_EXT LDAC_E LCD_BSTE 11 1 0 0 10 0 1 1 01 0 1 0 00 0 0 0 Description External VLCD connected to the VLCD pin. See note 2 below for the definition of V3P3L. LCD boost is enabled. The maximum VLCD pin voltage is 2*V3P3L-1. In general, the VLCD pin voltage is as follows: VLCD = max(2*V3P3L-1, 2.5(1+LCD_DAC[4:0]/31) LCD boost is disabled. The maximum VLCD voltage is V3P3L. VLCD = max(V3P3L, 2.5V+2.5*LCD_DAC[4:0]/31) VLCD=V3P3L, LCD DAC and LCD boost are disabled. In LCD mode, this setting causes the lowest battery current. Notes: 1. LCD_EXT, LDAC_E and LCD_BSTE are 71M654x internal signals which are decoded from the LCD_VMODE[1:0] control field setting (I/O RAM 0x2401[7:6]). Each of these decoded signals, when asserted, has the effect indicated in the description column above, and as summarized below. LCD_EXT : When set, the VLCD pin expects an external supply voltage LDAC_E : When set, LCD DAC is enabled LCD_BSTE : When set, the LCD boost circuit is enabled 2. V3P3L is an internal supply rail that is supplied from either the VBAT pin or the V3P3SYS pin, depending on the V3P3SYS pin voltage. When the V3P3SYS pin drops below 3.0 VDC, the 71M654x switches to BRN mode and V3P3L is sourced from the VBAT pin, otherwise V3P3L is sourced from the V3P3SYS pin while in MSN mode. When using the VLCD boost circuit, use care when setting the LCD_DAC[4:0] (I/O RAM 0x240D[4:0]) value to ensure that the LCD manufacturer's recommended operating voltage specification is not exceeded. The voltage doubler is active in all LCD modes including the LCD mode when LCD_BSTE = 1. Current dissipation in LCD mode can be reduced if the boost circuit is disabled and the LCD system is operated directly from VBAT. The LCD DAC uses a low-power reference and, within the constraints of VBAT and the voltage doubler, generates a VLCD voltage of 2.5 VDC + 2.5 * LCD_DAC[4:0]/31. The LCD_BAT bit (I/O RAM 0x2402[7]) causes the LCD system to use the battery voltage in all power modes. This may be useful when an external supply is available for the LCD system. The advantage of connecting the external supply to VBAT, rather than VLCD is that the LCD DAC is still active. If LCD_EXT = 1, the VLCD pin must be driven from an external source. In this case, the LCD DAC has no effect. Rev 5 65 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The LCD system has the ability to drive up to six segments per SEG driver. If the display is configured with six back planes, the 6-way multiplexing compresses the number of SEG pins required to drive a display and therefore enhance the number of DIO pins available to the application. Refer to the LCD_MODE[2:0] field (I/O RAM 0x2400[6:4]) settings (Table 57) for the different LCD multiplexing choices. If 5-state multiplexing is selected, SEGDIO27 is converted to COM4. If 6-state multiplexing is selected, SEGDIO26 is converted to COM5. These conversions override the SEG/DIO mapping of SEGDIO26 and SEGDIO27. Additionally, independent of LCD_MODE[2:0], if LCD_ALLCOM = 1, then SEGDIO26 and SEGDIO27 become COM4 and COM5 if their LCD_MAP[ ] bits are set. The LCD_ON (I/O RAM 0x240C[0]) and LCD_BLANK (I/O RAM 0x240C[1]) bits are an easy way to either blank the LCD display or turn it fully on. Neither bit affects the contents of the LCD data stored in the LCDSEG_DIO[ ] registers. In comparison, LCD_RST (I/O RAM 0x240C[2]) clears all LCD data to zero. LCD_RST affects only pins that are configured as LCD. A small amount of power can be saved by programming the LCD frequency to the lowest value that provides satisfactory LCD visibility over the required temperature range. 66 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 57 shows all I/O RAM registers that control the operation of the LCD interface. Table 57: LCD Configurations Name Location Rst Wk Dir LCD_ALLCOM 2400[3] 0 - R/W LCD_BAT 2402[7] 0 - R/W LCD_E 2400[7] 0 - R/W LCD_ON LCD_BLANK 240C[0] 240C[1] 0 0 - R/W R/W LCD_RST 240C[2] 0 - R/W LCD_DAC[4:0] 240D[4:0] 0 - R/W LCD_CLK[1:0] 2400[1:0] 0 - R/W LCD_MODE[2:0] 2400[6:4] 0 - R/W LCD_VMODE[1:0] 2401[7:6] 00 00 R/W Description Configures all 6 SEG/COM pins as COM. Has no effect on pins whose LCD_MAP bit is zero. Connects the LCD power supply to VBAT in all modes. Enables the LCD display. When disabled, VLC2, VLC1, and VLC0 are ground as are the COM and SEG outputs if their LCD_MAP bit is 1. LCD_ON = 1 turns on all LCD segments without affecting the LCD data. Similarly, LCD_BLANK = 1 turns off all LCD segments without affecting the LCD data. If both bits are set, all LCD segments are turned on. Clear all bits of LCD data. These bits affect SEGDIO pins that are configured as LCD drivers. This register controls the LCD contrast DAC, which adjusts the VLCD voltage and has an output range of 2.5 VDC to 5 VDC. The VLCD voltage is VLCD = 2.5 + 2.5 * LCD_DAC[4:0]/31 Thus, the LSB of the DAC is 80.6 mV. The maximum DAC output voltage is limited by V3P3SYS, VBAT, and whether LCD_BSTE is set. Sets the LCD clock frequency (1/T). See definition of T in Figure 21. Note: fw = 32768 Hz 00-fw/2^9, 01-fw/2^8, 10-fw/2^7, 11-fw/2^6 The LCD bias and multiplex mode. Output LCD_MODE 000 4 states, 1/3 bias 001 3 states, 1/3 bias 010 2 states, 1/2 bias 011 3 states, 1/2 bias 100 Static display 101 5 states, 1/3 bias 110 6 states, 1/3 bias This register specifies how VLCD is generated. LCD_VMODE Description 11 External VLCD LCD boost and LCD DAC 10 enabled 01 LCD DAC enabled No boost and no DAC. VLCD 00 = VBAT or V3P3SYS The LCD can be driven in static, 1/2 bias, and 1/3 bias modes. Figure 21 defines the COM waveforms. Note that COM pins that are not required in a specific mode maintain a `segment off' state rather than GND, VCC, or high impedance. The segment drivers SEGDIO22 and SEGDIO23 can be configured to blink at either 0.5 Hz or 1 Hz. The blink rate is controlled by LCD_Y (I/O RAM 0x2400[2]). There can be up to six pixels/segments connected to each of these driver pins. The I/O RAM fields LCD_BLKMAP22[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2402[5:0]) and LCD_BLKMAP23[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2401[5:0]) identify which pixels, if any, are to blink. LCD_BLKMAP22[5:0] and LCD_BLKMAP23[5:0] are non-volatile. Rev 5 67 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The LCD bias may be compensated for temperature using the LCD_DAC[4:0] field (I/O RAM 0x240D[4:0]). The bias may be adjusted from 1.4 V below the 3.3 V supply (V3P3SYS in MSN mode and VBAT in BRN and LCD modes). When the LCD_DAC[4:0] field is set to 000, the DAC is bypassed and powered down. This can be used to reduce current in LCD mode. STATIC (LCD_MODE=100) 1/2 BIAS, 2 STATES (LCD_MODE = 010 ) 0 1 COM0 COM0 1/2 BIAS, 3 STATES (LCD_MODE = 011 ) 0 1 2 COM0 COM1 COM1 (1/2) COM1 COM2 (1/2) COM2 (1/2) COM2 COM3 (1/2) COM3 (1/2) COM3 (1/2) COM4 (1/2) COM4 (1/2) COM4 (1/2) COM5 (1/2) COM5 (1/2) COM5 (1/2) SEG_ON SEG_ON SEG_ON SEG_OFF SEG_OFF SEG_OFF T 1/3 BIAS, 3 STATES (LCD_MODE = 011 ) 0 1 2 COM0 1/3 BIAS, 4 STATES (LCD_MODE = 000 ) 3 0 1 2 COM0 1/3 BIAS, 6 STATES (LCD_MODE = 110 ) 4 5 3 0 1 2 COM0 COM1 COM1 COM2 COM2 COM3 COM3 COM4 COM4 COM4 COM5 COM5 COM5 SEG_ON SEG_ON SEG_ON SEG_OFF SEG_OFF SEG_OFF COM1 COM2 COM3 (2/3) (1/3) Figure 21: LCD Waveforms 68 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet LCD Drivers (71M6541D/F/G) With a maximum of 35 LCD driver pins available, the 71M6541D/F/G is capable of driving up to 6 x 35 = 210 pixels of an LCD display when using the 6 x multiplex mode. At eight pixels per digit, this corresponds to 26 digits. LCD segment data is written to the LCD_SEGn[5:0] I/O RAM registers as described in 2.5.8.2 and 2.5.8.3. SEG46 through SEG50 cannot be configured as DIO pins. Display data for these pins are written to I/O RAM registers LCD_SEG46[5:0] through LCD_SEG50[5:0] (see Table 58). When the ICE_E pin is pulled high, it overrides the SEG functionality, and pins E_RXTX/SEG48, E_TCLK/SEG49 and E_RST/SEG50 function as ICE interface pins. LCD_MAP[46] and LCD_MAP[47] (I/O RAM 0x2406[6] and 0x2407[7]) must be set to 1 in order to permit TMUX2OUT/SEG46 and TMUXOUT/SEG47 to operate as SEG drivers, otherwise. If LCD_MAP[46] and LCD_MAP[47] are 0, these pins operate as TMU2XOUT and TMUXOUT (see 2.5.12 Test Ports (TMUXOUT and TMUX2OUT Pins) on page 78). Rev 5 49 50 Pin # 61 60 38 37 36 Configuration Always LCD pins, except when used for ICE interface or TMUXOUT/TMUX2OUT. SEG Data Register LCD_SEG50[5:0] 48 LCD_SEG49[5:0] 47 LCD_SEG48[5:0] 46 LCD_SEG47[5:0] SEG LCD_SEG46[5:0] Table 58: 71M6541D/F/G LCD Data Registers for SEG46 to SEG50 69 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet LCD Drivers (71M6542F/G) With a maximum of 56 LCD driver pins available, the 71M6542D/F is capable of driving up to 6 x 56 = 336 pixels of an LCD display when using the 6 x multiplex mode. At eight pixels per digit, this corresponds to 42 digits. LCD segment data is written to the LCD_SEGn[5:0] I/O RAM registers as described in 2.5.8.3 Digital I/O for the . SEG46 through SEG50 cannot be configured as DIO pins. Display data for these pins are written to I/O RAM fields LCD_SEG46[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x243E[5:0]) through LCD_SEG50[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2442[5:0]); see Table 59. The associated pins function as ICE interface pins, and the ICE functionality overrides the LCD function whenever ICE_E is pulled high. Table 59: 71M6542F/G LCD Data Registers for SEG46 to SEG50 SEG 46 47 48 49 50 Pin # 93 92 58 57 56 2.5.9 LCD_SEGDIO50[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO49[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO48[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO47[5:0] SEG Data Register Always LCD pins, except when used for ICE interface or TMUXOUT/TMUX2OUT. LCD_SEGDIO46[5:0] Configuration: EEPROM Interface The 71M6541D/F/G provides hardware support for either a two-pin or a three-wire (-wire) type of EEPROM interface. The interfaces use the SFR EECTRL (SFR 0x9F) and EEDATA (SFR 0x9E) registers for communication. 2.5.9.1 Two-Pin EEPROM Interface The dedicated 2-pin serial interface communicates with external EEPROM devices and is intended for 2 use with I C devices. The interface is multiplexed onto the SEGDIO2 (SDCK) and SEGDIO3 (SDATA) pins and is selected by setting DIO_EEX[1:0] = 01 (I/O RAM 0x2456[7:6]). The MPU communicates with the interface through the SFR registers EEDATA and EECTRL. If the MPU wishes to write a byte of data to the EEPROM, it places the data in EEDATA and then writes the Transmit code to EECTRL. This initiates the transmit operation which is finished when the BUSY bit falls. INT5 is also asserted when BUSY falls. The MPU can then check the RX_ACK bit to see if the EEPROM acknowledged the transmission. A byte is read by writing the Receive command to EECTRL and waiting for the BUSY bit to fall. Upon completion, the received data is in EEDATA. The serial transmit and receive clock is 78 kHz during each transmission, and then holds in a high state until the next transmission. The EECTRL bits when the two-pin interface is selected are shown in Table 60. 70 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 60: EECTRL Bits for 2-pin Interface Status Bit Name Read/ Write Reset State Polarity Description 7 6 5 ERROR BUSY RX_ACK R R R 0 0 1 Positive Positive Positive 4 TX_ACK R 1 Positive 1 when an illegal command is received. 1 when serial data bus is busy. 1 indicates that the EEPROM sent an ACK bit. 1 indicates that an ACK bit has been sent to the EEPROM. CMD[3:0] 0000 0010 3:0 CMD[3:0] W 0000 Positive 0011 0101 0110 1001 Others Operation No-op command. Receive a byte from the EEPROM and send ACK. Transmit a byte to the EEPROM. Issue a STOP sequence. Receive the last byte from the EEPROM and do not send ACK. Issue a START sequence. No operation, set the ERROR bit. The EEPROM interface can also be operated by controlling the DIO2 and DIO3 pins directly. The direction of the DIO line can be changed from input to output and an output value can be written with a single write operation, thus avoiding collisions (see Table 15 Port Registers (SEGDIO0-15)). Therefore, no resistor is required in series SDATA to protect against collisions. 2.5.9.2 Three-Wire (-Wire) EEPROM Interface with Single Data Pin A 500 kHz three-wire interface, using SDATA, SDCK, and a DIO pin for CS is available. The interface is selected by setting DIO_EEX[1:0] = 10. The EECTRL bits when the three-wire interface is selected are shown in Table 61. When EECTRL is written, up to 8 bits from EEDATA are either written to the EEPROM or read from the EEPROM, depending on the values of the EECTRL bits. 2.5.9.3 Three-Wire (-Wire/SPI) EEPROM Interface with Separate Di/DO Pins If DIO_EEX[1:0]=11, the three-wire interface is the same as above, except DI and DO are separate pins. In this case, SEGDIO3 becomes DO and SEGDIO8 becomes DI. The timing diagrams are the same as for DIO_EEX[1:0]=10 except that all output data appears on DO and all input data is expected on DI. In this mode, DI is ignored while data is being received on DO. This mode is compatible with SPI modes 0,0 and 1,1 where data is shifted out on the falling edge of the clock and is strobed in on the rising edge of the clock. Table 61: EECTRL Bits for the 3-Wire Interface Control Bit Name Read/ Write 7 WFR W 6 BUSY R 5 HiZ W Rev 5 Description Wait for Ready. If this bit is set, the trailing edge of BUSY is delayed until a rising edge is seen on the data line. This bit can be used during the last byte of a Write command to cause the INT5 interrupt to occur when the EEPROM has finished its internal write sequence. This bit is ignored if Hi-Z=0. Asserted while the serial data bus is busy. When the BUSY bit falls, an INT5 interrupt occurs. Indicates that the SD signal is to be floated to high impedance immediately after the last SDCK rising edge. 71 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Control Bit Name Read/ Write 4 RD W 3:0 CNT[3:0] W Description Indicates that EEDATA (SFR 0x9E) is to be filled with data from EEPROM. Specifies the number of clocks to be issued. Allowed values are 0 through 8. If RD=1, CNT bits of data are read MSB first, and right justified into the low order bits of EEDATA. If RD=0, CNT bits are sent MSB first to the EEPROM, shifted out of the MSB of EEDATA. If CNT[3:0] is zero, SDATA simply obeys the HiZ bit. The timing diagrams in Figure 22 through Figure 26 describe the 3-wire EEPROM interface behavior. All commands begin when the EECTRL (SFR 0x9F) register is written. Transactions start by first raising the DIO pin that is connected to CS. Multiple 8-bit or less commands such as those shown in Figure 22 through Figure 26 are then sent via EECTRL and EEDATA. When the transaction is finished, CS must be lowered. At the end of a Read transaction, the EEPROM is driving SDATA, but transitions to Hi-Z (high impedance) when CS falls. The firmware should then immediately issue a write command with CNT=0 and HiZ=0 to take control of SDATA and force it to a low-Z state. EECTRL Byte Written INT5 CNT Cycles (6 shown) Write -- No HiZ SCLK (output) SDATA (output) D7 D6 D5 SDATA output Z D4 D3 D2 (LoZ) BUSY (bit) Figure 22: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command, HiZ=0. EECTRL Byte Written INT5 CNT Cycles (6 shown) Write -- With HiZ SCLK (output) SDATA (output) D7 D6 D5 SDATA output Z D4 D3 D2 (LoZ) (HiZ) BUSY (bit) Figure 23: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command, HiZ=1 EECTRL Byte Written INT5 CNT Cycles (8 shown) READ SCLK (output) SDATA (input) SDATA output Z D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 (HiZ) BUSY (bit) Figure 24: 3-Wire Interface. Read Command. 72 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet EECTRL Byte Written INT5 not issued CNT Cycles (0 shown) Write -- No HiZ EECTRL Byte Written Write -- HiZ INT5 not issued CNT Cycles (0 shown) SCLK (output) SCLK (output) SDATA (output) SDATA (output) D7 SDATA output Z SDATA output Z (LoZ) (HiZ) BUSY (bit) BUSY (bit) Figure 25: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command when CNT=0 EECTRL Byte Written INT5 CNT Cycles (6 shown) Write -- With HiZ and WFR SCLK (output) SDATA (out/in) D7 D6 D5 (From 654x) SDATA output Z (LoZ) D4 D3 D2 BUSY (From EEPROM) READY (HiZ) BUSY (bit) Figure 26: 3-Wire Interface. Write Command when HiZ=1 and WFR=1. 2.5.10 SPI Slave Port The slave SPI port communicates directly with the MPU data bus and is able to read and write Data RAM and I/O RAM locations. It is also able to send commands to the MPU. The interface to the slave port consists of the SPI_CSZ, SPI_CKI, SPI_DI and SPI_DO pins. These pins are multiplexed with the combined DIO/LCD segment driver pins SEGDIO36 to SEGDIO39. Additionally, the SPI interface allows flash memory to be read and to be programmed. To facilitate flash programming, cycling power or asserting RESET causes the SPI port pins to default to SPI mode. The SPI port is disabled by clearing the SPI_E bit (I/O RAM 0x270C[4]). Possible applications for the SPI interface are: 1) An external host reads data from CE locations to obtain metering information. This can be used in applications where the 71M654x function as a smart front-end with preprocessing capability. Since the addresses are in 16-bit format, any type of XRAM data can be accessed: CE, MPU, I/O RAM, but not SFRs or the 80515-internal register bank. 2) A communication link can be established via the SPI interface: By writing into MPU memory locations, the external host can initiate and control processes in the 71M654x MPU. Writing to a CE or MPU location normally generates an interrupt, a function that can be used to signal to the MPU that the byte that had just been written by the external host must be read and processed. Data can also be inserted by the external host without generating an interrupt. 3) An external DSP can access front-end data generated by the ADC. This mode of operation uses the 71M654x as an analog front-end (AFE). 4) Flash programming by the external host (SPI Flash Mode). SPI Transactions A typical SPI transaction is as follows. While SPI_CSZ is high, the port is held in an initialized/reset state. During this state, SPI_DO is held in Hi-Z state and all transitions on SPI_CLK and SPI_DI are ignored. When SPI_CSZ falls, the port begins the transaction on the first rising edge of SPI_CLK. As shown in Table 62, a transaction consists of an optional 16 bit address, an 8 bit command, an 8 bit status byte, followed by one or more bytes of data. The transaction ends when SPI_CSZ is raised. Some transactions may consist of a command only. Rev 5 73 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet When SPI_CSZ rises, SPI command bytes that are not of the form x000 0000 update the SPI_CMD (SFR 0xFD) register and then cause an interrupt to be issued to the MPU. The exception is if the transaction was a single byte. In this case, the SPI_CMD byte is always updated and the interrupt issued. SPI_CMD is not cleared when SPI_CSZ is high. The SPI port supports data transfers up to 10 Mb/s. A serial read or write operation requires at least 8 clocks per byte, guaranteeing SPI access to the RAM is no faster than 1.25 MHz, thus ensuring that SPI access to DRAM is always possible. Table 62: SPI Transaction Fields Field Name Address Required Size (bytes) Description Yes, except for single-byte transaction Yes 2 16-bit address. The address field is not required if the transaction is a simple SPI command. 1 Status Yes, if transaction includes DATA 1 Data Yes, if transaction includes DATA 1 or more 8-bit command. This byte can be used as a command to the MPU. In multi-byte transactions, the MSB is the R/W bit. Unless the transaction is multi-byte and SPI_CMD is exactly 0x80 or 0x00, the SPI_CMD register is updated and an SPI interrupt is issued. Otherwise, the SPI_CMD register is unchanged and the interrupt is not issued. 8-bit status field, indicating the status of the previous transaction. This byte is also available in the MPU memory map as SPI_STAT (I/O RAM 0x2708) register. See Table 64 for the contents. The read or write data. Address is auto incremented for each new byte. Command The SPI_STAT byte is output on every SPI transaction and indicates the parity of the previous transaction and the error status of the previous transaction. Potential error sources are: * * 71M654x not ready. Transaction not ending on a byte boundary. SPI Safe Mode Sometimes it is desirable to prevent the SPI interface from writing to arbitrary RAM locations and thus disturbing MPU and CE operation. This is especially true in AFE applications. For this reason, the SPI SAFE mode was created. In SPI SAFE mode, SPI write operations are disabled except for a 16 byte transfer region at address 0x400 to 0x40F. If the SPI host needs to write to other addresses, it must use the SPI_CMD register to request the write operation from the MPU. SPI SAFE mode is enabled by the SPI_SAFE bit (I/O RAM 0x270C[3]). Single-Byte Transaction If a transaction is a single byte, the byte is interpreted as SPI_CMD. Regardless of the byte value, singlebyte transactions always update the SPI_CMD register and cause an SPI interrupt to be generated. Multi-Byte Transaction As shown in Figure 27, multi-byte operations consist of a 16 bit address field, an 8 bit CMD, a status byte, and a sequence of data bytes. A multi byte transaction is three or more bytes. 74 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet SERIAL READ 16 bit Address Status Byte 8 bit CMD DATA[ADDR] DATA[ADDR+1] Extended Read . . . (From Host) SPI_CSZ 0 15 16 A0 C7 23 31 24 32 39 40 D0 D7 47 (From Host) SPI_CK (From Host) SPI_DI A15 A14 A1 C6 C5 (From 6543) SPI_DO SERIAL WRITE x C0 HI Z ST7 16 bit Address ST6 ST5 ST0 D7 D6 Status Byte 8 bit CMD D1 DATA[ADDR] D6 D1 D0 DATA[ADDR+1] (From Host) SPI_CSZ Extended Write . . . 0 15 16 A0 C7 23 31 24 32 39 40 D0 D7 47 (From Host) SPI_CK (From Host) SPI_DI x A15 A14 A1 HI Z (From 6543) SPI_DO C6 C5 D7 C0 ST7 ST6 ST5 D6 D1 D6 D1 D0 x ST0 Figure 27: SPI Slave Port - Typical Multi-Byte Read and Write Operations Table 63: SPI Command Sequences Command Sequence ADDR 1xxx xxxx STATUS Byte0 ... ByteN ADDR 0xxx xxxx STATUS Byte0 ... ByteN Rev 5 Description Read data starting at ADDR. ADDR auto-increments until SPI_CSZ is raised. Upon completion, SPI_CMD (SFR 0xFD) is updated to 1xxx xxxx and an SPI interrupt is generated. The exception is if the command byte is 1000 0000. In this case, no MPU interrupt is generated and SPI_CMD is not updated. Write data starting at ADDR. ADDR auto-increments until SPI_CSZ is raised. Upon completion, SPI_CMD is updated to 0xxx xxxx and an SPI interrupt is generated. The exception is if the command byte is 0000 0000. In this case, no MPU interrupt is generated and SPI_CMD is not updated. 75 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 64: SPI Registers Name EX_SPI SPI_CMD Location Rst Wk Dir Description 2701[7] SFR FD[7:0] 0 - 0 - R/W R SPI_E 270C[4] 1 1 R/W IE_SPI SFR F8[7] 0 0 R/W SPI_SAFE 270C[3] 0 0 R/W SPI_STAT 2708[7:0] 0 0 R SPI interrupt enable bit. SPI command. The 8-bit command from the bus master. SPI port enable bit. It enables the SPI interface on pins SEGDIO36 - SEGDIO39. SPI interrupt flag. Set by hardware, cleared by writing a 0. Limits SPI writes to SPI_CMD and a 16 byte region in DRAM when set. No other write operations are permitted. SPI_STAT contains the status results from the previous SPI transaction. Bit 7: Ready error: The 71M654x was not ready to read or write as directed by the previous command. Bit 6: Read data parity: This bit is the parity of all bytes read from the 71M654x in the previous command. Does not include the SPI_STAT byte. Bit 5: Write data parity: This bit is the overall parity of the bytes written to the 71M654x in the previous command. It includes CMD and ADDR bytes. Bit 4-2: Bottom 3 bits of the byte count. Does not include ADDR and CMD bytes. One, two, and three byte instructions return 111. Bit 1: SPI FLASH mode: This bit is zero when the TEST pin is zero. Bit 0: SPI FLASH mode ready: Used in SPI FLASH mode. Indicates that the flash is ready to receive another write instruction. 76 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet SPI Flash Mode (SFM) In normal operation, the SPI slave interface cannot read or write the flash memory. However, the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G support an SPI Flash Mode (SFM) which facilitates initial programming of the flash memory. When in SFM mode, the SPI can erase, read, and write the flash memory. Other memory elements such as XRAM and I/O RAM are not accessible in this mode. In order to protect the flash contents, several operations are required before the SFM mode is successfully invoked. In SFM mode, n byte reads and dual-byte writes to flash memory are supported. See the SPI Transactions description on Page 73 for the format of read and write commands. Since the flash write operation is always based on a two-byte word, the initial address must always be even. Data is written to the 16-bit flash memory bus after the odd word is written. In SFM mode, the MPU is completely halted. For this reason, the interrupt feature described in the SPI Transaction section above is not available in SFM mode. The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G must be reset by the WD timer or by the RESET pin in order to exit SFM mode. Invoking SFM The following conditions must be met prior to invoking SFM: * * * * * Pin ICE_E = 1. This disables the watchdog and adds another layer of protection against inadvertent Flash corruption. The external power source (V3P3SYS, V3P3A) is at the proper level (> 3.0 VDC). PREBOOT = 0 (SFR 0xB2[7]). This validates the state of the SECURE bit (SFR 0xB2[6]). SECURE = 0. This I/O RAM register indicates that SPI secure mode is not enabled. Operations are limited to SFM Mass Erase mode if the SECURE bit = 1 (Flash read back is not allowed in Secure mode). FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2702[7:4]) = 0010. The I/O RAM registers SFMM (I/O RAM 0x2080) and SFMS (I/O RAM 0x2081) are used to invoke SFM. Only the SPI interface has access to these two registers. This eliminates an indirect path from the MPU for disabling the watchdog. SFMM and SFMS need to be written to in sequence in order to invoke SFM. This sequential write process prevents inadvertent entering of SFM. The sequence for invoking SFM is: * First, write to the SFMM (I/O RAM 0x2080) register. The value written to this register defines the SFM mode. o 0xD1: Mass Erase mode. A Flash Mass erase cycle is invoked upon entering SFM. o 0x2E: Flash Read back mode. SFM is entered for Flash read back purposes. Flash writes are not be blocked and it is up to the user to guarantee that only previously unwritten locations are written. This mode is not accessible when SPI secure mode is set. o SFM is not invoked if any other pattern is written to the SFMM register. * Next, write 0x96 to the SFMS (I/O RAM 0x2081) register. This action invokes SFM provided that the previous write operation to SFMM met the requirements. Writing any other pattern to this register does not invoke SFM. Additionally, any write operations to this register automatically reset the previously written SFMM register values to zero. Rev 5 77 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet SFM Details The following occurs upon entering SFM. * * * * * The CE is disabled. The MPU is halted. Once the MPU is halted it can only be restarted with a reset. This reset can be accomplished with the RESET pin, a watchdog reset, or by cycling power (without battery at the VBAT pin). The Flash control logic is reset in case the MPU was in the middle of a Flash write operation or Erase cycle. Mass erase is invoked if specified in the SFMM register, I/O RAM 0x2080 (see Invoking SFM, above). The SECURE bit (SFR 0xB2[6]) is cleared at the end of this and all Mass Erase cycles. All SPI read and write operations now refer to Flash instead of XRAM space. The SPI host can access the current state of the pending multi-cycle Flash access by performing a 4-byte SPI write of any address and checking the status field. All SPI write operations in SFM mode must be 6-byte write transaction that writes two bytes to an even address. The write transactions must contain a command byte of the form 0xxx xxxx. Auto incrementing is disabled for write operations. SPI read transactions can make use of auto increment and may access single bytes. The command byte must always be of the form 1xxx xxxx in SFM read transactions. SPI commands in SFM Interrupts are not generated in SFM since the MPU is halted. The format of the commands is described in the SPI Transactions description on Page 73. 2.5.11 Hardware Watchdog Timer An independent, robust, fixed-duration, watchdog timer (WDT) is included in the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G. It uses the RTC crystal oscillator as its time base and must be refreshed by the MPU firmware at least every 1.5 seconds. When not refreshed on time, the WDT overflows and the part is reset as if the RESET pin were pulled high, except that the I/O RAM bits are in the same state as after a wake-up from SLP or LCD modes (see the I/O RAM description in 5.2 I/O RAM Map - Alphabetical Order for a list of I/O RAM bit states after RESET and wake-up). After 4100 CK32 cycles (or 125 ms) following the WDT overflow, the MPU is launched from program address 0x0000. The watchdog timer is also reset when the internal signal WAKE=0 (see 3.4 Wake Up Behavior). For details, see 3.3.4 Watchdog Timer Reset. 2.5.12 Test Ports (TMUXOUT and TMUX2OUT Pins) Two independent multiplexers allow the selection of internal analog and digital signals for the TMUXOUT and TMUX2OUT pins. These pins are multiplexed with the SEG47 and SEG46 function. In order to function as test pins, LCD_MAP[46] (I/O RAM 0x2406[6]) and LCD_MAP[47] (I/O RAM 0x2406[7]) must be 0. One of the digital or analog signals listed in Table 65 can be selected to be output on the TMUXOUT pin. The function of the multiplexer is controlled with the I/O RAM register TMUX[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2502[5:0], as shown in Table 65. One of the digital or analog signals listed in Table 66 can be selected to be output on the TMUX2OUT pin. The function of the multiplexer is controlled with the I/O RAM register TMUX2[4:0] (I/O RAM 0x2503[4:0]), as shown in Table 66. The TMUX[5:0] and TMUX2[4:0] I/O RAM locations are non-volatile and their contents are preserved by battery power and across resets. 78 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The TMUXOUT and TMUX2OUT pins may be used for diagnostics purposes during the product development cycle or in the production test. The RTC 1-second output may be used to calibrate the crystal oscillator. The RTC 4-second output provides higher precision for RTC calibration. RTCLK may also be used to calibrate the RTC. Table 65: TMUX[5:0] Selections Signal Name Description 1 RTCLK 9 WD_RST A CKMPU D V3AOK bit E V3OK bit 1B MUX_SYNC 32.768 kHz clock waveform Indicates when the MPU has reset the watchdog timer. Can be monitored to determine spare time in the watchdog timer. MPU clock - see Table 9 Indicates that the V3P3A pin voltage is 3.0 V. The V3P3A and V3P3SYS pins are expected to be tied together at the PCB level. The 71M654x monitors the V3P3A pin voltage only. Indicates that the V3P3A pin voltage is 2.8 V. The V3P3A and V3P3SYS pins are expected to be tied together at the PCB level. The 71M654x monitors the V3P3A pin voltage only. Internal multiplexer frame SYNC signal. See Figure 6 and Figure 7. 1C 1D 1F CE_BUSY interrupt CE_XFER interrupt RTM output from CE TMUX[5:0] See 2.3.3 on page 25 and Figure 16 on page 47 See 2.3.5 on page 25 Note: All TMUX[5:0] values which are not shown are reserved. Table 66: TMUX2[4:0] Selections Signal Name Description 0 WD_OVF 1 PULSE_1S 2 PULSE_4S 3 A RTCLK SPARE[1] bit - I/O RAM 0x2704[1] SPARE[2] bit - I/O RAM 0x2704[2] WAKE B MUX_SYNC C E 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 1F MCK GNDD INT0 - DIG I/O INT1 - DIG I/O INT2 - CE_PULSE INT3 - CE_BUSY INT4 - VSTAT INT5 - EEPROM/SPI INT6 - XFER, RTC RTM_CK (flash) Indicates when the watchdog timer has expired (overflowed). One second pulse with 25% Duty Cycle. This signal can be used to measure the deviation of the RTC from an ideal 1 second interval. Multiple cycles should be averaged together to filter out jitter. Four second pulse with 25% Duty Cycle. This signal can be used to measure the deviation of the RTC from an ideal 4 second interval. Multiple cycles should be averaged together to filter out jitter. The 4 second pulse provides a more precise measurement than the 1 second pulse. 32.768 kHz clock waveform Copies the value of the bit stored in 0x2704[1]. For general purpose use. Copies the value of the bit stored in 0x2704[2]. For general purpose use. Indicates when a WAKE event has occurred. Internal multiplexer frame SYNC signal. See Figure 6 and Figure 7. See 2.5.3 on page 50 Digital GND. Use this signal to make the TMUX2OUT pin static. TMUX2[4:0] 8 9 Interrupt 0. See 2.4.8 on page 41. Also see Figure 16 on page 47. See 2.3.5 on page 25. Note: All TMUX2[4:0] values which are not shown are reserved. Rev 5 79 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3 Functional Description 3.1 Theory of Operation The energy delivered by a power source into a load can be expressed as: t E = V (t ) I (t )dt 0 Assuming phase angles are constant, the following formulae apply: P = Real Energy [Wh] = V * A * cos * t S = Apparent Energy [VAh] = Q = Reactive Energy [VARh] = V * A * sin * t P2 + Q2 For a practical meter, not only voltage and current amplitudes, but also phase angles and harmonic content may change constantly. Thus, simple RMS measurements are inherently inaccurate. A modern solid-state electricity meter IC such as the 71M654x functions by emulating the integral operation above, i.e., it processes current and voltage samples through an ADC at a constant frequency. As long as the ADC resolution is high enough and the sample frequency is beyond the harmonic range of interest, the current and voltage samples, multiplied with the time period of sampling yield an accurate quantity for the momentary energy. Summing up the momentary energy quantities over time results in very accurate results for accumulated energy. 500 400 300 200 100 0 0 5 10 15 20 -100 -200 Current [A] -300 Voltage [V] Energy per Interval [Ws] -400 Accumulated Energy [Ws] -500 Figure 28: Voltage, Current, Momentary and Accumulated Energy Figure 28 shows the shapes of V(t), I(t), the momentary power and the accumulated power, resulting from 50 samples of the voltage and current signals over a period of 20 ms. The application of 240 VAC and 100 A results in an accumulation of 480 Ws (= 0.133 Wh) over the 20 ms period, as indicated by the accumulated power curve. The described sampling method works reliably, even in the presence of dynamic phase shift and harmonic distortion. 80 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.2 Battery Modes Shortly after system power (V3P3SYS) is applied, the part is in mission mode (MSN mode). MSN mode means that the part is operating with system power and that the internal PLL is stable. This mode is the normal operating mode where the part is capable of measuring energy. When system power is not available, the 71M654x is in one of three battery modes: * * * BRN mode (brownout mode) LCD mode (LCD-only mode) SLP mode (sleep mode). An internal comparator monitors the voltage at the V3P3SYS pin (note that V3P3SYS and V3P3A are typically connected together at the PCB level). When the V3P3SYS dc voltage drops below 3.0 VDC, the comparator resets an internal power status bit called V3OK . As soon as system power is removed and V3OK = 0, the 71M654x switches to battery power (VBAT pin), notifies the MPU by issuing an interrupt and updates the VSTAT[2:0] register (SFR 0xF9[2:0], see Table 68). The MPU continues to execute code when the system transitions from MSN to BRN mode. Refer to 3.2.1 BRN Mode for the settings that result in the lowest possible power during BRN mode. Depending on the MPU code, the MPU can choose to stay in BRN mode, or transition to LCD or to SLP mode (via the I/O RAM bits LCD_ONLY, I/O RAM 0x28B2[6] and SLEEP, I/O RAM 0x28B2[7]). BRN mode is similar to MSN mode except that resources powered by V3P3A power, such as the ADC are inaccurate. In BRN mode the CE continues to run and should be turned off to conserve VBAT power. Also, the PLL continues to function at the same frequency as in MSN mode and its frequency should be reduced to save power (CKGN = 0x24 (I/O RAM 0x2200). When system power is restored, the 71M654x automatically transitions from any of the battery modes (BRN, LCD, SLP) back to MSN mode, switches back to using system power (V3P3SYS, V3P3A), issues an interrupt and updates VSTAT[1:0]. The MPU software should restore MSN mode operation by issuing a soft reset to restore system settings to values appropriate for MSN mode. Figure 29 shows a state diagram of the various operating modes, with the possible transitions between modes. When the part wakes-up under battery power, the part automatically enters BRN mode (see 3.4 Wake Up Behavior). From BRN mode, the part may enter either LCD mode or SLP mode, as controlled by the MPU. RESET MSN V3P3SYS falls VSTAT=00X V3P3SYS rises System Power Battery Power VSTAT=001 V3P3SYS rises LCD_ONLY BRN V3P3SYS rises RESET & VBAT sufficient Wake Flags SLEEP or VBAT insufficient Wake event LCD Wake event VBAT insufficient VBAT insufficient RESET & VBAT insufficient SLP Figure 29: Operation Modes State Diagram Rev 5 81 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Transitions from both LCD and SLP mode to BRN mode can be initiated by the following events: * * * * Wake-up timer timeout. Pushbutton (PB) is activated. A rising edge on SEGDIO4, or a high logic level on SEGDIO52 (71M6542F/G only) or SEGDIO55. Activity on the RX or OPT_RX pins. The MPU has access to a variety of registers that signal the event that caused the wake up. See 3.4 Wake Up Behavior for details. Table 67 shows the circuit functions available in each operating mode. Table 67: Available Circuit Functions Circuit Function CE (Computation Engine) FIR ADC, VREF PLL Battery Measurement Temperature sensor Max MPU clock rate System Power MSN (Mission Mode) PLL_FAST=1 PLL_FAST=0 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 4.92MHz (from PLL) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 38.4kHz Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 1.57MHz (from PLL) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 38.9kHz Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Battery Power BRN (Brownout Mode) LCD PLL_FAST=1 PLL_FAST=0 Note 1 --Yes Yes Yes 4.92MHz (from PLL) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 38.4kHz Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Note 1 --Yes Yes Yes 1.57MHz (from PLL) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 38.9kHz Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 2 SLEEP ---Boost2 -Yes -----Yes -- -- MPU_DIV clk. divider --ICE --DIO Pins --Watchdog Timer --LCD Yes -LCD Boost Yes EEPROM Interface (2-wire) --EEPROM Interface (3-wire) --UART (full speed) --Optical TX modulation --Flash Read --Flash Page Erase --Flash Write --RAM Read and Write --Wakeup Timer Yes Yes OSC and RTC Yes Yes DRAM data preservation --NV RAM data preservation Yes Yes Notes: 1. The CE is active in BRN mode, but ADC data is inaccurate. The MPU should halt the CE to conserve power (CE_E = 0, I/O RAM 0x2106[0]). 2. "--" indicates that the corresponding circuit is not active 3. "Boost" implies that the LCD boost circuit is active (i.e., LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 10 (I/O RAM 0x2401[7:6]). The LCD boost circuit requires a clock from the PLL to function. Thus, the PLL is automatically kept active if LCD boost is active while in LCD mode, otherwise the PLL is de-activated. 82 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.2.1 BRN Mode In BRN mode, most non-metering digital functions are active (as shown in Table 67) including ICE, UART, EEPROM, LCD and RTC. In BRN mode, the PLL continues to function at the same frequency as MSN mode. It is up to the MPU to scale down the PLL (using PLL_FAST, I/O RAM 0x2200[4]) or the MPU frequency (using MPU_DIV[2:0], I/O RAM 0x2200[2:0]) in order to save power. From BRN mode, the MPU can choose to enter LCD or SLP modes. When system power is restored while the 71M654x is in BRN mode, the part automatically transitions to MSN mode. The recommended minimum power configuration for BRN mode is as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * RCE0 = 0x00 (I/O RAM 0x2709[7:0]) - remote sensors disabled LCD_BAT = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2402[7]) - LCD powered from VBAT LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2401[7:6]) - 5V LCD boost disabled CE6 = 0x00 (I/O RAM 0x2106) - CE, RTM and CHOP are disabled MUX_DIV[3:0] = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4]) - the ADC multiplexer is disabled ADC_E = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2704[4]) - ADC disabled VREF_CAL = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2704[7]) - Vref not driven out VREF_DIS = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2704[6]) - Vref disabled PRE_E = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2704[5] - pre-amp disabled BCURR = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2704[3]) - battery 100A current load OFF TMUX[5:0] = 0x0E (I/O RAM 0x2502[5:0]) - TMUXOUT output set to a dc value TMUX2[4:0] = 0x0E (I/O RAM 0x2503[4:0]) - TMUXOUT2 output set to a dc value CKGN = 0x24 (I/O RAM 0x2200) - PLL set slow, MPU_DIV[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2200[2:0]) set to maximum TEMP_PER[2:0] = 6 (I/O RAM 0x28A0[2:0]) - temp measurement set to automatic every 512 s TEMP_BSEL = 1 (I/O RAM 0x28A0[7]) - temperature sensor monitors VBAT PCON = 1 (SFR 0x87) - at the end of the main BRN loop, halt the MPU and wait for an interrupt The baud rate registers are adjusted as desired All unused interrupts are disabled 3.2.2 LCD Mode LCD mode may be commanded by the MPU at any time by setting the LCD_ONLY control bit (I/O RAM 0x28B2[6]). However, it is recommended that the LCD_ONLY control bit be set by the MPU only after the 71M654x has entered BRN mode. For example, if the 71M654x is in MSN mode when LCD_ONLY is set, the duration of LCD mode is very brief and the 71M654x immediately 'wakes'. In LCD mode, V3P3D is disabled, thus removing all current leakage from the VBAT pin. Before asserting LCD_ONLY mode, it is recommended that the MPU minimize PLL current by reducing the output frequency of the PLL to 6.2 MHz (i.e., write PLL_FAST = 0, I/O RAM 0x2200[4]). The LCD boost system requires a clock from the PLL for its operation. Thus, if the LCD boost system is enabled (i.e., LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 10, I/O RAM 0x2401[7:6]), then the PLL is automatically kept active during LCD mode, otherwise the PLL is de-activated. In LCD mode, the data contained in the LCD_SEG registers is displayed using the segment driver pins. Up to two LCD segments connected to the pins SEGDIO22 and SEGDIO23 can be made to blink without the involvement of the MPU, which is disabled in LCD mode. To minimize battery power consumption, only segments that are used should be enabled. After the transition from LCD mode to MSN or BRN mode, the PC (Program Counter) is at 0x0000, the XRAM is in an undefined state, and configuration I/O RAM bits are reset (see Table 76 for I/O RAM state upon wake). The data stored in non-volatile I/O RAM locations is preserved in LCD mode (the shaded locations in Table 76 are non-volatile). Rev 5 83 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.2.3 SLP Mode When the V3P3SYS pin voltage drops below 2.8 VDC, the 71M654x enters BRN mode and the V3P3D pin obtains power from the VBAT pin instead of the V3P3SYS pin. Once in BRN mode, the MPU may invoke SLP mode by setting the SLEEP bit (I/O RAM 0x28B2[7]). The purpose of SLP mode is to consume the least amount power while still maintaining the RTC (Real Time Clock), temperature compensation of the RTC, and the non-volatile portions of the I/O RAM. In SLP mode, the V3P3D pin is disconnected, removing all sources of current leakage from the VBAT pin. The non-volatile I/O RAM locations and the SLP mode functions, such as the temperature sensor, oscillator, RTC, and the RTC temperature compensation are powered by the VBAT_RTC pin. SLP mode can be exited only by a system power-up event or one of the wake methods described in 3.4 Wake Up Behavior. If the SLEEP bit is asserted when V3P3SYS pin power is present (i.e., while in MSN mode), the 71M654x enters SLP mode, resetting the internal WAKE signal, at which point the 71M654x begins the standard wake from sleep procedures as described in 3.4 Wake Up Behavior. When power is restored to the V3P3SYS pin, the 71M654x transitions from SLP mode to MSN mode and the MPU PC (Program Counter) is initialized to 0x0000. At this point, the XRAM is in an undefined state, but non-volatile I/O RAM locations are preserved (the shaded locations in Table 76 are non-volatile). 84 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.3 Fault and Reset Behavior 3.3.1 Events at Power-Down Power fault detection is performed by internal comparators that monitor the voltage at the V3P3A pin and also monitor the internally generated VDD pin voltage (2.5 VDC). The V3P3SYS and V3P3A pins must be tied together at the PCB level, so that the comparators, which are internally connected only to the V3P3A pin, are able to simultaneously monitor the common V3P3SYS and V3P3A pin voltage. The following discussion assumes that the V3P3A and V3P3SYS pins are tied together at the PCB level. During a power failure, as V3P3A falls, two thresholds are detected: * * The first threshold, at 3.0 VDC (VSTAT[2:0] = 001), warns the MPU that the analog modules are no longer accurate. Other than warning the MPU, the hardware takes no action when this threshold is crossed. The second threshold, at 2.8 VDC, causes the 71M654x to switch to battery power. This switching happens while the FLASH and RAM systems are still able to read and write. The power quality is reflected by the SFR VSTAT[2:0] field, as shown in Table 68. The VSTAT[2:0] field is located at SFR address 0xF9 and occupies bits [2:0], and it is read-only. In addition to the state of the main power, the VSTAT[2:0] register provides information about the internal VDD voltage under battery power. Note that if system power (V3P3A) is above 2.8 VDC, the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G always switch from battery to system power. Table 68: VSTAT[2:0] (SFR 0xF9[2:0]) VSTAT[2:0] 000 001 010 011 101 Description System Power OK. V3P3A > 3.0 VDC. Analog modules are functional and accurate. System Power is low. 2.8 VDC < V3P3A < 3.0 VDC. Analog modules not accurate. Switch over to battery power is imminent. The IC is on battery power and VDD is OK. VDD > 2.25 VDC. The IC has full digital functionality. The IC is on battery power and 2.25 VDC > VDD > 2.0 VDC. Flash write operations are inhibited. The IC is on battery power and VDD < 2.0, which means that the MPU is nearly out of voltage. A reset occurs in 4 cycles of the crystal clock CK32. The response to a system power fault is almost entirely controlled by firmware. During a power failure, system power slowly falls. This is monitored by internal comparators that cause the hardware to automatically switch over to taking power from the VBAT input. An interrupt notifies the MPU that the part is now battery powered. At this point, it is the MPU's responsibility to reduce power by slowing the clock rate, disabling the PLL, etc. Precision analog components such as the bandgap reference, the bandgap buffer, and the ADC are powered only by the V3P3A pin and become inaccurate and ultimately unavailable as the V3P3A pin voltage continues to drop (i.e., circuits powered by the V3P3A pin are not backed by the VBAT pin). When the V3P3A pin falls below 2.8 VDC, the ADC clocks are halted and the amplifiers are unbiased. Meanwhile, control bits such as ADC_E bit (I/O RAM 0x2704[4]) are not affected, since their I/O RAM storage is powered from the VDD pin (2.5 VDC). The VDD pin is supplied with power through an internal 2.5 VDC regulator that is connected to the V3P3D pin. In turn, the V3P3D pin is switched to receive power from the VBAT pin when the V3P3SYS pin drops below 3.0 VDC. Note that the V3P3SYS and V3P3A pins are typically tied together at the PCB level. Rev 5 85 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.3.2 IC Behavior at Low Battery Voltage When system power is not present, the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G rely on the VBAT pin for power. If the VBAT voltage is not sufficient to maintain VDD at 2.0 VDC or greater, the MPU cannot operate reliably. Low VBAT voltage can occur while the part is operating in BRN mode, or while it is dormant in SLP or LCD mode. Two cases can be distinguished, depending on MPU code: * Case 1: System power is not present, and the part is waking from SLP or LCD mode. In this case, the hardware checks the value of VDD to determine if processor operation is possible. If it is not possible, the part configures itself for BRN operation, and holds the processor in reset (WAKE=0). In this mode, VBAT powers the 1.0 VDC reference for the LCD system, the VDD regulator, the PLL, and the fault comparator. The part remains in this waiting mode until VDD becomes high due to system power being applied or the VBAT battery being replaced or recharged. * Case 2: The part is operating under VBAT power and VSTAT[2:0] (SFR 0xF9[2:0]) becomes 101, indicating that VDD falls below 2.0 VDC. In this case, the firmware has two choices: 1) One choice is to assert the SLEEP bit (I/O RAM 0x28B2[7]) immediately. This assertion preserves the remaining charge in VBAT. Of course, if the battery voltage is not increased, the 71M654x enters Case 1 as soon as it tries to wake up. 2) The alternative choice is to enter the waiting mode described in Case 1 immediately. Specifically, if the firmware does not assert the SLEEP bit, the hardware resets the processor four CE32 clock cycles (i.e., 122 s) after VSTAT[2:0] becomes 101 and, as described in Case 1, it begins waiting for VDD to become greater than 2.0 VDC. The MPU wakes up when system power returns, or when VDD becomes greater than 2.0 VDC. In either case, when VDD recovers, and when the MPU wakes up, the WF_BADVDD flag (I/O RAM 0x28B0[2]) can be read to determine that the processor is recovering from a bad VBAT condition. The WF_BADVDD flag remains set until the next time WAKE falls. This flag is independent of the other WF flags. In all cases, low VBAT voltage does not corrupt RTC operation, the state of NV memory, or the state of non-volatile memory. These circuits depend on the VBAT_RTC pin for power. 3.3.3 Reset Sequence When the RESET pin is pulled high, all digital activity in the chip stops, with the exception of the oscillator and RTC. Additionally, all I/O RAM bits are forced to their RST state. Reliable reset does not occur until RESET has been high at least for 2 s. Note that TMUX and the RTC do not reset unless the TEST pin is pulled high while RESET is high. The RESET control bit (I/O RAM 0x 2200[3]) performs an identical reset to the RESET pin except that a significantly shorter reset timer is used. Once initiated, the reset sequence waits until the reset timer times out. The time-out occurs in 4100 CE32 cycles (125 ms), at which time the MPU begins executing its pre-boot and boot sequences from address 0x0000. See 2.5.1.1 Hardware Watchdog Timer for a detailed description of the pre-boot and boot sequences. If system power is not present, the reset timer duration is two CE32 cycles, at which time the MPU begins executing in BRN mode, starting at address 0x0000. A softer form of reset is initiated when the E_RST pin of the ICE interface is pulled low. This event causes the MPU and other registers in the MPU core to be reset but does not reset the remainder of the IC, for example the I/O RAM. It does not trigger the reset sequence. This type of reset is intended to reset the MPU program, but not to make other changes to the chip's state. 3.3.4 Watchdog Timer Reset The watchdog timer (WDT) is described in 2.5.11 Hardware Watchdog Timer. A status bit, WF_OVF (I/O RAM 0x28B0[4]), is set when a WDT overflow occurs. Similar to the other wake flags, this bit is powered by the non-volatile supply and can be read by the MPU to determine if the part is initializing after a WD overflow event or after a power up. The WF_OVF bit is cleared by the RESET pin. 86 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet There is no internal digital state that could deactivate the WDT. For debug purposes, however, the WDT can be disabled by raising the ICE_E pin to 3.3 VDC. In normal operation, the WDT is reset by periodically writing a one to the WD_RST control bit (I/O RAM 0x28B4[7]). The watchdog timer is also reset when the 71M654x wakes from LCD or SLP mode, and when ICE_E = 1. 3.4 Wake Up Behavior As described above, the part always wakes-up in MSN mode when system power is restored. As described in 3.2 Battery Modes, transitions from both LCD and SLP mode to BRN mode can be initiated by a wake-up timer timeout, when the pushbutton (PB) input is high, a rising edge on SEGDIO4, or a high logic level on SEGDIO52 or SEGDIO55, or by activity on the RX or OPT_RX pins. 3.4.1 Wake on Hardware Events The following pin signal events wake the 71M654x from SLP or LCD mode: a high level on the PB pin, either edge on the RX pin, a rising edge on the SEGDIO4 pin, a high level on the SEGDIO52 pin (71M6542F/G only), or a high level on the SEGDIO55 pin or either edge on the OPT_RX pin. See Table 69 for de-bounce details on each pin and for further details on the OPT_RX/SEGDIO55 pin. The SEGDIO4, SEGDIO52 (71M6542F/G only), and SEGDIO55 pins must be configured as DIO inputs and their wake enable (EW_x bits) must be set. In SLP and LCD modes, the MPU is held in reset and cannot poll pins or react to interrupts. When one of the hardware wake events occurs, the internal WAKE signal rises and within three CK32 cycles the MPU begins to execute. The MPU can determine which one of the pins awakened it by checking the WF_PB, WF_RX, WF_SEGDIO4, WF_DIO52 (71M6542F/G only), or WF_DIO55 flags (see Table 69). If the part is in SLP or LCD mode, it can be awakened by a high level on the PB pin. This pin is normally pulled to GND and can be connected externally so it may be pulled high by a push button depression. Some pins are de-bounced to reject EMI noise. Detection hardware ignores all transitions after the initial transition. Table 69 shows which pins are equipped with de-bounce circuitry. Pins that do not have de-bounce circuits must still be high for at least 2 s to be recognized. The wake enable and flag bits are also shown in Table 69. The wake flag bits are set by hardware when the MPU wakes from a wake event. Note that the PB flag is set whenever the PB is pushed, even if the part is already awake. Table 71 lists the events that clear the WF flags. In addition to push buttons and timers, the part can also reboot due to the RESET pin, the RESET bit (I/O RAM 0x2200[3]), the WDT, the cold start detector, and E_RST. As seen in Table 69, each of these mechanisms has a flag bit to alert the MPU to the source of the wakeup. If the wake-up is caused by return of system power, there is no active WF flag and the VSTAT[2:0] field (SFR 0xF9[2:0]) indicate that system power is stable. Rev 5 87 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 69: Wake Enables and Flag Bits Wake Enable Wake Flag De-bounce Description Name Location Name Location WAKE_ARM 28B2[5] WF_TMR 28B1[5] No Wake on Timer. EW_PB 28B3[3] WF_PB 28B1[3] Yes Wake on PB*. EW_RX 28B3[4] WF_RX 28B1[4] 2 s Wake on either edge of RX. EW_DIO4 28B3[2] WF_DIO4 28B1[2] 2 s Wake on SEGDIO4. EW_DIO52 28B3[1] WF_DIO52 28B1[1] Yes Wake on SEGDIO52*. WF_DIO55 28B1[0] Yes Always Enabled Always Enabled WF_RST WF_RSTBIT 28B0[6] 28B0[5] 2 s No Always Enabled WF_ERST 28B0[3] 2 s Always Enabled WF_OVF 28B0[4] No Always Enabled WF_CSTART 28B0[7] No Always Enabled WF_BADVDD 28B0[2] No EW_DIO55 28B3[0] OPT_RXDIS = 1: Wake on DIO55* with 64 ms de-bounce. OPT_RXDIS = 0: Wake on either edge of OPT_RX with 2 s debounce. OPT_RXDIS: I/O RAM 0x2457[2] Wake after RESET. Wake after RESET bit. Wake after E_RST. (ICE must be enabled) Wake after WD reset. Wake after cold start - the first application of power. Wake after insufficient VBAT voltage. 71M6542F/G only. *This pin is sampled every 2 ms and must remain high for 64 ms to be declared a valid high level. This pin is high-level sensitive. 88 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 70: Wake Bits Name Location RST WK Dir EW_DIO4 28B3[2] 0 - R/W EW_DIO52 28B3[1] 0 - R/W EW_DIO55 28B3[0] 0 - R/W WAKE_ARM 28B2[5] 0 - R/W EW_PB 28B3[3] 0 - R/W EW_RX 28B3[4] 0 - R/W WF_DIO4 28B1[2] 0 - R WF_DIO52 28B1[1] 0 - R WF_DIO55 28B1[0] 0 - R WF_TMR WF_PB WF_RX WF_RST WF_RSTBIT WF_ERST WF_CSTART WF_BADVDD 28B1[5] 28B1[3] 28B1[4] 28B0[6] 28B0[5] 28B0[3] 28B0[7] 28B0[2] 0 0 0 * * * * * - - - R R R Rev 5 - R Description Connects SEGDIO4 to the WAKE logic and permits SEGDIO4 rising to wake the part. This bit has no effect unless SEGDIO4 is configured as a digital input. Connects DIO52 to the WAKE logic and permits DIO52 high-level to wake the part (71M6542F/G only). This bit has no effect unless DIO52 is configured as a digital input. Connects DIO55 to the WAKE logic and permits DIO55 high-level to wake the part. This bit has no effect unless DIO55 is configured as a digital input. Arms the WAKE timer and loads it with the value in the WAKE_TMR register (I/O RAM 0x2880). When SLP mode or LCD mode is asserted by the MPU, the WAKE timer becomes active. Connects the PB pin to the WAKE logic and permits PB high-level to wake the part. PB is always configured as an input. Connects the RX pin to the WAKE logic and permits RX rising to wake the part. See 3.4.1 for de-bounce issues. SEGDIO4 flag bit. If SEGDIO4 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set whenever SEGDIO4 rises. It is held in reset if SEGDIO4 is not configured for wakeup. SEGDIO52 flag bit. If SEGDIO52 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set whenever SEGDIO52 is a high level. It is held in reset if SEGDIO52 is not configured for wakeup (71M6542F/G only). SEGDIO55 flag bit. If SEGDIO55 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set whenever SEGDIO55 is a high level. It is held in reset if SEGDIO55 is not configured for wakeup. Indicates that the Wake timer caused the part to wake up. Indicates that the PB pin caused the part to wake. Indicates that RX pin caused the part to wake. Indicates that the RST pin, E_RST pin, RESET bit (I/O RAM 0x2200[3]), the cold start detector, or low voltage on the VBAT pin caused the part to reset. *See Table 71 for details. 89 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 71: Clear Events for WAKE flags Flag Wake on: Clear Events WF_TMR Timer expiration WAKE falls WF_PB PB pin high level WAKE falls WF_RX Either edge RX pin WAKE falls WF_DIO4 SEGDIO4 rising edge WAKE falls WF_DIO52 SEGDIO52 high level (71M6542F/G only) If OPT_RXDIS = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2457[2]), wake on SEGDIO55 high If OPT_RXDIS = 0 wake on either edge of OPT_RX WAKE falls RESET pin driven high WAKE falls, WF_CSTART, WF_RSTBIT, WF_OVF, WF_BADVDD RESET bit is set (I/O RAM 0x2200[3]) WAKE falls, WF_CSTART, WF_OVF, WF_BADVDD, WF_RST WF_DIO55 WF_RST WF_RSTBIT WF_ERST WF_OVF WF_CSTART E_RST pin driven high and the ICE interface must be enabled by driving the ICE_E pin high. Watchdog (WD) reset Coldstart (i.e., after the application of first power) WAKE falls WAKE falls, WF_CSTART, WF_RST, WF_OVF, WF_RSTBIT WAKE falls, WF_CSTART, WF_RSTBIT, WF_BADVDD, WF_RST WAKE falls, WF_RSTBIT, WF_OVF, WF_BADVDD, WF_RST Note: "WAKE falls" implies that the internal WAKE signal has been reset, which happens automatically upon entry into LCD mode or SLEEP mode (i.e., when the MPU sets the LCD_ONLY bit (I/O RAM 0x28B2[6]) or the SLEEP (I/O RAM 0x28B2[7]) bit). When the internal WAKE signal resets, all wake flags are reset. Since the various wake flags are automatically reset when WAKE falls, it is not necessary for the MPU to reset these flags before entering LCD mode or SLEEP mode. Also, other wake events can cause the wake flag to reset, as indicated above (e.g., the WF_RST flag can also be reset by any of the following flags setting: WF_CSTART, WS_RSTBIT, WF_OVF, WF_BADVDD) 3.4.2 Wake on Timer If the part is in SLP or LCD mode, it can be awakened by the Wake Timer. Until this timer times out, the MPU is in reset due to the internal WAKE signal being low. When the Wake Timer times out, WAKE rises and within three CK32 cycles, the MPU begins to execute. The MPU can determine that the timer woke it by checking the WF_TMR wake flag (I/O RAM 0x28B1[2]). The Wake Timer begins timing when the part enters LCD or SLP mode. Its duration is controlled by the value in the WAKE_TMR[7:0] register (I/O RAM 0x2880). The timer duration is WAKE_TMR +1 seconds. The Wake Timer is armed by setting WAKE_ARM = 1 (I/O RAM 0x28B2[5]). It must be armed at least three RTC cycles before either SLP or LCD modes are initiated. Setting WAKE_ARM presets the timer with the value in WAKE_TMR and readies the timer to start when the MPU writes to the SLEEP (I/O RAM 0x28B2[7]) or LCD_ONLY (I/O RAM 0x28B2[6]) bits. The timer is neither reset nor disarmed when the MPU wakes-up. Thus, once armed and set, the MPU continues to be awakened WAKE_TMR[7:0] seconds after it requests SLP mode or LCD mode (i.e., once written, the WAKE_TMR[7:0] register holds its value and does not have to be re-written each time the MPU enters SLP or LCD mode. Also, since WAKE_TMR[7:0] is non-volatile, it also holds its value through resets and power failures). 90 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 3.5 Data Flow and MPU/CE Communication The data flow between the Compute Engine (CE) and the MPU is shown in Figure 30. In a typical application, the 32-bit CE sequentially processes the samples from the voltage inputs on pins IA, VA, 2 2 IB, etc., performing calculations to measure active power (Wh), reactive power (VARh), A h, and V h for four-quadrant metering. These measurements are then accessed by the MPU, processed further and output using the peripheral devices available to the MPU. Both the CE and multiplexer are controlled by the MPU via shared registers in the I/O RAM and in RAM. The CE outputs a total of six discrete signals to the MPU. These consist of four pulses and two interrupts: * * * * CE_BUSY XFER_BUSY WPULSE, VPULSE (pulses for active and reactive energy) XPULSE, YPULSE (auxiliary pulses) These interrupts are connected to the MPU interrupt service inputs as external interrupts. CE_BUSY indicates that the CE is actively processing data. This signal occurs once every multiplexer cycle (typically 396 s), and indicates that the CE has updated status information in its CESTATUS register (CE RAM 0x80). XFER_BUSY indicates that the CE is updating data to the output region of the RAM. This indication occurs whenever the CE has finished generating a sum by completing an accumulation interval determined by SUM_SAMPS[12:0], I/O RAM 0x2107[4:0], 2108[7:0], (typically every 1000 ms). Interrupts to the MPU occur on the falling edges of the XFER_BUSY and CE_BUSY signals. WPULSE and VPULSE are typically used to signal energy accumulation of real (Wh) and reactive (VARh) energy. Tying WPULSE and VPULSE into the MPU interrupt system can support pulse counting. XPULSE and YPULSE can be used to signal events such as sags and zero crossings of the mains voltage to the MPU. Tying these outputs into the MPU interrupt system relieves the MPU from having to read the CESTATUS register at every occurrence of the CE_BUSY interrupt in order to detect sag or zero crossing events. Pulses XPULSE YPULSE Interrupts VPULSE WPULSE CE_BUSY XFER_BUSY CE Samples Processed Metering Data CESTATUS CECONFIG MUX Control MPU Control Control XRAM I/O RAM (Configuration RAM) Figure 30: MPU/CE Data Flow Refer to 5.3 CE Interface Description for additional information on setting up the device using the MPU firmware. Rev 5 91 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4 Application Information 4.1 Connecting 5 V Devices All digital input pins of the 71M654x are compatible with external 5 V devices. I/O pins configured as inputs do not require current-limiting resistors when they are connected to external 5 V devices. 4.2 Direct Connection of Sensors Figure 31 through Figure 34 show voltage-sensing resistive dividers, current-sensing current transformers (CTs) and current-sensing resistive shunts and how they are connected to the voltage and current inputs of the 71M654x. All input signals to the 71M654x sensor inputs are voltage signals providing a scaled representation of either a sensed voltage or current. The analog input pins of the 71M654x are designed for sensors with low source impedance. RC filters with resistance values higher than those implemented in the Demo Boards must not be used. Refer to the Demo Board schematics for complete sensor input circuits and corresponding component values. RIN VA VIN ROUT V3P3A Figure 31: Resistive Voltage Divider (Voltage Sensing) IIN IOUT IAP CT RBURDEN VOUT V3P3A Noise Filter 1:N Figure 32. CT with Single-Ended Input Connection (Current Sensing) IIN IOUT IAP V3P3A CT RBURDEN VOUT IAN Bias Network and Noise Filter 1:N Figure 33: CT with Differential Input Connection (Current Sensing) IIN IAP V3P3A RSHUNT VOUT IAN Bias Network and Noise Filter Figure 34: Differential Resistive Shunt Connections (Current Sensing) 92 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.3 71M6541D/F/G Using Local Sensors Figure 35 shows a 71M6541D/F/G configuration using locally connected current sensors. The IAP-IAN current channel may be directly connected to either a shunt resistor or a CT, while the IBP-IBN channel is connected to a CT and is therefore isolated. This configuration implements a single-phase measurement with tamper-detection using one current sensor to measure the neutral current. This configuration can also be used to create a split phase meter (e.g., ANSI Form 2S). For best performance, both the IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN current sensor inputs are configured for differential mode (i.e., DIFFA_E = 1 and DIFFB_E = 1, I/O RAM 0x210C[4] and 0x210C[5]). The IBP-IBN input must be configured as an analog differential input disabling the remote sensor interface (i.e., RMT_E = 0, I/O RAM 0x2709[3]). See Figure 2 for the AFE configuration corresponding to Figure 35. NEUTRAL CT CT or LOAD Shunt LINE NEUTRAL Note: This system is referenced to LINE POWER SUPPLY Resistor Divider LINE MUX and ADC V3P3A V3P3SYS GNDA GNDD PWR MODE CONTROL IAP IAN LINE 71M6541D/F/G WAKE-UP REGULATOR BATTERY VBAT VA VBAT_RTC IBP IBN TEMPERATURE SENSOR VREF SERIAL PORTS AMR IR TX COMPUTE ENGINE RX MODUL- RX ATOR TX POWER FAULT COMPARATOR HOST RAM FLASH MEMORY MPU RTC TIMERS BATTERY MONITOR COM0...5 SEG SEG/DIO LCD DRIVER DIO, PULSES DIO V3P3D OSCILLATOR/ PLL XIN RTC BATTERY LCD DISPLAY 8888.8888 PULSES, DIO I2C or Wire EEPROM 32 kHz SPI INTERFACE ICE XOUT 11/5/2010 Figure 35. 71M6541D/F/G with Local Sensors Rev 5 93 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.4 71M6541D/F/G Using 71M6x01and Current Shunts Figure 36 shows a typical connection for one isolated and one non-isolated shunt sensor, using the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface. This configuration implements a single-phase measurement with tamper-detection using the second current sensor. This configuration can also be used to create a split phase meter (e.g., ANSI Form 2S). For best performance, the IAP-IAN current sensor input is configured for differential mode (i.e., DIFFA_E = 1, I/O RAM 0x210C[4]). The outputs of the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface are routed through a pulse transformer, which is connected to the pins IBP-IBN. The IBP-IBN pins must be configured for remote sensor communication (i.e., RMT_E =1, I/O RAM 0x2709[3]). See Figure 3 for the AFE configuration corresponding to Figure 36. NEUTRAL Shunt LOAD Note: This system is referenced to LINE Shunt LINE NEUTRAL POWER SUPPLY LINE Resistor Divider LINE 71M6xx1 MUX and ADC V3P3A V3P3SYS GNDA GNDD PWR MODE CONTROL IAP IAN Pulse Transformer 71M6541D/F/G WAKE-UP REGULATOR BATTERY VBAT VA VBAT_RTC IBP IBN TEMPERATURE SENSOR VREF SERIAL PORTS AMR IR TX COMPUTE ENGINE RX MODUL- RX ATOR TX POWER FAULT COMPARATOR HOST RAM FLASH MEMORY MPU RTC TIMERS BATTERY MONITOR COM0...5 SEG SEG/DIO LCD DRIVER DIO, PULSES DIO V3P3D OSCILLATOR/ PLL XIN RTC BATTERY LCD DISPLAY 8888.8888 PULSES, DIO I2C or Wire EEPROM 32 kHz SPI INTERFACE ICE XOUT 11/5/2010 Figure 36: 71M6541D/F/G with 71M6x01 isolated Sensor 94 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.5 71M6542F/G Using Local Sensors Figure 38 shows a 71M6542F/G configuration using locally connected current sensors. The IAP-IAN current channel may be directly connected to either a shunt resistor or a CT, while the IBP-IBN channel is connected to a CT and is therefore isolated. This configuration implements a dual-phase measurement utilizing Equation 2. For best performance, both the IAP-IAN and IBP-IBN current sensor inputs are configured for differential mode (i.e., DIFFA_E = 1 and DIFFB_E = 1, I/O RAM 0x210C[4] and 0x210C[5]). The IBP-IBN input must be configured as an analog differential input disabling the remote sensor interface (i.e., RMT_E = 0, I/O RAM 0x2709[3]). See Figure 4 for the AFE configuration corresponding to Figure 38. CT or Shunt PHASE A LOAD NEUTRAL Shunt Note: This system is referenced to PHASE A LOAD PHASE B NEUTRAL POWER SUPPLY Resistor Dividers PHASE A MUX and ADC V3P3A V3P3SYS GNDA GNDD PWR MODE CONTROL IAP IAN WAKE-UP PHASE A 71M6542F/G REGULATOR VB VA VBAT VBAT_RTC IBP IBN TEMPERATURE SENSOR VREF SERIAL PORTS AMR IR TX RAM COMPUTE ENGINE RX MODUL- RX ATOR TX POWER FAULT COMPARATOR HOST BATTERY FLASH MEMORY MPU RTC TIMERS BATTERY MONITOR COM0...5 SEG SEG/DIO LCD DRIVER DIO, PULSES DIO V3P3D OSCILLATOR/ PLL XIN RTC BATTERY LCD DISPLAY 8888.8888 PULSES, DIO I2C or Wire EEPROM 32 kHz SPI INTERFACE ICE XOUT 11/5/2010 Figure 37: 71M6542F/G with Local Sensors Rev 5 95 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.6 71M6542F/G Using 71M6x01 and Current Shunts Figure 38 shows a typical two-phase connection for the 71M6542F/G using one isolated and one nonisolated sensor. For best performance, the IAP-IAN current sensor input is configured for differential mode (i.e., DIFFA_E = 1, I/O RAM 0x210C[4]). The 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface is used to isolate phase B. The outputs of the 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor Interface are routed through a pulse transformer, which is connected to the pins IBP-IBN. The IBP-IBN pins must be configured for remote sensor communication (i.e., RMT_E =1, I/O RAM 0x2709[3]). See Figure 5 for the AFE configuration corresponding to Figure 38. Shunt PHASE A LOAD NEUTRAL Shunt Note: This system is referenced to PHASE A LOAD PHASE B NEUTRAL POWER SUPPLY PHASE A Resistor Dividers PHASE A 71M6XX1 MUX and ADC Pulse Transformer V3P3A V3P3SYS GNDA GNDD PWR MODE CONTROL IAP IAN 71M6542F/G REGULATOR VB VA VBAT_RTC TEMPERATURE SENSOR VREF SERIAL PORTS IR TX RAM COMPUTE ENGINE RX MODUL- RX ATOR TX POWER FAULT COMPARATOR HOST BATTERY VBAT IBP IBN AMR WAKE-UP FLASH MEMORY MPU RTC TIMERS BATTERY MONITOR COM0...5 SEG SEG/DIO LCD DRIVER DIO, PULSES DIO V3P3D OSCILLATOR/ PLL XIN RTC BATTERY LCD DISPLAY 8888.8888 PULSES, DIO I2C or Wire EEPROM 32 kHz SPI INTERFACE ICE XOUT Figure 38: 71M6542F/G with 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor 96 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.7 Metrology Temperature Compensation 4.7.1 Voltage Reference Precision Since the VREF band-gap amplifier is chopper-stabilized, as set by the CHOP_E[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[3:2]) control field, the dc offset voltage, which is the most significant long-term drift mechanism in the voltage references (VREF), is automatically removed by the chopper circuit. Both the 71M654x and the 71M6x01 feature chopper circuits for their respective VREF voltage reference. Maxim implements a trimming procedure of the VREF voltage reference during the device manufacturing process. The reference voltage (VREF) is trimmed to a target value of 1.195V. During this trimming process, the TRIMT[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x2309) value is stored in non-volatile fuses. TRIMT[7:0] is trimmed to a value that results in minimum VREF variation with temperature. For the 71M654x device, the TRIMT[7:0] value can be read by the MPU during initialization in order to calculate parabolic temperature compensation coefficients suitable for each individual 71M654x device. The resulting temperature coefficient for VREF in the 71M654x is 40 ppm/C. Considering the factory calibration temperature of VREF to be +22C and the industrial temperature range (-40C to +85C), the VREF error at the temperature extremes for the 71M654x device can be calculated as: (85o C - 22 o C ) 40 ppm / oC = +2520 ppm = +0.252% and (-40 C - 22 C ) 40 ppm / oC = -2480 ppm = -0.248% o o The above calculation implies that both the voltage and the current measurements are individually subject to a theoretical maximum error of approximately 0.25%. When the voltage sample and current sample are multiplied together to obtain the energy per sample, the voltage error and current error combine resulting in approximately 0.5% maximum energy measurement error. However, this theoretical 0.5% error considers only the voltage reference (VREF) as an error source. In practice, other error sources exist in the system. The principal remaining error sources are the current sensors (shunts or CTs) and their corresponding signal conditioning circuits, and the resistor voltage divider used to measure the voltage. The 71M654x devices should be used in Class 1% designs, allowing sufficient margin for the other error sources in the system. 4.7.2 Temperature Coefficients for the 71M654x The equations provided below for calculating TC1 and TC2 apply to the 71M654x. In order to obtain TC1 and TC2, the MPU reads TRIMT[7:0] (I/O RAM 0x2309) and uses the TC1 and TC2 equations provided. PPMC and PPMC2 are then calculated from TC1 and TC2, as shown. The resulting tracking of the reference voltage (VREF) is within 40 ppm/C. See 4.7.1 Voltage Reference Precision. TC1 = 275 - 4.95 TRIMT [7 : 0] TC 2 = -0.557 - 2.8 10 -4 TRIMT [7 : 0] PPMC = PPMC 2 = 2 21 5 1.195 7 2 29 5 8 1.195 TC1 = 22.4632 TC1 TC 2 = 1150.116 TC 2 The coefficients multiplying TC1 and TC2 to obtain PPMC and PPMC2 are derived from the 1.195V ADC voltage reference and scaling performed in the CE, as shown above. See 4.7.3 and 4.7.4 below for further temperature compensation details. Rev 5 97 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.7.3 Temperature Compensation for VREF with Local Sensors This section discusses metrology temperature compensation for the meter designs where local sensors are used, as shown in Figure 35 and Figure 37. In these configurations where all sensors are directly connected to the 71M654x, each sensor channel's accuracy is affected by the voltage variation in the 71M654x VREF due to temperature. The VREF in the 71M654x can be compensated digitally using a second-order polynomial function of temperature. The 71M654x features an on-chip temperature sensor for the purpose of temperature compensating its VREF. There are also error sources external to the 71M654x. The voltage sensor resistor dividers and the shunt current sensor and/or CT and their corresponding signal conditioning circuits also have a temperature dependency, which also may require compensation, depending on the required accuracy class. The compensation for these external error sources may be optionally lumped with the compensation for VREF by incorporating their compensation into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for each corresponding channel. The MPU has the responsibility of computing the necessary compensation values required for each sensor channel based on the sensed temperature. Maxim provides demonstration code that implements the GAIN_ADJn compensation equation shown below. The resulting GAIN_ADJn values are stored by the MPU in three CE RAM locations GAIN_ADJ0-GAIN_ADJ2 (CE RAM 0x40-0x42). The demonstration code thus provides a suitable implementation of temperature compensation, but other methods are possible in MPU firmware by utilizing the on-chip temperature sensors and the CE RAM GAIN_ADJn storage locations. The demonstration code maintains three separate sets of PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients and computes three separate GAIN_ADJn values based on the sensed temperature using the equation below: GAIN _ ADJ = 16385 + 10 TEMP _ X PPMC 214 + 100 TEMP _ X 2 PPMC 2 2 23 Where, TEMP_X is the deviation from nominal or calibration temperature expressed in multiples of o 0.1 C. For example, since the 71M654x calibration (reference) temperature is 22 C and the measured o o temperature is 27 C, then TEMP_X = (27-22) x 10 = 50 (decimal), which represents a +5 C deviation o from 22 C. Table 73 shows the three GAIN_ADJn equation output values and the voltage or current measurements for which they compensate. * * * GAIN_ADJ0 compensates for the VA and VB (71M6542F/G only) voltage measurements in the 71M654x and is used to compensate the VREF in the 71M654x. The designer may optionally add compensation for the resistive voltage dividers into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. GAIN_ADJ1 provides compensation for the IA current channel and compensates for the 71M654x VREF. The designer may optionally add compensation for the shunt or CT and its corresponding signal conditioning circuit into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. GAIN_ADJ2 provides compensation for the IB current channel and compensates for the 71M654x VREF. The designer may optionally add compensation for the CT and its signal conditioning circuit into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. Table 72: GAIN_ADJn Compensation Channels Gain Adjustment Output GAIN_ADJ0 GAIN_ADJ1 GAIN_ADJ2 CE RAM Address 71M6541D/F/G 71M6542F/G 0x40 0x41 0x42 VA IA IB VA, VB IA IB In the demonstration code, temperature compensation behavior is determined by the values stored in the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for each of the three channels, which are setup by the MPU demo code at initialization time from values that are previously stored in EEPROM. To disable temperature compensation in the demonstration code, PPMC and PPMC2 are both set to zero for each of the three GAIN_ADJn channels. To enable temperature compensation, the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients are set with values that match the expected temperature variation of each corresponding sensor channel. 98 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet For VREF compensation, both the linear coefficient PPMC and the quadratic coefficient PPMC2, are determined as described in 4.7.2 Temperature Coefficients for the 71M654x. The compensation for the external error sources is accomplished by summing the PPMC value associated with VREF with the PPMC value associated with the external error source to obtain the final PPMC value for the sensor channel. Similarly, the PPMC2 value associated with VREF is summed with the PPMC2 value associated with the external error source. To determine the contribution of the current shunt sensor or CT to the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients, the designer must either know the temperature coefficients of the shunt or the CT from its data sheet or obtain them by laboratory measurement. The designer must consider component variation across mass production to ensure that the product will meet its accuracy requirement across production. 4.7.4 Temperature Compensation for VREF with Remote Sensor This section discusses metrology temperature compensation for the meter designs where current shunt sensors are used in conjunction with the 71M6x01 isolated sensors, as shown in Figure 36 and Figure 38. Any sensors that are directly connected to the 71M654x are affected by the voltage variation in the 71M654x VREF due to temperature. On the other hand, sensors that are connected to the 71M6x01 isolated sensor, are affected by the VREF in the 71M6x01. The VREF in both the 71M654x and 71M6x01 can be compensated digitally using a second-order polynomial function of temperature. The 71M654x and 71M6x01 feature temperature sensors for the purposes of temperature compensating their corresponding VREF. Referring to Figure 36 and Figure 38, the VA voltage sensor is available in the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G and is directly connected to the 71M654x. The VB voltage sensor is available only in the 71M6542F/G and is also directly connected to it. Thus, the precision of these directly connected voltage sensors is affected by VREF in the 71M654x. The 71M654x also has one shunt current sensor (IA) which is connected directly to it, and therefore is also affected by the VREF in the 71M654x. The external current sensor and its corresponding signal conditioning circuit also has a temperature dependency, which also may require compensation, depending on the required accuracy class. Finally, the second current sensor (IB) is isolated by the 71M6x01 and depends on the VREF of the 71M6x01, plus the variation of the corresponding shunt resistance with temperature. The MPU has the responsibility of computing the necessary compensation values required for each sensor channel based on the sensed temperature. Maxim provides demonstration code that implements the GAIN_ADJn compensation equation shown below. The resulting GAIN_ADJn values are stored by the MPU in three CE RAM locations GAIN_ADJ0-GAIN_ADJ2 (CE RAM 0x40-0x42). The demonstration code thus provides a suitable implementation of temperature compensation, but other methods are possible in MPU firmware by utilizing the on-chip temperature sensors and the CE RAM GAIN_ADJn storage locations. The demonstration code maintains three separate sets of PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients and computes three separate GAIN_ADJn values based on the sensed temperature using the equation below: GAIN _ ADJ = 16385 + 10 TEMP _ X PPMC 214 + 100 TEMP _ X 2 PPMC 2 2 23 Where, TEMP_X is the deviation from nominal or calibration temperature expressed in multiples of o 0.1 C. For example, since the 71M654x calibration (reference) temperature is 22 C and the measured o o temperature is 27 C, then TEMP_X = (27-22) x 10 = 50 (decimal), which represents a +5 C deviation o from 22 C. Table 73 shows the three GAIN_ADJn equation output values and the voltage or current measurements for which they compensate. * * GAIN_ADJ0 compensates for the VA and VB (71M6542F/G only) voltage measurements in the 71M654x and is used to compensate the VREF in the 71M654x. The designer may optionally add compensation for the resistive voltage dividers into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. GAIN_ADJ1 provides compensation for the IA current channel and compensates for the 71M654x VREF. The designer may optionally add compensation for the shunt and its corresponding signal conditioning circuit into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. Rev 5 99 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet * GAIN_ADJ2 provides compensation for the remotely connected IB shunt current sensor and compensates for the 71M6x01 VREF. The designer may optionally add compensation for the shunt connected to the 71M6x01 into the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for this channel. Table 73: GAIN_ADJn Compensation Channels Gain Adjustment Output CE RAM Address 71M6541D/F/G 71M6542F/G GAIN_ADJ0 GAIN_ADJ1 GAIN_ADJ2 0x40 0x41 0x42 VA IA IB VA, VB IA IB In the demonstration code, temperature compensation behavior is determined by the values stored in the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients, which are setup by the MPU demo code at initialization time from values that are previously stored in EEPROM. To disable temperature compensation in the demonstration code, PPMC and PPMC2 are both set to zero for each of the three GAIN_ADJn channels. To enable temperature compensation, the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients are set with values that match the expected temperature variation of the corresponding channel. For VREF compensation, both the linear coefficient PPMC and the quadratic coefficient PPMC2, are determined for the 71M654x as described in 4.7.2 Temperature Coefficients for the 71M654x. For information on determining the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients for the 71M6x01 VREF, refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet. The compensation for the external error sources is accomplished by summing the PPMC value associated with VREF with the PPMC value associated with the external error source to obtain the final PPMC value for the sensor channel. Similarly, the PPMC2 value associated with VREF is summed with the PPMC2 value associated with the external error source. To determine the contribution of the current shunt sensor to the PPMC and PPMC2 coefficients, the designer must either know the temperature coefficients of the shunt from its data sheet or obtain it by laboratory measurement. The designer must consider component variation across mass production to ensure that the product will meet its accuracy requirement across production. 4.8 2 Connecting I2C EEPROMs 2 I C EEPROMs or other I C compatible devices should be connected to the DIO pins SEGDIO2 and SEGDIO3, as shown in Figure 39. Pull-up resistors of roughly 10 k to V3P3D (to ensure operation in BRN mode) should be used for both SDCK and SDATA signals. The DIO_EEX[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2456[7:6]) field in I/O RAM must be set to 01 2 in order to convert the DIO pins SEGDIO2 and SEGDIO3 to I C pins SDCK and SDATA. 10 k V3P3D 10 k EEPROM SEGDIO2/SDCK SEGDIO3/SDATA SDCK SDATA 71M654x 2 Figure 39: I C EEPROM Connection 100 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.9 Connecting Three-Wire EEPROMs Wire EEPROMs and other compatible devices should be connected to the DIO pins SEGDIO2/SDCK and SEGDIO3/SDATA, as described in 2.5.9 EEPROM Interface. 4.10 UART0 (TX/RX) The UART0 RX pin should be pulled down by a 10 k resistor and additionally protected by a 100 pF ceramic capacitor, as shown in Figure 40. 71M654x RX 100 pF 10 k TX RX TX Figure 40: Connections for UART0 4.11 Optical Interface (UART1) The OPT_TX and OPT_RX pins can be used for a regular serial interface (by connecting a RS_232 transceiver for example), or they can be used to directly operate optical components (for example, an infrared diode and phototransistor implementing a FLAG interface). Figure 41 shows the basic connections for UART1. The OPT_TX pin becomes active when the I/O RAM control field OPT_TXE (I/O RAM 0x2456[3:2]) is set to 01. The polarity of the OPT_TX and OPT_RX pins can be inverted with the configuration bits, OPT_TXINV (I/O RAM 0x2456[0]) and OPT_RXINV (I/O RAM 0x2457[1]), respectively. The OPT_TX output may be modulated at 38 kHz when system power is present. Modulation is not available in BRN mode. The OPT_TXMOD bit (I/O RAM 0x2456[1]) enables modulation. The duty cycle is controlled by OPT_FDC[1:0] (I/O RAM 0x2457[5:4]), which can select 50%, 25%, 12.5%, and 6.25% duty cycle. A 6.25% duty cycle means OPT_TX is low for 6.25% of the period. The OPT_RX pin uses digital signal thresholds. It may need an analog filter when receiving modulated optical signals. With modulation, an optical emitter can be operated at higher current than nominal, enabling it to increase the distance along the optical path. If operation in BRN mode is desired, the external components should be connected to V3P3D. However, it is recommended to limit the current to a few mA. Rev 5 101 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet V3P3SYS R1 71M654x OPT_RX 100 pF 10 k Phototransistor V3P3SYS R2 LED OPT_TX Figure 41: Connection for Optical Components 4.12 Connecting the Reset Pin Even though a functional meter does not necessarily need a reset switch, it is useful to have a reset pushbutton for prototyping as shown in Figure 42, left side. The RESET signal may be sourced from V3P3SYS (functional in MSN mode only), V3P3D (MSN and BRN modes), or VBAT (all modes, if a battery is present), or from a combination of these sources, depending on the application. For a production meter, the RESET pin should be protected by the external components shown in Figure 42, right side. R1 should be in the range of 100 and mounted as closely as possible to the IC. Since the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G generate their own power-on reset, a reset button or circuitry, as shown in Figure 42, is only required for test units and prototypes. VBAT/ V3P3D V3P3D R2 71M654x 71M654x 1k Reset Switch RESET 0.1F 10k R1 GNDD GNDD Figure 42: External Components for the RESET Pin: Push-Button (Left), Production Circuit (Right) 102 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.13 Connecting the Emulator Port Pins Even when the emulator is not used, small shunt capacitors to ground (22 pF) should be used for protection from EMI as illustrated in Figure 43. Production boards should have the ICE_E pin connected to ground. LCD Segments (optional) V3P3D 71M654x ICE_E 62 E_RST 62 E_RXT E_TCLK 62 22 pF 22 pF 22 pF Figure 43: External Components for the Emulator Interface Rev 5 103 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 4.14 Flash Programming 4.14.1 Flash Programming via the ICE Port Operational or test code can be programmed into the flash memory using either an in-circuit emulator or the Flash Programmer Module (TFP-2) available from Maxim. The flash programming procedure uses the E_RST, E_RXTX, and E_TCLK pins. 4.14.2 Flash Programming via the SPI Port It is possible to erase, read and program the flash memory of the SPI port. See 2.5.10 SPI Slave Port for a detailed description. 4.15 MPU Firmware Library All application-specific MPU functions mentioned in 4 Application Information are featured in the demonstration C source code supplied by Maxim. The code is available as part of the Demonstration Kit for the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G. The Demonstration Kits come with the preprogrammed with demo firmware and mounted on a functional sample meter Demo Board. The Demo Boards allow for quick and efficient evaluation of the IC without having to write firmware or having to supply an in-circuit emulator (ICE). 4.16 Crystal Oscillator The oscillator of the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G drives a standard 32.768 kHz watch crystal. The oscillator has been designed specifically to handle these crystals and is compatible with their high impedance and limited power handling capability. The oscillator power dissipation is very low to maximize the lifetime of any battery backup device attached to the VBAT_RTC pin. Board layouts with minimum capacitance from XIN to XOUT require less battery current. Good layouts have XIN and XOUT shielded from each other and from LCD and digital signals. Since the oscillator is self-biasing, an external resistor must not be connected across the crystal. 4.17 Meter Calibration Once the 71M654x energy meter device has been installed in a meter system, it must be calibrated. A complete calibration includes the following: * * Establishment of the reference temperature (e.g., typically 22 C) Calibration of the metrology section, i.e., calibration for tolerances of the current sensors, voltage dividers and signal conditioning components as well as of the internal reference voltage (VREF) at the reference temperature (e.g., typically 22 C). * Calibration of the oscillator frequency using the RTCA_ADJ[7:0] I/O RAM register (I/O RAM 0x2504). The metrology section can be calibrated using the gain and phase adjustment factors accessible to the CE. The gain adjustment is used to compensate for tolerances of components used for signal conditioning, especially the resistive components. Phase adjustment is provided to compensate for phase shifts introduced by the current sensors or by the effects of reactive power supplies. Due to the flexibility of the MPU firmware, any calibration method, such as calibration based on energy, or current and voltage can be implemented. It is also possible to implement segment-wise calibration (depending on current range). The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G support common industry standard calibration techniques, such as single-point (energy-only), multi-point (energy, Vrms, Irms), and auto-calibration. Maxim provides a calibration spreadsheet file to facilitate the calibration process. Contact your Maxim representative to obtain a copy of the latest calibration spreadsheet file for the 71M654x. 104 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5 Firmware Interface 5.1 I/O RAM Map -Functional Order In Table 74 and Table 75, unimplemented (U) and reserved (R) bits are shaded in light gray. Unimplemented bits are identified with a `U'. Unimplemented bits have no memory storage, writing them has no effect, and reading them always returns zero. Reserved bits are identified with an `R', and must always be written with a zero. Writing values other than zero to reserved bits may have undesirable side effects and must be avoided. Non-volatile bits are shaded in dark gray. Non-volatile bits are backed-up during power failures if the system includes a battery connected to the VBAT pin. The I/O RAM locations listed in Table 74 have sequential addresses to facilitate reading by the MPU (e.g., in order to verify their contents). These I/O RAM locations are usually modified only at boot-up. The addresses shown in Table 74 are an alternative sequential address to the addresses from Table 75 which are used throughout document. For instance, EQU[2:0] can be accessed at I/O RAM 0x2000[7:5] or at I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]. Table 74: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order, Basic Configuration Name Addr CE6 CE5 CE4 CE3 CE2 CE1 CE0 RCE0 RTMUX Reserved MUX5 MUX4 MUX3 MUX2 MUX1 MUX0 TEMP LCD0 LCD1 LCD2 LCD_MAP6 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 200A 200B 200C 200D 200E 200F 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 Rev 5 Bit 7 Bit 6 EQU[2:0] U Bit 5 Bit 4 U Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 CHOP_E[1:0] RTM_E CE_E SUM_SAMPS[12:8] SUM_SAMPS[7:0] U U CE_LCTN[5:0] PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] R R DIFFB_E DIFFA_E RFLY_DIS FIR_LEN[1:0] PLS_INV CHOPR[1:0] R R RMT_E R R R U TMUXRB[2:0] U TMUXRA[2:0] U U R U U U U U MUX_DIV[3:0] MUX10_SEL MUX9_SEL MUX8_SEL MUX7_SEL MUX6_SEL MUX5_SEL MUX4_SEL MUX3_SEL MUX2_SEL MUX1_SEL MUX0_SEL TEMP_BSEL TEMP_PWR OSC_COMP TEMP_BAT TBYTE_BUSY TEMP_PER[2:0] LCD_E LCD_MODE[2:0] LCD_ALLCOM LCD_Y LCD_CLK[1:0] LCD_VMODE[1:0] LCD_BLNKMAP23[5:0] LCD_BAT R LCD_BLNKMAP22[5:0] LCD_MAP[55:48] 105 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Addr LCD_MAP5 LCD_MAP4 LCD_MAP3 LCD_MAP2 LCD_MAP1 LCD_MAP0 DIO_R5 DIO_R4 DIO_R3 DIO_R2 DIO_R1 DIO_R0 DIO0 DIO1 DIO2 INT1_E INT2_E WAKE_E SFMM SFMS 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 201A 201B 201C 201D 201E 201F 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2080 2081 Bit 7 Bit 6 U U U U U U U DIO_EEX[1:0] DIO_PW DIO_PV DIO_PX DIO_PY EX_EEX EX_XPULSE EX_SPI EX_WPULSE Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 LCD_MAP[47:40] LCD_MAP[39:32] LCD_MAP[31:24] LCD_MAP[23:16] LCD_MAP[15:8] LCD_MAP[7:0] U U U DIO_R11[2:0] U DIO_R9[2:0] U DIO_R7[2:0] U DIO_R5[2:0] U DIO_R3[2:0] U U U OPT_TXE[1:0] OPT_FDC[1:0] U OPT_RXDIS U U U U EX_YPULSE EX_RTCT U EX_RTC1M EX_VPULSE U U U EW_RX EW_PB EW_DIO4 SFMM[7:0]* SFMS[7:0]* Bit 1 Bit 0 DIO_RPB[2:0] DIO_R10[2:0] DIO_R8[2:0] DIO_R6[2:0] DIO_R4[2:0] DIO_R2[2:0] OPT_TXMOD OPT_RXINV U EX_RTC1S U EW_DIO52 OPT_TXINV OPT_BB U EX_XFER U EW_DIO55 Notes: *SFMM and SFMS are accessible only through the SPI slave port. See Invoking SFM (page 77) for details. 71M6542F/G only. 106 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 75 lists bits and registers that may have to be accessed on a frequent basis. Reserved bits have lighter gray background, and non-volatile bits have a darker gray background. Table 75: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order Name Addr CE and ADC MUX5 2100 MUX4 2101 MUX3 2102 MUX2 2103 MUX1 2104 MUX0 2105 CE6 2106 CE5 2107 CE4 2108 CE3 2109 CE2 210A CE1 210B CE0 210C RTM0 210D RTM0 210E RTM1 210F RTM2 2110 RTM3 2111 CLOCK GENERATION CKGN 2200 LCD/DIO VREF TRIM FUSES TRIMT 2309 LCD/DIO LCD0 2400 LCD1 2401 LCD2 2402 LCD_MAP6 2405 LCD_MAP5 2406 Rev 5 Bit 7 U Bit 6 Bit 5 MUX_DIV[3:0] MUX9_SEL[3:0] MUX7_SEL[3:0] MUX5_SEL[3:0] MUX3_SEL[3:0] MUX1_SEL[3:0] EQU[2:0] U U U U R U R U DIFFB_E U U U ADC_DIV Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 MUX10_SEL[3:0] MUX8_SEL[3:0] MUX6_SEL[3:0] MUX4_SEL[3:0] MUX2_SEL[3:0] MUX0_SEL[3:0] U CHOP_E[1:0] RTM_E CE_E SUM_SAMPS[12:8] SUM_SAMPS[7:0] CE_LCTN[5:0] PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] DIFFA_E RFLY_DIS FIR_LEN[1:0] PLS_INV U U U RTM0[9:8] RTM0[7:0] RTM1[7:0] RTM2[7:0] RTM3[7:0] PLL_FAST RESET MPU_DIV[2:0] TRIMT[7:0] LCD_E LCD_VMODE[1:0] LCD_BAT R LCD_MODE[2:0] LCD_ALLCOM LCD_Y LCD_BLNKMAP23[5:0] LCD_BLNKMAP22[5:0] LCD_MAP[55:48] LCD_MAP[47:40] LCD_CLK[1:0] 107 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Addr Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 LCD_MAP4 LCD_MAP3 LCD_MAP2 LCD_MAP1 LCD_MAP0 LCD4 LCD_DAC SEGDIO0 ... SEGDIO15 SEGDIO16 ... SEGDIO45 SEGDIO46 ... SEGDIO50 SEGDIO51 ... SEGDIO55 2407 2408 2409 240A 240B 240C 240D 2410 ... 241F 2420 ... 243D 243E ... 2442 2443 ... 2447 U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U DIO_R5 DIO_R4 DIO_R3 DIO_R2 DIO_R1 DIO_R0 DIO0 DIO1 DIO2 NV BITS RESERVED RESERVED TMUX 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455 2456 2457 2458 108 2500 2501 2502 U U U U U U U DIO_EEX[1:0] DIO_PW DIO_PV DIO_PX DIO_PY U U U U U U Bit 4 Bit 3 LCD_MAP[39:32] LCD_MAP[31:24] LCD_MAP[23:16] LCD_MAP[15:8] LCD_MAP[7:0] U U Bit 1 LCD_RST LCD_BLANK LCD_DAC[4:0] LCD_SEG0[5:0] ... LCD_SEG15[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO16[5:0] ... LCD_SEGDIO45[5:0] LCD_SEG46[5:0] ... LCD_SEG50[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO51[5:0] ... LCD_SEGDIO55[5:0] U U DIO_R11[2:0] DIO_R9[2:0] DIO_R7[2:0] DIO_R5[2:0] DIO_R3[2:0] U U OPT_FDC[1:0] U U U R Bit 2 U U U U U U U U OPT_TXE[1:0] U OPT_RXDIS U U R U R U Bit 0 LCD_ON DIO_RPB[2:0] DIO_R10[2:0] DIO_R8[2:0] DIO_R6[2:0] DIO_R4[2:0] DIO_R2[2:0] OPT_TXMOD OPT_RXINV U OPT_TXINV OPT_BB U R U R U TMUX[5:0] Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Addr TMUX2 2503 RTC1 2504 71M6x01 Interface REMOTE2 2602 REMOTE1 2603 RBITS INT1_E 2700 INT2_E 2701 SECURE 2702 Analog0 2704 VERSION 2706 INTBITS 2707 FLAG0 SFR E8 FLAG1 SFR F8 STAT SFR F9 REMOTE0 SFR FC SPI1 SFR FD SPI0 2708 RCE0 2709 RTMUX 270A DIO3 270C NV RAM and RTC 2800NVRAMxx 287F WAKE 2880 STEMP1 2881 STEMP0 2882 BSENSE 2885 LKPADDR 2887 LKPDATA 2888 LKPCTRL 2889 RTC0 2890 RTC2 2892 Rev 5 Bit 7 U U Bit 6 U Bit 5 U Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 TMUX2[4:0] Bit 1 Bit 0 EX_RTC1M U FLSH_RDE EX_RTC1S U FLSH_WRE SPARE[2:0] EX_XFER U R INT2 IE_RTC1M U INT1 IE_RTC1S U VSTAT[2:0] INT0 IE_XFER PB_STATE R U R TMUXRA[2:0] U U U U U U U LKP_RD U LKP_WR U RTCA_ADJ[6:0] RMT_RD[15:8] RMT_RD[7:0] EX_EEX EX_SPI VREF_CAL U IE_EEX IE_SPI U EX_XPULSE EX_YPULSE EX_WPULSE EX_VPULSE FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] VREF_DIS PRE_E INT6 IE_XPULSE IE_WPULSE U PERR_RD CHOPR[1:0] U U R U INT5 IE_YPULSE IE_VPULSE U PERR_WR R R PORT_E EX_RTCT U U U R ADC_E BCURR VERSION[7:0] INT4 INT3 IE_RTCT U U U PLL_OK U RCMD[4:0] SPI_CMD[7:0] SPI_STAT[7:0] R RMT_E R U SPI_E SPI_SAFE R NVRAM[0] - NVRAM[7F] - Direct Access STEMP[2:0] LKPAUTOI U RTC_WR U RTC_RD U U WAKE_TMR[7:0] STEMP[10:3] U U BSENSE[7:0] LKPADDR[6:0] LKPDAT[7:0] U U RTC_FAIL U RTC_SBSC[7:0] 109 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Addr Bit 7 U U U U U U Bit 6 U U U U U U Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RTC_SEC[5:0] RTC_MIN[5:0] U RTC_HR[4:0] U U U RTC_DAY[2:0] U RTC_DATE[4:0] U U RTC_MO[3:0] RTC_YR[7:0] U U U RTC_P[16:14] RTC_P[13:6] RTC_P[5:0] RTC_Q[1:0] RTC_TMIN[5:0] U RTC_THR[4:0] OSC_COMP TEMP_BAT TBYTE_BUSY TEMP_PER[2:0] WF_RSTBIT WF_OVF WF_ERST WF_BADVDD U U WF_TMR WF_RX WF_PB WF_DIO4 WF_DIO52 WF_DIO55 WAKE_ARM U U U U U U EW_RX EW_PB EW_DIO4 EW_DIO52 EW_DIO55 U U U U U U RTC3 2893 RTC4 2894 RTC5 2895 RTC6 2896 RTC7 2897 RTC8 2898 RTC9 2899 U U RTC10 289B RTC11 289C RTC12 289D U U RTC13 289E U U RTC14 289F TEMP 28A0 TEMP_BSEL TEMP_PWR WF_RST WF1 28B0 WF_CSTART U U WF2 28B1 SLEEP LCD_ONLY MISC 28B2 U U WAKE_E 28B3 WD_RST TEMP_START WDRST 28B4 MPU PORTS DIO_DIR[15:12] P3 SFR B0 DIO_DIR[11:8] P2 SFR A0 DIO_DIR[7:4] P1 SFR 90 DIO_DIR[3:0] P0 SFR 80 FLASH FLSH_ERASE[7:0] ERASE SFR 94 PREBOOT SECURE U U FLSH_PEND FLSHCTL SFR B2 U U U U U FL_BANK SFR B6 FLSH_PGADR[5:0] PGADR SFR B7 2 IC EEDATA[7:0] EEDATA SFR 9E EECTRL[7:0] EECTRL SFR 9F 71M6542F/G only 110 DIO[15:12] DIO[11:8] DIO[7:4] DIO[3:0] FLSH_PSTWR FLSH_MEEN FLSH_PWE U FL_BANK[1:0] U U Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.2 I/O RAM Map - Alphabetical Order Table 76 lists I/O RAM bits and registers in alphabetical order. Bits with a write direction (W in column Dir) are written by the MPU into configuration RAM. Typically, they are initially stored in flash memory and copied to the configuration RAM by the MPU. Some of the more frequently programmed bits are mapped to the MPU SFR memory space. The remaining bits are mapped to the address space 0x2XXX. Bits with R (read) direction can be read by the MPU. Columns labeled Rst and Wk describe the bit values upon reset and wake, respectively. No entry in one of these columns means the bit is either read-only or is powered by the NV supply and is not initialized. Write-only bits return zero when they are read. Locations that are shaded in grey are non-volatile (i.e., battery-backed). Table 76: I/O RAM Map - Functional Order Name ADC_E ADC_DIV Location 2704[4] 2200[5] BCURR BSENSE[7:0] CE_E 2704[3] 2885[7:0] 2106[0] CE_LCTN[5:0] 2109[5:0] CHIP_ID[15:8] CHIP_ID[7:0] 2300[7:0] 2301[7:0] CHOP_E[1:0] 2106[3:2] Rev 5 Rst Wk Dir 0 Description 0 R/W Enables ADC and VREF. When disabled, reduces bias current. ADC_DIV controls the rate of the ADC and FIR clocks. The ADC_DIV setting determines whether MCK is divided by 4 or 8: 0 = MCK/4 1 = MCK/8 The resulting ADC and FIR clock is as shown below. 0 0 R/W PLL_FAST = 0 PLL_FAST = 1 MCK 6.291456 MHz 19.660800 MHz ADC_DIV = 0 1.572864 MHz 4.9152 MHz ADC_DIV = 1 0.786432 MHz 2.4576 MHz 0 0 R/W Connects a 100 A load to the battery selected by TEMP_BSEL. - - R The result of the battery measurement. See 2.5.6 71M654x Battery Monitor. 0 0 R/W CE enable. CE program location. The starting address for the CE program is 31 31 R/W 1024*CE_LCTN. 0 0 R These bytes contain the chip identification. 0 0 R Chop enable for the reference bandgap circuit. The value of CHOP changes on the rising edge of MUXSYNC according to the value in CHOP_E: 0 0 R/W 1 00 = toggle 01 = positive 10 = reversed 11 = toggle 1 except at the mux sync edge at the end of an accumulation interval. 111 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location CHOPR[1:0] 2709[7:6] DIFFA_E DIFFB_E DIO_R2[2:0] DIO_R3[2:0] DIO_R4[2:0] DIO_R5[2:0] DIO_R6[2:0] DIO_R7[2:0] DIO_R8[2:0] DIO_R9[2:0] DIO_R10[2:0] DIO_R11[2:0] DIO_RPB[2:0] 210C[4] 210C[5] 2455[2:0] 2455[6:4] 2454[2:0] 2454[6:4] 2453[2:0] 2453[6:4] 2452[2:0] 2452[6:4] 2451[2:0] 2451[6:4] 2450[2:0] DIO_DIR[15:12] DIO_DIR[11:8] DIO_DIR[7:4] DIO_DIR[3:0] DIO[15:12] DIO[11:8] DIO[7:4] DIO[3:0] SFR B0[7:4] SFR A0[7:4] SFR 90[7:4] SFR 80[7:4] Rst Wk Dir Description The CHOP settings for the remote sensor. 00 = Auto chop. Change every MUX frame. 00 00 R/W 01 = Positive 10 = Negative 11 = Auto chop. Same as 00. 0 0 R/W Enables differential configuration for the IA current input (IAP-IAN). 0 0 R/W Enables differential configuration for the IB current input (IBP-IBN). Connects PB and dedicated I/O pins DIO2 through DIO11 to internal resources. 0 If more than one input is connected to the same resource, the MULTIPLE 0 column below specifies how they are combined. 0 0 MULTIPLE DIO_Rx Resource 0 0 NONE - 0 - R/W 1 Reserved OR 0 2 T0 (Timer0 clock or gate) OR 0 3 T1 (Timer1 clock or gate) OR 0 4 IO interrupt (int0) OR 0 5 IO interrupt (int1) OR 0 F SFR B0[3:0] SFR A0[3:0] SFR 90[3:0] F SFR 80[3:0] F Programs the direction of the first 16 DIO pins. 1 indicates output. Ignored if the pin is not configured as I/O. See DIO_PV and DIO_PW for special option R/W for the SEGDIO0 and SEGDIO1 outputs. See DIO_EEX for special option for SEGDIO2 and SEGDIO3. Note that the direction of DIO pins above 15 is set by SEGDIOx[1]. See PORT_E to avoid power-up spikes. F The value on the first 16 DIO pins. Pins configured as LCD reads zero. When written, changes data on pins configured as outputs. Pins configured R/W as LCD or input ignore writes. Note that the data for DIO pins above 15 is set by SEGDIOx[0]. When set, converts pins SEGDIO3/SEGDIO2 to interface with external EEPROM. SEGDIO2 becomes SDCK and SEGDIO3 becomes bi-directional SDATA, but only if LCD_MAP[2] and LCD_MAP[3] are cleared. DIO_EEX[1:0] 2456[7:6] 0 - R/W DIO_EEX[1:0] 00 01 10 11 112 Function Disable EEPROM interface 2-Wire EEPROM interface 3-Wire EEPROM interface 3-Wire EEPROM interface with separate DO (DIO3) and DI (DIO8) pins. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name DIO_PV DIO_PW DIO_PX DIO_PY EEDATA[7:0] EECTRL[7:0] Location 2457[6] 2457[7] 2458[7] 2458[6] SFR 9E SFR 9F Rst Wk Dir 0 0 0 0 0 0 - - - - 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Description Causes VARPULSE to be output on pin SEGDIO1, if LCD_MAP[1] = 0. Causes WPULSE to be output on pin SEGDIO0, if LCD_MAP[0] = 0. Causes XPULSE to be output on pin SEGDIO6 , if LCD_MAP[6] = 0. Causes YPULSE to be output on pin SEGDIO7 , if LCD_MAP[7] = 0. Serial EEPROM interface data. Serial EEPROM interface control. Status Bit Name Read/ Write Reset State 7 ERROR R 0 Positive 6 BUSY R 0 Positive 5 RX_ACK R 1 Positive R/W Polarity Description 1 when an illegal command is received. 1 when serial data bus is busy. 1 indicates that the EEPROM sent an ACK bit. Specifies the power equation. EQU 0 EQU[2:0] 2106[7:5] 0 0 R/W 1 2 Watt & VAR Formula (WSUM/VARSUM) VA*IA 1 element, 2W 1f VA*(IA-IB)/2 1 element, 3W 1f VA*IA + VB*IB 2 element, 3W 3f Delta Inputs Used for Energy/Current Calculation W0SUM/ W1SUM/ I0SQ I1SQ VAR0SUM VAR1SUM SUM SUM 1 1 VA*IA VA*IB IA IB VA*(IA-IB)/2 - IA-IB IB VA*IA VB*IB IA IB Note: 1. Optionally, IB may be used to measure neutral current. 71M6542F/G only Rev 5 113 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name EX_XFER EX_RTC1S EX_RTC1M EX_RTCT EX_SPI EX_EEX EX_XPULSE EX_YPULSE EX_WPULSE EX_VPULSE Location Rst Wk Dir Description 2700[0] 2700[1] 2700[2] 2700[3] 2701[7] 2700[7] 2700[6] 2700[5] 2701[6] 2701[5] 0 0 Interrupt enable bits. These bits enable the XFER_BUSY, the RTC_1SEC, etc. The bits are set by hardware and cannot be set by writing a 1. The bits R/W are reset by writing 0. Note that if one of these interrupts is to enabled, its corresponding 8051 EX enable bit must also be set. See 2.4.8 Interrupts for details. EW_DIO4 28B3[2] 0 - R/W EW_DIO52 28B3[1] 0 - R/W EW_DIO55 28B3[0] 0 - R/W EW_PB 28B3[3] 0 - R/W EW_RX 28B3[4] 0 - R/W 210C[2:1] 0 0 R/W FIR_LEN[1:0] 114 Connects SEGDIO4 to the WAKE logic and permits SEGDIO4 rising to wake the part. This bit has no effect unless DIO4 is configured as a digital input. Connects SEGDIO52 to the WAKE logic and permits SEGDIO52 rising to wake the part. This bit has no effect unless SEGDIO52 is configured as a digital input. The SEGDIO52 pin is only available in the 71M6542F/G. Connects SEGDIO55 to the WAKE logic and permits SEGDIO55 rising to wake the part. This bit has no effect unless SEGDIO55 is configured as a digital input. Connects PB to the WAKE logic and permits a high level on PB to wake the part. PB is always configured as an input. Connects RX to the WAKE logic and permits RX rising to wake the part. See the WAKE description on page 87 for de-bounce issues. Determines the number of ADC cycles in the ADC decimation FIR filter. PLL_FAST = 1: FIR_LEN[1:0] ADC Cycles 00 141 01 288 10 384 PLL_FAST = 0: FIR_LEN[1:0] ADC Cycles 00 135 01 276 10 Not Allowed The ADC LSB size and full-scale values depend on the FIR_LEN[1:0] setting. Refer to 6.4.15 ADC Converter on page 150. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name FL_BANK Location Rst Wk Dir SFR B6 01 01 R/W Description Flash Bank Selection (71M6541G and 71M6542G only) The program memory of the 71M6541G/71M6542G consists of a fixed lower bank of 32 KB, addressable at 0x0000 to 0x7FFF plus an upper banked area of 32 KB, addressable at 0x8000 to 0xFFFF. The I/O RAM register FL_BANK is used to switch one of four memory banks of 32 KB each into the address range from 0x8000 to 0xFFFF. Note that when FL_BANK = 0, the upper bank is the same as the lower bank. FL_BANK[1:0] SFR 94[7:0] 0 0 W FLSH_MEEN SFR B2[1] 0 0 W FLSH_PEND SFR B2[3] 0 0 R SFR B7[7:2] 0 0 W FLSH_ERASE[7:0] FLSH_PGADR[5:0] Rev 5 Address Range for Lower Bank (0x0000-0x7FFF) 0x0000-0x7FFF 0x0000-0x7FFF 0x0000-0x7FFF 0x0000-0x7FFF Address Range for Upper Bank (0x8000-0xFFFF) 0x00000-0x07FFF 0x08000-0x0FFFF 0x10000-0x17FFF 0x18000-0x1FFFF 00 01 10 11 Flash Erase Initiate FLSH_ERASE is used to initiate either the Flash Mass Erase cycle or the Flash Page Erase cycle. Specific patterns are expected for FLSH_ERASE in order to initiate the appropriate Erase cycle. (default = 0x00). 0x55 = Initiate Flash Page Erase cycle. Must be proceeded by a write to FLSH_PGADR[5:0] (SFR 0xB7[7:2]). 0xAA = Initiate Flash Mass Erase cycle. Must be proceeded by a write to FLSH_MEEN and the ICE port must be enabled. Any other pattern written to FLSH_ERASE has no effect. Mass Erase Enable 0 = Mass Erase disabled (default). 1 = Mass Erase enabled. Must be re-written for each new Mass Erase cycle. Indicates that a timed flash write is pending. If another flash write is attempted, it is ignored. Flash Page Erase Address FLSH_PGADR[5:0] - Flash Page Address (page 0 thru 63) that is erased during the Page Erase cycle. (default = 0x00). Must be re-written for each new Page Erase cycle. 115 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location FLSH_PSTWR SFR B2[2] 0 0 FLSH_PWE SFR B2[0] 0 0 FLSH_RDE 2702[2] - - FLSH_UNLOCK[3:0] 2702[7:4] 0 0 FLSH_WRE IE_XFER IE_RTC1S IE_RTC1M IE_RTCT IE_SPI IE_EEX IE_XPULSE IE_YPULSE IE_WPULSE IE_VPULSE 2702[1] SFR E8[0] SFR E8[1] SFR E8[2] SFR E8[4] SFR F8[7] SFR E8[7] SFR E8[6] SFR E8[5] SFR F8[6] SFR F8[5] - - 0 0 INTBITS 2707[6:0] - - LCD_ALLCOM 2400[3] 0 - LCD_BAT 2402[7] 0 - 2401[5:0] 2402[5:0] 0 - LCD_BLNKMAP23[5:0] LCD_BLNKMAP22[5:0] 116 Rst Wk Dir Description Enables timed flash writes. When 1, and if CE_E = 1, flash write requests are stored in a one-element deep FIFO and are executed when CE_BUSY falls. R/W FLSH_PEND can be read to determine the status of the FIFO. If FLSH_PSTWR = 0 or if CE_E = 0, flash writes are immediate. Program Write Enable 0 = MOVX commands refer to External RAM Space, normal operation (default). R/W 1 = MOVX @DPTR,A moves A to External Program Space (Flash) @ DPTR. This bit is automatically reset after each byte written to flash. Writes to this bit are inhibited when interrupts are enabled. Indicates that the flash may be read by ICE or SPI slave. FLSH_RDE = R (!SECURE) Must be a `2' to enable any flash modification. See the description of Flash R/W security for more details. R Indicates that the flash may be written through ICE or SPI slave ports. Interrupt flags for external interrupts 2 and 6. These flags monitor the source of the int6 and int2 interrupts (external interrupts to the MPU core). These flags are set by hardware and must be cleared by the software interrupt handler. The IEX2 (SFR 0xC0[1]) and IEX6 (SFR 0xC0[5]) interrupt flags are R/W automatically cleared by the MPU core when it vectors to the interrupt handler. IEX2 and IEX6 must be cleared by writing zero to their corresponding bit positions in SFR 0xC0, while writing ones to the other bit positions that are not being cleared. Interrupt inputs. The MPU may read these bits to see the input to external interrupts INT0, INT1, up to INT6. These bits do not have any memory and are primarily intended for debug use. Configures SEG/COM bits as COM. Has no effect on pins whose LCD_MAP R/W bit is zero. R/W Connects the LCD power supply to VBAT in all modes. Identifies which segments connected to SEG23 and SEG22 should blink. 1 R/W means `blink.' The most significant bit corresponds to COM5, the least significant, to COM0. R Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location Rst Wk Dir Description Sets the LCD clock frequency. Note: fw = 32768 Hz LCD_CLK LCD Clock Frequency LCD_CLK[1:0] 2400[1:0] 0 - R/W 00 01 LCD_DAC[4:0] LCD_E LCD_MAP[55:48] LCD_MAP[47:40] LCD_MAP[39:32] LCD_MAP[31:24] LCD_MAP[23:16] LCD_MAP[15:8] LCD_MAP[7:0] 240D[4:0] 0 - 2400[7] 0 - 2405[7:0] 2406[7:0] 2407[7:0] 2408[7:0] 2409[7:0] 240A[7:0] 240B[7:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 - - - - - - - fW = 64 Hz 29 fW = 128 Hz 28 LCD_CLK 10 11 LCD Clock Frequency fW = 256 Hz 27 fW = 512 Hz 26 The LCD contrast DAC. This DAC controls the VLCD voltage and has an output range of 2.5 V to 5 V. The VLCD voltage is VLCD = 2.5 + 2.5 * LCD_DAC[4:0]/31 R/W Thus, the LSB of the DAC is 80.6 mV. The maximum DAC output voltage is limited by V3P3SYS, VBAT, and whether LCD_BSTE = 1. Enables the LCD display. When disabled, VLC2, VLC1, and VLC0 are R/W ground as are the COM and SEG outputs if their LCD_MAP bit is 1. R/W Enables LCD segment driver mode of combined SEGDIO pins. Pins that R/W cannot be configured as outputs (SEG48 through SEG50) become inputs with R/W internal pull ups when their LCD_MAP bit is zero. Also, note that SEG48 R/W through SEG50 are multiplexed with the in-circuit emulator signals. When the R/W ICE_E pin is high, the ICE interface is enabled, and SEG48 through SEG50 R/W become E_RXTX, E_TCLK and E_RST, respectively. R/W Selects the LCD bias and multiplex mode. LCD_MODE 000 001 010 011 Output 4 states, 1/3 bias 3 states, 1/3 bias 2 states, 1/2 bias 3 states, 1/2 bias LCD_MODE 100 101 110 Output Static display 5 states, 1/3 bias 6 states, 1/3 bias 2400[6:4] 0 - R/W LCD_ON LCD_BLANK 240C[0] 240C[1] 0 0 - - LCD_ONLY 28B2[6] 0 0 LCD_RST 240C[2] 0 - R/W Turns on or off all LCD segments without changing LCD data. If both bits are R/W set, the LCD display is turned on. Puts the IC to sleep, but with LCD display still active. Ignored if system power W is present. It awakens when Wake Timer times out, when certain DIO pins are raised, or when system power returns. See 3.2 Battery Modes. Clear all bits of LCD data. These bits affect SEGDIO pins that are configured R/W as LCD drivers. This bit does not auto clear. LCD_MODE[2:0] Rev 5 117 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name LCD_SEG0[5:0] to LCD_SEG15[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO16[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO45[5:0] LCD_SEG46[5:0] to LCD_SEG50[5:0] LCD_SEGDIO51[5:0] to LCD_SEGDIO55[5:0] LCD_VMODE[1:0] LCD_Y LKPADDR[6:0] LKPAUTOI LKPDAT[7:0] LKP_RD LKP_WR 118 Location Rst Wk Dir Description 2410[5:0] to 241F[5:0] 0 - R/W 2420[5:0] to 243D[5:0] 0 - SEG and DIO data for SEGDIO16 through SEGDIO45. If configured as DIO, R/W bit 1 is direction (1 is output, 0 is input), bit 0 is data, and the other bits are ignored. 243E[5:0] to 2442[5:0] 0 - R/W 2443[5:0] to 2447[5:0] 2401[7:6] 0 - SEG Data for SEG0 through SEG15. DIO data for these pins is in SFR space. SEG data for SEG46 through SEG50. These pins cannot be configured as DIO. SEG and DIO data for SEGDIO51 through SEGDIO55. If configured as DIO, bit 1 is direction (1 is output, 0 is input), bit 0 is data, and the other bits are R/W ignored. SEGDIO52 through SEDIO54 are available only on the 71M6542F/G. Specifies how VLCD is generated. See 2.5.8.4 for the definition of V3P3L. 00 00 R/W 2400[2] 0 - R/W 2887[6:0] 0 0 R/W 2887[7] 0 0 R/W 2888[7:0] 0 0 R/W 2889[1] 2889[0] 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W LCD_VMODE 11 10 01 00 Description External VLCD LCD boost and LCD DAC enabled LCD DAC enabled No boost and no DAC. VLCD=V3P3L. LCD Blink Frequency (ignored if blink is disabled). 1 = 1 Hz, 0 = 0.5 Hz The address for reading and writing the RTC lookup RAM Auto-increment flag. When set, LKPADDR auto-increments every time LKP_RD or LKP_WR is pulsed. The incremented address can be read at LKPADDR[6:0]. The data for reading and writing the RTC lookup RAM. Strobe bits for the RTC lookup RAM read and write. When set, the LKPADDR[6:0] field and LKPDAT register is used in a read or write operation. When a strobe is set, it stays set until the operation completes, at which time the strobe is cleared and LKPADDR[6:0] is incremented if the LKPAUTOI bit is set. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location Rst Wk Dir MPU_DIV[2:0] 2200[2:0] 0 0 R/W MUX0_SEL[3:0] MUX1_SEL[3:0] MUX2_SEL[3:0] MUX3_SEL[3:0] MUX4_SEL[3:0] MUX5_SEL[3:0] MUX6_SEL[3:0] MUX7_SEL[3:0] MUX8_SEL[3:0] MUX9_SEL[3:0] MUX10_SEL[3:0] 2105[3:0] 2105[7:4] 2104[3:0] 2104[7:4] 2103[3:0] 2103[7:4] 2102[3:0] 2102[7:4] 2101[3:0] 2101[7:4] 2100[3:0] 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W MUX_DIV[3:0] 2100[7:4] 0 0 R/W 2457[0] 0 - R/W OPT_BB Description MPU clock rate is: -(2+MPU_DIV[2:0]) . MPU Rate = MCK Rate * 2 The maximum value for MPU_DIV[2:0] is 4. Based on the default values of the PLL_FAST bit and MPU_DIV[2:0], the power up MPU rate is 6.29 MHz / 4 = 1.5725 MHz. The minimum MPU clock rate is 38.4 kHz when PLL_FAS T = 1. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 0. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 1. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 2. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 3. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 4. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 5. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 6. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 7. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 8. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 9. Selects which ADC input is to be converted during time slot 10. MUX_DIV[3:0] is the number of ADC time slots in each MUX frame. The maximum number of time slots is 11. Configures the input of the optical port to be a DIO pin to allow it to be bit-banged. In this case, DIO5 becomes a third high speed UART. Refer to 2.5.7 UART and Optical Interface under the "Bit Banged Optical UART (Third UART)" sub-heading on page 58. Selects OPT_TX modulation duty cycle. OPT_FDC[1:0] OPT_RXDIS Rev 5 2457[5:4] 2457[2] 0 0 OPT_FDC 00 01 10 11 Function 50% Low 25% Low 12.5% Low 6.25% Low - R/W - OPT_RX can be configured as an input to the optical UART or as SEGDIO55. OPT_RXDIS = 0 and LCD_MAP[55] = 0: OPT_RX R/W OPT_RXDIS = 1 and LCD_MAP[55] = 0: DIO55 OPT_RXDIS = 0 and LCD_MAP[55] = 1: SEG55 OPT_RXDIS = 1 and LCD_MAP[55] = 1: SEG55 119 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name OPT_RXINV OPT_TXE [1:0] Location 2457[1] 2456[3:2] Rst Wk Dir 0 - R/W 00 - R/W OPT_TXINV 2456[0] 0 - R/W OPT_TXMOD 2456[1] 0 - R/W OSC_COMP 28A0[5] 0 - R/W PB_STATE SFR F8[0] 0 0 R PERR_RD PERR_WR SFR FC[6] SFR FC[5] 0 0 R/W PLL_OK SFR F9[4] 0 0 R 2200[4] 0 0 R/W PLL_FAST PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] 120 210A[7:0] FF FF R/W Description Inverts result from OPT_RX comparator when 1. Affects only the UART input. Has no effect when OPT_RX is used as a DIO input. Configures the OPT_TX output pin. If LCD_MAP[51] = 0: 00 = DIO51, 01 = OPT_TX, 10 = WPULSE, 11 = VARPULSE If LCD_MAP[51] = 1: xx = SEG51 Invert OPT_TX when 1. This inversion occurs before modulation. Enables modulation of OPT_TX. When OPT_TXMOD is set, OPT_TX is modulated when it would otherwise have been zero. The modulation is applied after any inversion caused by OPT_TXINV. Enables the automatic update of RTC_P and RTC_Q every time the temperature is measured. The de-bounced state of the PB pin. The IC sets these bits to indicate that a parity error on the remote sensor has been detected. Once set, the bits are remembered until they are cleared by the MPU. Indicates that the clock generation PLL is settled. Controls the speed of the PLL and MCK. 1 = 19.66 MHz (XTAL * 600) 0 = 6.29 MHz (XTAL * 192) PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] determines the maximum width of the pulse (low-going pulse if PLS_INV=0 or high-going pulse if PLS_INV=1). The maximum pulse width is (2*PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] + 1)*TI. Where TI is PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] in units of CK_FIR clock cycles. If PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] = 0 or PLS_MAXWIDTH[7:0] = 255, no pulse width checking is performed and the output pulses have 50% duty cycle. See 2.3.6.2 VPULSE and WPULSE. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] 210B[7:0] Rst Wk Dir Description PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] determines the interval time between pulses. The time between output pulses is PLS_INTERVAL[7:0]*4 in units of CK_FIR clock cycles. If PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] = 0, the FIFO is not used and pulses are output as soon as the CE issues them. PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] is calculated as follows: PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] = Floor ( Mux frame duration in CK_FIR cycles / CE pulse updates per Mux frame / 4 ) 0 0 R/W For example, since the 71M654x CE code is written to generate 6 pulses in one integration interval, when the FIFO is enabled (i.e., PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] 0) and that the frame duration is 1950 CK_FIR clock cycles, PLS_INTERVAL[7:0] should be written with Floor(1950 / 6 / 4) = 81 so that the five pulses are evenly spaced in time over the integration interval and the last pulse is issued just prior to the end of the interval. See 2.3.6.2 VPULSE and WPULSE. Inverts the polarity of WPULSE, VARPULSE, XPULSE and YPULSE. R/W Normally, these pulses are active low. When inverted, they become active high. PLS_INV 210C[0] 0 0 PORT_E 270C[5] 0 0 PRE_E PREBOOT 2704[5] SFRB2[7] 0 - 0 - RCMD[4:0] SFR FC[4:0] 0 0 RESET 2200[3] 0 0 RFLY_DIS 210C[3] 0 0 RMT_E 2709[3] 0 0 2602[7:0] 2603[7:0] 0 0 R Response from remote read request. 2890[4] 0 0 R Indicates that a count error has occurred in the RTC and that the time is not trustworthy. This bit can be cleared by writing a 0. RMT_RD[15:8] RMT_RD[7:0] RTC_FAIL Rev 5 Enables outputs from the pins SEGDIO0-SEGDIO15. PORT_E = 0 after reset R/W and power-up blocks the momentary output pulse that would occur on SEGDIO0 to SEGDIO15. R/W Enables the 8x pre-amplifier. R Indicates that pre-boot sequence is active. When the MPU writes a non-zero value to RCMD[4:0], the IC issues a R/W command to the appropriate remote sensor. When the command is complete, the IC clears RCMD[4:0]. W When set, writes a one to WF_RSTBIT and then causes a reset. Controls how the IC drives the power pulse for the 71M6x01. When set, the R/W power pulse is driven high and low. When cleared, it is driven high followed by an open circuit fly-back interval. Enables the remote digital isolation interface, which transforms the IBP-IBN R/W pins into a digital balanced differential pair. Thus, enabling these pins to interface to the 71M6x01 isolated sensor. 121 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location RTC_P[16:14] RTC_P[13:6] RTC_P[5:0] 289B[2:0] 289C[7:0] 289D[7:2] 4 0 0 4 0 0 RTC_Q[1:0] 289D[1:0] 0 0 2890[6] 0 0 RTC_SBSC[7:0] RTC_TMIN[5:0] 2892[7:0] 289E[5:0] - 0 - - RTC_THR[4:0] 289F[4:0] 0 - 2890[7] 0 0 RTC_SEC[5:0] RTC_MIN[5:0] RTC_HR[4:0] RTC_DAY[2:0] RTC_DATE[4:0] RTC_MO[3:0] RTC_YR[7:0] 2893[5:0] 2894[5:0] 2895[4:0] 2896[2:0] 2897[4:0] 2898[3:0] 2899[7:0] - - - - - - - - - - - - - - RTCA_ADJ[6:0] RTM_E RTM0[9:8] RTM0[7:0] RTM1[7:0] RTM2[7:0] RTM3[7:0] 2504[7:0] 2106[1] 210D[1:0] 210E[7:0] 210F[7:0] 2110[7:0] 2111[7:0] 40 0 0 0 0 0 0 - 0 0 0 0 0 0 RTC_RD RTC_WR 122 Rst Wk Dir Description RTC adjust. See 2.5.4 Real-Time Clock (RTC). R/W 0x0FFBF RTC_P 0x10040 Note: RTC_P[16:0] and RTC_Q[1:0] form a single 19-bit RTC adjustment value. RTC adjust. See 2.5.4 Real-Time Clock (RTC). R/W Note: RTC_P[16:0] and RTC_Q[1:0] form a single 19-bit RTC adjustment value. Freezes the RTC shadow register so it is suitable for MPU reads. When R/W RTC_RD is read, it returns the status of the shadow register: 0 = up to date, 1 = frozen. R Time remaining until the next 1 second boundary. LSB = 1/128 second. R/W The target minutes register. See RTC_THR below. The target hours register. The RTC_T interrupt occurs when RTC_MIN R/W becomes equal to RTC_TMIN and RTC_HR becomes equal to RTC_THR. Freezes the RTC shadow register so it is suitable for MPU writes. When RTC_WR is cleared, the contents of the shadow register are written to the R/W RTC counter on the next RTC clock (~500 Hz). When RTC_WR is read, it returns 1 as long as RTC_WR is set. It continues to return one until the RTC counter actually updates. The RTC interface registers. These are the year, month, day, hour, minute and second parameters for the RTC. The RTC is set by writing to these registers. Year 00 and all others divisible by 4 are defined as a leap year. SEC 00 to 59 MIN 00 to 59 HR 00 to 23 (00 = Midnight) R/W DAY 01 to 07 (01 = Sunday) DATE 01 to 31 MO 01 to 12 YR 00 to 99 Each write operation to one of these registers must be preceded by a write to 0x2890. R/W Analog RTC frequency adjust register. R/W Real Time Monitor enable. When 0, the RTM output is low. Four RTM probes. Before each CE code pass, the values of these registers are serially output on the RTM pin. The RTM registers are ignored when R/W RTM_E = 0. Note that RTM0 is 10 bits wide. The others assume the upper two bits are 00. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location SECURE SFR B2[6] 0 0 28B2[7] 0 0 SFR FD[7:0] - - SPI_E 270C[4] 1 1 SPI_SAFE 270C[3] 0 0 SPI_STAT[7:0] 2708[7:0] 0 0 STEMP[10:3] STEMP[2:0] SUM_SAMPS[12:8] SUM_SAMPS[7:0] 2881[7:0] 2882[7:5] 2107[4:0] 2108[7:0] - - - - 0 0 28A0[3] 0 0 230A[2:0] 230B[7:0] 0 - R TEMP_BAT 28A0[4] 0 - R/W TEMP_BSEL 28A0[7] 0 - SLEEP SPI_CMD[7:0] TBYTE_BUSY TEMP_22[10:8] TEMP_22[7:0] Rev 5 Rst Wk Dir Description Inhibits erasure of page 0 and flash addresses above the beginning of CE code R/W as defined by CE_LCTN[5:0]. Also inhibits the read of flash via the SPI and ICE port. Puts the part to SLP mode. Ignored if system power is present. The part W wakes when the Wake timer times out, when push button is pushed, or when system power returns. R SPI command register for the 8-bit command from the bus master. SPI port enable. Enables SPI interface on pins SEGDIO36 - SEGDIO39. R/W Requires that LCD_MAP[36-39] = 0. Limits SPI writes to SPI_CMD and a 16-byte region in DRAM. No other R/W writes are permitted. SPI_STAT contains the status results from the previous SPI transaction. Bit 7: Ready error: The 71M654x was not ready to read or write as directed by the previous command. Bit 6: Read data parity: This bit is the parity of all bytes read from the 71M654x in the previous command. Does not include the SPI_STAT byte. Bit 5: Write data parity: This bit is the overall parity of the bytes written to the R 71M654x in the previous command. It includes CMD and ADDR bytes. Bit 4-2: Bottom 3 bits of the byte count. Does not include ADDR and CMD bytes. One, two, and three byte instructions return 111. Bit 1: SPI FLASH mode: This bit is zero when the TEST pin is zero. Bit 0: SPI FLASH mode ready: Used in SPI FLASH mode. Indicates that the flash is ready to receive another write instruction. R The result of the temperature measurement. R The number of multiplexer cycles per XFER_BUSY interrupt. Maximum value R/W is 8191 cycles. Indicates that hardware is still writing the 0x28A0 byte. Additional writes to R this byte are locked out while it is one. Write duration could be as long as 6ms. Storage location for STEMP at 22C. STEMP is an 11-bit word. Causes VBAT to be measured whenever a temperature measurement is performed. Selects which battery is monitored by the temperature sensor: 1 = VBAT, R/W 0 = VBAT_RTC 123 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name TBYTE_BUSY TEMP_PER[2:0] Location Rst Wk Dir 28A0[3] 0 0 R 28A0[2:0] 0 - R/W TEMP_PWR 28A0[6] TEMP_START 28B4[6] TMUX[5:0] TMUX2[4:0] TMUXRA[2:0] 2502[5:0] 2503[4:0] 270A[2:0] VERSION[7:0] TEMP_PER 0 1-6 7 Time (seconds) No temperature updates (3+TEMP_PER) 2 Continuous updates Selects the power source for the temp sensor: R/W 1 = V3P3D, 0 = VBAT_RTC. This bit is ignored in SLP and LCD modes, where the temp sensor is always powered by VBAT_RTC. When TEMP_PER = 0 automatic temperature measurements are disabled, and TEMP_START may be set by the MPU to initiate a one-shot temperature 0 0 R/W measurement. TEMP_START is ignored in SLP and LCD modes. Hardware clears TEMP_START when the temperature measurement is complete. - - R/W Selects one of 32 signals for TMUXOUT. See 2.5.12 for details. - - R/W Selects one of 32 signals for TMUX2OUT. See 2.5.12 for details. 000 000 R/W The TMUX setting for the remote isolated sensor (71M6x01). The silicon version index. This word may be read by firmware to determine the silicon version. 0 - 2706[7:0] - - R VREF_CAL 2704[7] 0 0 R/W VREF_DIS 2704[6] 0 1 124 Description Indicates that hardware is still writing the 0x28A0 byte. Additional writes to this byte will be locked out while it is one. Write duration could be as long as 6ms. Sets the period between temperature measurements. Automatic measurements can be enabled in any mode (MSN, BRN, LCD, or SLP). TEMP_PER = 0 disables automatic temperature updates, in which case TEMP_START may be used by the MPU to initiate a one-shot temperature measurement. VERSION[7:0] 0001 0011 0010 0010 Silicon Version B01 B02 Brings the ADC reference voltage out to the VREF pin. This feature is disabled when VREF_DIS=1. R/W Disables the internal ADC voltage reference. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Name Location Rst Wk Dir VSTAT[2:0] SFR F9[2:0] - - WAKE_ARM 28B2[5] 0 - 2880[7:0] 0 - WD_RST 28B4[7] 0 0 WF_DIO4 28B1[2] 0 - WF_DIO52 28B1[1] 0 - WF_DIO55 28B1[0] 0 - WF_TMR WF_PB WF_RX WF_CSTART WF_RST WF_RSTBIT WF_OVF WF_ERST WF_BADVDD 28B1[5] 28B1[3] 28B1[4] 28B0[7] 28B0[6] 28B0[5] 28B0[4] 28B0[3] 28B0[2] 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 - - - WAKE_TMR[7:0] Rev 5 - Description This word describes the source of power and the status of the VDD. VSTAT Description 000 System Power OK. V3P3A>3.0v. Analog modules are functional and accurate. [V3AOK,V3OK] = 11 001 System Power Low. 2.8v2.25v. Full digital functionality. R [V3AOK,V3OK] = 00, [VDDOK,VDDgt2] = 11 011 Battery power and VDD>2.0. Flash writes are inhibited. If the TRIMVDD[5] fuse is blown, PLL_FAST (I/O RAM 0x2200[4]) is cleared. [V3AOK,V3OK] = 00, [VDDOK,VDDgt2] = 01 101 Battery power and VDD<2.0. When VSTAT=101, processor is nearly out of voltage. Processor failure is imminent. [V3AOK,V3OK] = 00, [VDDOK,VDDgt2] = 00 Arms the WAKE timer and loads it with WAKE_TMR[7:0]. When SLEEP or R/W LCD_ONLY is asserted by the MPU, the WAKE timer becomes active. R/W Timer duration is WAKE_TMR+1 seconds. Reset the WD timer. The WD is reset when a 1 is written to this bit. Writing a W one clears and restarts the watch dog timer. DIO4 wake flag bit. If DIO4 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set R whenever the de-bounced version of DIO4 rises. It is held in reset if DI04 is not configured for wakeup. DIO52 wake flag bit. If DIO52 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set R whenever the de-bounced version of DIO52 rises. It is held in reset if DI052 is not configured for wakeup. DIO55 wake flag bit. If DIO55 is configured to wake the part, this bit is set R whenever the de-bounced version of DIO55 rises. It is held in reset if DI055 is not configured for wakeup. R Indicates that the wake timer caused the part to wake up. R Indicates that the PB caused the part to wake. R Indicates that RX caused the part to wake. R Indicates that the Reset pin, Reset bit, ERST pin, Watchdog timer, the cold start detector, or bad VBAT caused the part to reset. 125 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3 CE Interface Description 5.3.1 CE Program The CE performs the precision computations necessary to accurately measure energy. These computations include offset cancellation, phase compensation, product smoothing, product summation, frequency detection, VAR calculation, sag detection and voltage phase measurement. All data computed by the CE is dependent on the selected meter equation as given by EQU[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]). The CE program is supplied by Maxim as a data image that can be merged with the MPU operational code for meter applications. Typically, the CE program provided with the demonstration code covers most applications and does not need to be modified. Other variations of CE code are available from Maxim. The descriptions provided in this section apply to the CE code revisions shown in Table 77. Contact the local Maxim representative to obtain the appropriate CE code required for a specific application. Table 77. Standard CE Codes Device Local Sensors Remote Sensor 71M6541D/F/G CE41A01 (Eq. 0 or 1) CE41B016601 CE41A01 (Eq. 0 or 1) CE41B016201 CE41A04 (Eq. 2) (Eq. 0, 1 or 2) 71M6542F/G 5.3.2 CE Data Format All CE words are 4 bytes. Unless specified otherwise, they are in 32-bit two's complement format (-1 = 0xFFFFFFFF). Calibration parameters are defined in flash memory (or external EEPROM) and must be copied to CE data memory by the MPU before enabling the CE. Internal variables are used in internal CE calculations. Input variables allow the MPU to control the behavior of the CE code. Output variables are outputs of the CE calculations. The corresponding MPU address for the most significant byte is given by 0x0000 + 4 x CE_address and by 0x0003 + 4 x CE_address for the least significant byte. 5.3.3 Constants Constants used in the CE Data Memory tables are: * * * * * * * * Sampling Frequency: FS = 32768 Hz/13 = 2520.62 Hz. F0 is the fundamental frequency of the mains phases. IMAX is the external rms current corresponding to 250 mV pk (176.8 mV rms) at the inputs IA and IB. IMAX needs to be adjusted if the pre-amplifier is activated for the IAP-IAN inputs. For a 250 shunt resistor, IMAX becomes 707 A (176.8 mV rms / 250 = 707.2 A rms). VMAX is the external rms voltage corresponding to 250 mV pk at the VA and VB inputs. NACC, the accumulation count for energy measurements is SUM_SAMPS[12:0] (I/O RAM 0x2107[4:0], 0x2108[7:0]). The duration of the accumulation interval for energy measurements is SUM_SAMPS[12:0] / FS. X is a gain constant of the pulse generators. Its value is determined by PULSE_FAST and PULSE_SLOW (see Table 83). -9 Voltage LSB (for sag threshold) = VMAX * 7.879810 V. The system constants IMAX and VMAX are used by the MPU to convert internal digital quantities (as used by the CE) to external, i.e., metering quantities. Their values are determined by the scaling of the voltage and current sensors used in an actual meter. The LSB values used in this document relate digital quantities at the CE or MPU interface to external meter input quantities. For example, if a SAG threshold of 80 V rms is desired at the meter input, the digital value that should be programmed into SAG_THR (CE RAM 0x24) would be 80 Vrms * SQRT(2)/SAG_THRLSB, where SAG_THRLSB is the LSB value in the description of SAG_THR (see Table 84). 126 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet The parameters EQU[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]), CE_E (I/O RAM 0x2106[0]), and SUM_SAMPS[12:0] are essential to the function of the CE are stored in I/O RAM (see 5.2 I/O RAM Map - Alphabetical Order for details). 5.3.4 Environment Before starting the CE using the CE_E bit (I/O RAM 0x2106[0]), the MPU has to establish the proper environment for the CE by implementing the following steps: * * * * * * * * Locate the CE code in Flash memory using CE_LCTN[5:0] (I/O RAM 0x2109[5:0]) Load the CE data into RAM Establish the equation to be applied in EQU[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]) Establish the number of samples per accumulation period in SUM_SAMPS[12:0] (I/O RAM 0x2107[4:0], 0x2108[7:0]) Establish the number of cycles per ADC multiplexer frame (MUX_DIV[3:0] (I/O RAM 0x2100[7:4])) Apply proper values to MUXn_SEL, as well as proper selections for DIFFn_E (I/O RAM 0x210C[5:4]) and RMT_E (I/O RAM 0x2709[3]) in order to configure the analog inputs Initialize any MPU interrupts, such as CE_BUSY, XFER_BUSY, or the power failure detection interrupt VMAX = 600 V, IMAX = 707 A, and kH = 1 Wh/pulse are assumed as default settings When different CE codes are used, a different set of environment parameters need to be established. The exact values for these parameters are listed in the Application Notes and other documentation which accompanies the CE code. Operating CE codes with environment parameters deviating from the values specified by Maxim leads to unpredictable results. See Table 1 and Table 2. Typically, there are thirteen 32768 Hz cycles per ADC multiplexer frame (see 2.2.2 Input Multiplexer). This means that the product of the number of cycles per slot and the number of conversions per frame must be 12 (plus one settling cycle per frame, see Figure 6 and Figure 7). The default configuration is FIR_LEN[1:0] = 01, I/O RAM 0x210C[2:1], (three cycles per conversion) and MUX_DIV[3:0] = 3 (3 conversions per multiplexer cycle). Sample configurations can be copied from Demo Code provided by Maxim with the Demo Kits. 5.3.5 CE Calculations Referring to Table 78, The MPU selects the desired equation by writing the EQU[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]). Table 78: CE EQU Equations and Element Input Mapping EQU Watt & VAR Formula (WSUM/VARSUM) 0 VA IA - 1 element, 2W 1f 1 VA*(IA-IB)/2 - 1 element, 3W 1f 2 VA*IA + VB*IB - 2 element, 3W 3f Delta Note: 71M6542F/G only. Rev 5 Inputs Used for Energy/Current Calculation W0SUM/ VAR0SUM W1SUM/ VAR1SUM I0SQ SUM I1SQ SUM VA*IA VA*(IA-IB)/2 VA*IA VA*IB - VB*IB IA IA-IB IA IB IB - 127 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3.6 CE Front End Data (Raw Data) Access to the raw data provided by the AFE is possible by reading addresses 0-3, 9 and 10 (decimal) shown in Table 79. The MUX_SEL column in Table 79 shows the MUX_SEL handles for the various sensor input pins. For example, if differential mode is enable via control bit DIFFA_E = 1 (I/O RAM 0x210C[4]), then the inputs IAP and IAN are combined together to form a single differential input and the corresponding MUX_SEL handle is 0. Similarly, the CE RAM location column provides the CE RAM address where the sample data is stored. Continuing with the same example, if DIFFA_E = 1, the corresponding CE RAM location where the samples for the IAP-IAN differential input are stored is 0 and CE RAM location is not disturbed. The IB input can be configured as a direct-connected sensor (i.e., directly connected to the 71M654x) or as a remote sensor (i.e., using a 71M6x01 Isolated Sensor). If the remote sensor is disabled by RMT_E = 0 and differential mode is enabled by DIFFB_E = 1 (I/O RAM 0x210C[5]), then IBP and IBN form a differential input with a MUX_SEL handle of 2, and the corresponding samples are stored in CE RAM location 2 (CE RAM location 3 is not disturbed). If the remote sensor enable bit RMT_E = 1 and DIFFB_E = 0 or 1, then the MUX_SEL handle is undefined (i.e., the sensor is not connected to the 71M654x, so MUX_SEL does not apply, see 2.2 Analog Front End (AFE) on page 12), and the samples corresponding to this remote differential IBP-IBN input are stored in CE RAM location 2 (CE RAM location 3 is not disturbed). The voltage sensor inputs (VA and VB) do not have any associated configuration bits. VA has a MUX_SEL handle value of 10, and its samples are stored in CE RAM location 10. VB has a MUX_SEL handle value of 9 and its samples are stored in CE RAM location 9. Table 79: CE Raw Data Access Locations ADC Location Pin ADC0 ADC1 IAP IAP ADC2 ADC3 IBP IBN MUX_SEL Handle CE RAM Location DIFFA_E DIFFA_E 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 RMT_E, DIFFB_E RMT_E, DIFFB_E 0,0 0,1 1,0 1,1 0,0 0,1 1,0 1,1 2 2 2 - - 2 2* 2* 3 3 There are no configuration bits for ADC9, 10 9 9 10 10 ADC9 VB ADC10 VA Notes: * Remote interface data. 71M6542F/G only. 5.3.7 FCE Status and Control The CE Status Word, CESTATUS, is useful for generating early warnings to the MPU (Table 80). It contains sag warnings for phase A and B, as well as F0, the derived clock operating at the fundamental input frequency. The MPU can read the CE status word at every CE_BUSY interrupt. Since the CE_BUSY interrupt occurs at 2520.6 Hz, it is desirable to minimize the computation required in the interrupt handler of the MPU. Table 80: CESTATUS Register CE Address 0x80 Name CESTATUS Description See description of CESTATUS bits in Table 81. CESTATUS provides information about the status of voltage and input AC signal frequency, which are useful for generating an early power fail warning to initiate necessary data storage. CESTATUS represents the 128 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet status flags for the preceding CE code pass (CE_BUSY interrupt). The significance of the bits in CESTATUS is shown in Table 81. Table 81: CESTATUS (CE RAM 0x80) Bit Definitions CESTATUS bit 31:4 3 2 Not Used F0 Not Used 1 SAG_B 0 SAG_A Name Description These unused bits are always zero. F0 is a square wave at the exact fundamental input frequency. This unused bit is always zero. Normally zero. Becomes one when VB remains below SAG_THR for SAG_CNT samples. Does not return to zero until VB rises above SAG_THR. Normally zero. Becomes one when VA remains below SAG_THR for SAG_CNT samples. Does not return to zero until VA rises above SAG_THR. The CE is initialized by the MPU using CECONFIG (Table 82). This register contains in packed form SAG_CNT, FREQSEL[1:0], EXT_PULSE, PULSE_SLOW and PULSE_FAST. The CECONFIG bit definitions are given in Table 83. Table 82: CECONFIG Register CE Address Name Data Description 1 See description of the CECONFIG bits in 0x0030DB00 2 0x00B0DB00 Table 83. 1. Default for CE41A01 (71M6541D/F/G or CE41A04 (71M6542F/G) CE code for use with local sensors. 2. Default for CE41B016201 and CE41B016601 codes that support the 71M6x01 remote sensors. 0x20 CECONFIG Table 83: CECONFIG (CE RAM 0x20) Bit Definitions CECONFIG bit Name Default 23 Reserved 0 22 EXT_TEMP 0 21 EDGE_INT 1 20 SAG_INT 1 19:8 SAG_CNT 252 (0xFC) 7:6 FREQSEL[1:0] 0 Description Reserved (can be used by the MPU to indicate that the 71M6x01 is being used; CE does not use this). When 1, the MPU controls temperature compensation via the GAIN_ADJn registers (CE RAM 0x40-0x42), when 0, the CE is in control. When 1, XPULSE produces a pulse for each zero-crossing of the mains phase selected by FREQSEL[1:0] , which can be used to interrupt the MPU. When 1, activates YPULSE output when a sag condition is detected. The number of consecutive voltage samples below SAG_THR (CE RAM 0x24) before a sag alarm is declared. The default value is equivalent to 100 ms. FREQSEL[1:0] selects the phase to be used for the frequency monitor, sag detection, and for the zero crossing counter (MAINEDGE_X, CE RAM 0x83). FREQ SEL[1:0] 0 0 1 *71M6542F/G only Rev 5 0 1 X Phase Selected A B* Not allowed 129 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5 EXT_PULSE 1 4:2 Reserved 0 1 PULSE_FAST 0 0 PULSE_SLOW 0 When zero, causes the pulse generators to respond to internal data (WPULSE = WSUM_X (CE RAM 0x84), VPULSE = VARSUM_X (CE RAM 0x88)). Otherwise, the generators respond to values the MPU places in APULSEW and APULSER (CE RAM 0x45 and 0x49). Reserved. When PULSE_FAST = 1, the pulse generator input is increased 16x. When PULSE_SLOW = 1, the pulse generator input is reduced by a factor of 64. These two parameters control the pulse gain factor X (see table below). Allowed values are either 1 or 0. Default is 0 for both (X = 6). PULSE_FAST PULSE_SLOW X 2 0 0 1.5 * 2 = 6 6 1 0 1.5 * 2 = 96 -4 0 1 1.5 * 2 = 0.09375 1 1 Do not use The FREQSEL[1:0] field in CECONFIG (CE RAM 0x20[7:6]) selects the phase that is utilized to generate a sag interrupt. Thus, a SAG_INT event occurs when the selected phase has satisfied the sag event criteria as set by the SAG_THR (CE RAM 0x24) register and the SAG_CNT field in CECONFIG (CE RAM 0x20[19:8]). When the SAG_INT bit (CE RAM 0x20[20]) is set to 1, a sag event generates a transition on the YPULSE output. In a two-phase system (71M6542F/G), and after a sag interrupt, the MPU should change the FREQSEL[1:0] setting to select the other phase, if it is powered. Even though a sag interrupt is only generated on the selected phase, both phases are simultaneously checked for sag. The presence of power on a given phase can be sensed by directly checking the SAG_A and SAG_B bits in CESTATUS (CE RAM 0x80[0:1]). The EXT_TEMP bit enables temperature compensation by the MPU, when set to 1. When 0, internal (CE) temperature compensation is enabled. The CE pulse generator can be controlled by either the MPU (external) or CE (internal) variables. Control is by the MPU if the EXT_PULSE bit = 1 (CE RAM 0x20[5]). In this case, the MPU controls the pulse rate (external pulse generation) by placing values into APULSEW and APULSER (CE RAM 0x45 and 0x49). By setting EXT_PULSE = 0, the CE controls the pulse rate based on WSUM_X (CE RAM 0x84) and VARSUM_X (CE RAM 0x88). The 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Demo Code creep function halts both internal and external pulse generation. Table 84: Sag Threshold and Gain Adjust Control CE Address 130 Name Default 7 0x24 SAG_THR 2.39*10 0x40 GAIN_ADJ0 16384 0x41 GAIN_ADJ1 16384 0x42 GAIN_ADJ2 16384 Description The voltage threshold for sag warnings. The default value is equivalent to 113Vpk or 80 Vrms if VMAX = 600 Vrms. 2 _ = 7.8798 10-9 This register scales the voltage measurement channels VA and VB*. The default value of 16384 is equivalent to unity gain (1.000). *71M6542F/G only This register scales the IA current channel for Phase A. The default value of 16384 is equivalent to unity gain (1.000). This register scales the IB current channel for Phase B. The default value of 16384 is equivalent to unity gain (1.000). Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3.8 CE Transfer Variables When the MPU receives the XFER_BUSY interrupt, it knows that fresh data is available in the transfer variables. CE transfer variables are modified during the CE code pass that ends with an XFER_BUSY interrupt. They remain constant throughout each accumulation interval. In this data sheet, the names of CE transfer variables always end with "_X". The transfer variables can be categorized as: * * * Fundamental energy measurement variables Instantaneous (RMS) values Other measurement parameters 5.3.8.1 Fundamental Energy Measurement Variables Table 85 and Table 86 describe each transfer variable for fundamental energy measurement. All variables are signed 32-bit integers. Accumulated variables such as WSUM are internally scaled so they have at least 2x margin before overflow when the integration time is one second. Additionally, the hardware does not permit output values to fold back upon overflow. Table 85: CE Transfer Variables (with Local Sensors) CE Address Name 0x84 WSUM_X 0x85 0x86 W0SUM_X W1SUM_X 0x88 VARSUM_X 0x89 0x8A VAR0SUM_X VAR1SUM_X Description Configuration The signed sum: W0SUM_X+W1SUM_X. Not used for EQU[2:0] = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]) and EQU[2:0] = 1. The sum of Wh samples from each wattmeter element. -13 LSB = 9.4045*10 * VMAX * IMAX Wh. -13 For ce41a04: LSB = 6.6952*10 * VMAX * IMAX Wh. The signed sum: VAR0SUM_X+VAR1SUM_X. Not used for EQU[2:0] = 0 and EQU[2:0] = 1. The sum of VARh samples from each wattmeter element. -13 LSB = 9.4045*10 * VMAX * IMAX VARh. -13 For ce41a04, LSB = 6.6952*10 * VMAX * IMAX VARh. Figure 35 (page 93) Figure 37 (page 95) Note: 71M6542 only. Table 86: CE Transfer Variables (with Remote Sensor) CE Address Name 0x84 WSUM_X 0x85 0x86 W0SUM_X W1SUM_X 0x88 VARSUM_X 0x89 0x8A VAR0SUM_X VAR1SUM_X Description Configuration The signed sum: W0SUM_X+W1SUM_X. Not used for EQU[2:0] = 0 (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]) and EQU[2:0] = 1. The sum of Wh samples from each wattmeter element. -12 LSB = 1.55124*10 * VMAX* IMAX Wh. The signed sum: VAR0SUM_X+VAR1SUM_X. Not used for EQU[2:0] = 0 and EQU[2:0] = 1. The sum of VARh samples from each wattmeter element. -12 LSB = 1.55124*10 *VMAX* IMAX VARh. Figure 36 (page 94) Figure 38 (page 96) Note: 71M6542 only. Rev 5 131 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet WSUM_X (CE RAM 0x84) and VARSUM_X (CE RAM 0x88) are the signed sum of Phase-A and Phase-B Wh or VARh values according to the metering equation specified in the I/O RAM control field EQU[2:0] (I/O RAM 0x2106[7:5]). WxSUM_X (x = 0 or 1, CE RAM 0x85 and 0x86) is the Wh value accumulated for phase x in the last accumulation interval and can be computed based on the specified LSB value. 5.3.8.2 Instantaneous Energy Measurement Variables IxSQSUM_X and VxSQSUM (see Table 87) are the sum of the squared current and voltage samples acquired during the last accumulation interval. Table 87: CE Energy Measurement Variables (with Local Sensors) CE Address Name 0x8C I0SQSUM_X 0x8D I1SQSUM_X 0x90 V0SQSUM_X V1SQSUM_X 0x91 Configuration Description The sum of squared current samples from each element. -13 2 2 LSB = 9.4045*10 IMAX A h -13 2 2 For ce41a04, LSB = 6.6952*10 IMAX A h. When EQU = 1, I0SQSUM_X is based on IA and IB. The sum of squared voltage samples from each element. -13 2 2 LSB = 9.4045*10 VMAX V h -13 2 2 For ce41a04, LSB = 6.6952*10^ VMAX V h. Figure 35 (page 93) Figure 37 (page 95) 71M6542 only. Table 88: CE Energy Measurement Variables (with Remote Sensor) CE Address Name 0x8C I0SQSUM_X 0x8D I1SQSUM_X 0x90 V0SQSUM_X V1SQSUM_X 0x91 Description Configuration The sum of squared current samples from each element. -12 2 2 LSBI = 2.55872*10 * IMAX A h When EQU = 1, I0SQSUM_X is based on IA and IB. The sum of squared voltage samples from each element. -13 2 2 LSBV= 9.40448*10 * VMAX V h Figure 36 (page 94) Figure 38 (page 96) 71M6542 only. The RMS values can be computed by the MPU from the squared current and voltage samples as follows: Ix RMS = IxSQSUM LSBI 3600 FS N ACC VxRMS = VxSQSUM LSBV 3600 FS N ACC Note: NACC = SUM_SAMPS[12:0] (CE RAM 0x23). Other Transfer variables include those available for frequency and phase measurement, and those reflecting the count of the zero-crossings of the mains voltage and the battery voltage. These transfer variables are listed in Table 89. MAINEDGE_X (CE RAM 0x83) reflects the number of half-cycles accounted for in the last accumulated interval for the AC signal of the phase specified in the FREQSEL[1:0] field in CECONFIG (CE RAM 0x20[7:6]). MAINEDGE_X is useful for implementing a real-time clock based on the input AC signal. 132 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 89: Other Transfer Variables CE Address Name Description 2520.6 Hz 0.509 10- 6 Hz(for Local) 232 2520.6 Hz LSB 0.587 10- 6 Hz(for Remote) 232 The number of edge crossings of the selected voltage in the previous accumulation interval. Edge crossings are either direction and are de-bounced. Fundamental frequency: LSB 0x82 FREQ_X 0x83 MAINEDGE_X 5.3.9 Pulse Generation Table 90 describes the CE pulse generation parameters. The combination of the CECONFIG PULSE_SLOW and PULSE_FAST bits (CE RAM 0x20[0:1]) controls the speed of the pulse rate. The default values of 0 and 0 maintain the original pulse rate given by the Kh equation. WRATE (CE RAM 0x21) controls the number of pulses that are generated per measured Wh and VARh quantities. The lower WRATE is, the slower the pulse rate for the measured energy quantity. The metering constant Kh is derived from WRATE as the amount of energy measured for each pulse. That is, if Kh = 1Wh/pulse, a power applied to the meter of 120 V and 30 A results in one pulse per second. If the load is 240 V at 150 A, ten pulses per second are generated. Control is transferred to the MPU for pulse generation if EXT_PULSE = 1 (CE RAM 0x20[5]). In this case, the pulse rate is determined by APULSEW and APULSER (CE RAM 0x45 and 0x49). The MPU has to load the source for pulse generation in APULSEW and APULSER to generate pulses. Irrespective of the EXT_PULSE status, the output pulse rate controlled by APULSEW and APULSER is implemented by the CE only. By setting EXT_PULSE = 1, the MPU is providing the source for pulse generation. If EXT_PULSE is 0, W0SUM_X (CE RAM 0x85) and VAR0SUM_X (CE RAM 0x89) are the default pulse generation sources. In this case, creep cannot be controlled since it is an MPU function. The maximum pulse rate is 3*FS = 7.56 kHz. See 2.3.6.2 VPULSE and WPULSE for details on how to adjust the timing of the output pulses. The maximum time jitter is 1/6 of the multiplexer cycle period (nominally 67 s) and is independent of the number of pulses measured. Thus, if the pulse generator is monitored for one second, the peak jitter is 67 ppm. After 10 seconds, the peak jitter is 6.7 ppm. The average jitter is always zero. If it is attempted to drive either pulse generator faster than its maximum rate, it simply outputs at its maximum rate without exhibiting any rollover characteristics. The actual pulse rate, using WSUM as an example, is: RATE = WRATE WSUM FS X Hz , 2 46 where FS = sampling frequency (2520.6 Hz), X = Pulse speed factor derived from the CE variables PULSE_SLOW (CE RAM 0x20[0]) and PULSE_FAST (CE RAM 0x20[1]). Rev 5 133 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Table 90: CE Pulse Generation Parameters CE Address Name Default Description Kh = 0x21 WRATE 547 0x22 0x23 KVAR SUM_SAMPS 6444 2520 0x45 APULSEW 0 0x46 WPULSE_CTR 0 0x47 WPULSE_FRAC 0 0x48 0x49 0x4A WSUM_ACCUM APULSER VPULSE_CTR 0 0 0 0x4B VPULSE_FRAC 0 0x4C VSUM_ACCUM 0 134 VMAX IMAX K Wh / pulse WRATE N ACC X where: K = 66.1782 (Local Sensors) K = 109.1587 (Remote Sensor) K = 47.1132 (ce41a04 and Local Sensors) NACC = SUM_SAMPS[12:0] (CE RAM 0x23) See Table 83 for the definition of X. The default value yields 1.0 Wh/pulse for VMAX = 600 V and 15 IMAX = 208 A. The maximum value for WRATE is 32,768 (2 ). Scale factor for VAR measurement. SUM_SAMPS (NACC). Wh pulse (WPULSE) generator input to be updated by the MPU when using external pulse generation. The output pulse rate is: -32 -14 APULSEW * FS * 2 * WRATE * X * 2 . This input is buffered and can be updated by the MPU during a conversion interval. The change takes effect at the beginning of the next interval. WPULSE counter. Unsigned numerator, containing a fraction of a pulse. The value in this register always counts up towards the next pulse. Roll-over accumulator for WPULSE. VARh (VPULSE) pulse generator input. VPULSE counter. Unsigned numerator, containing a fraction of a pulse. The value in this register always counts up towards the next pulse. Roll-over accumulator for VPULSE. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3.10 Other CE Parameters Table 91 shows the CE parameters used for suppression of noise due to scaling and truncation effects. Table 91: CE Parameters for Noise Suppression and Code Version CE Address Name Default Description QUANT_VA 0x25 0 QUANT_IA 0x26 0 Compensation factors for truncation and noise in voltage, current, real energy and reactive energy for phase A. QUANT_A 0x27 0 QUANT_VARA 0x28 0 QUANT_VB 0x29 0 Compensation factors for truncation and noise in voltage, current, QUANT_IB 0x2A 0 real energy and reactive energy for phase B. QUANT_B 0x2B 0 71M6542 only. QUANT_VARB 0x2C 0 0x38 0x43453431 CE file name identifier in ASCII format (CE41a01f). These values 0x39 0x6130316B are overwritten as soon as the CE starts 0x3A 0x00000000 LSB weights for use with Local Sensors: QUANT _ Ix _ LSB = 5.08656 10 -13 IMAX 2 ( Amps 2 ) For ce41a04, QUANT_Ix_LSB = 3.6212*10-13 * IMAX2 (Amps2) QUANT _ Wx _ LSB = 1.04173 10 -9 VMAX IMAX (Watts ) For ce41a04, QUANT_Wx_LSB = 7.4162*10-10 * VMAX * IMAX (Watts) QUANT _ VARx _ LSB = 1.04173 10 -9 VMAX IMAX (Vars ) For ce41a04, QUANT_VARx_LSB = 7.4162 * 10-10 * VMAX * IMAX (Vars) LSB weights for use with the 71M6x01 isolated sensors: QUANT _ Ix _ LSB = 1.38392 10-12 IMAX 2 ( Amps 2 ) QUANT _ Wx _ LSB = 1.71829 10-9 VMAX IMAX (Watts) QUANT _ VARx _ LSB = 1.71829 10-9 VMAX IMAX (Vars) Rev 5 135 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3.11 CE Calibration Parameters Table 92 lists the parameters that are typically entered to effect calibration of meter accuracy. Table 92: CE Calibration Parameters CE Address Name Default Description 0x10 0x11 0x13 0x14 CAL_IA CAL_VA CAL_IB CAL_VB 16384 16384 16384 16384 0x12 PHADJ_A 0 These constants control the gain of their respective channels. The 14 nominal value for each parameter is 2 = 16384. The gain of each channel is directly proportional to its CAL parameter. Thus, if the gain of a channel is 1% slow, CAL should be increased by 1%. Refer to the 71M6541 Demo Board User's Manual for the equations to calculate these calibration parameters. 71M6542 only. These constants control the CT phase compensation. Compensation does not occur when PHADJ_X = 0. As PHADJ_X is increased, more compensation (lag) is introduced. The range is 215 - 1. If it is desired to delay the current by the angle , the equations are: PHADJ _ X = 2 20 0x15 PHADJ_B 0 0.02229 TAN at 60Hz 0.1487 - 0.0131 TAN 0.0155 TAN at 50Hz 0.1241 - 0.009695 TAN The shunt delay compensation is obtained using the equation provided below: 2f 2f + 2ab cos a 2 cos 2 f 2 s fs LYAJ _ X = deg rees (1 + 0.1 deg rees )214 360 2f PHADJ _ X = 2 20 0x12 DLYADJ_A 0 + b c sin fs where: a = 2A b = A2 + 1 0x15 DLYADJ_B 0 2 +2 = 22 + 4 Where, f is the mains frequency and fs is the sampling frequency. The table below provides the value of A for each current channel: Value of A (decimal) Channel Eq. 0 or 2 Eq. 1 14 14 DLYADJ_A 15811 / 2 6811 / 2 14 14 DLYADJ_B -1384 / 2 -1384 / 2 136 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 5.3.12 CE Flow Diagrams Figure 44 through Figure 46 show the data flow through the CE in simplified form. Functions not shown include delay compensation, sag detection, scaling and the processing of meter equations. Figure 44: CE Data Flow: Multiplexer and ADC Figure 45: CE Data Flow: Scaling, Gain Control, Intermediate Variables Rev 5 137 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet SUM W0 W1 VAR0 VAR1 W0SUM_X MPU W1SUM_X VAR0SUM_X VAR1SUM_X SUM_SAMPS=2520 SQUARE I0 SUM I0SQ I2 V0SQ V0 V2 I1 I2 I1SQ I0SQSUM_X V0SQSUM_X I1SQSUM_X F0 Figure 46: CE Data Flow: Squaring and Summation Stages 138 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6 Electrical Specifications This section provides the electrical specifications for the 71M654x. Please refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for the 71M6x01 electrical specifications, pin-out, and package mechanical data. The devices are 100% production tested at room temperature, and performance over the full temperature range is guaranteed by design. 6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 93 shows the absolute maximum ratings for the device. Stresses beyond Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only and functional operation at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under recommended operating conditions (see 6.3 Recommended Operating Conditions) is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. All voltages are with respect to GNDA. Table 93: Absolute Maximum Ratings Voltage and Current Supplies and Ground Pins V3P3SYS, V3P3A VBAT, VBAT_RTC GNDD Analog Output Pins -0.5 V to 4.6 V -0.5 V to 4.6 V -0.1 V to +0.1 V -10 mA to +10 mA, -0.5 V to V3P3A+0.5 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 to 3.0 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 V to 4.6 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 V to 6 V VREF VDD V3P3D VLCD Analog Input Pins IAP-IAN, VA, IBP-IBN, VB only) ( 71M6542F/G XIN, XOUT -10 mA to +10 mA -0.5 V to V3P3A+0.5 V -10 mA to +10 mA -0.5 V to 3.0 V SEG and SEGDIO Pins Configured as SEG or COM drivers Configured as Digital Inputs Configured as Digital Outputs -1 mA to 1 mA, -0.5 V to VLCD+0.5 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 V to 6 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 V to V3P3D+0.5 V Digital Pins Inputs (PB, RESET, RX, ICE_E, TEST) Outputs (TX) Rev 5 -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 to 6 V -10 mA to 10 mA, -0.5 V to V3P3D+0.5 V 139 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Temperature and ESD Stress Operating junction temperature (peak, 100ms) Operating junction temperature (continuous) Storage temperature Solder temperature - 10 second duration ESD stress on all pins 6.2 140 C 125 C -45 C to +165 C +250 C 4 kV Recommended External Components Table 94: Recommended External Components Name From To C1 C2 CSYS CVDD V3P3A V3P3D V3P3SYS VDD GNDA GNDD GNDD GNDD CVLCD VLCD GNDD XTAL XIN XOUT CXS XIN GNDA CXL XOUT GNDA 6.3 Function Bypass capacitor for 3.3 V supply Bypass capacitor for 3.3 V output Bypass capacitor for V3P3SYS Bypass capacitor for VDD Bypass capacitor for VLCD pin (when charge pump is used) 32.768 kHz crystal - electrically similar to ECS .327-12.5-17X, Vishay XT26T or Suntsu SCP6-32.768kHz TR (load capacitance 12.5 pF). Load capacitor values for crystal depend on crystal specifications and board parasitics. Nominal values are based on 4 pF board capacitance and include an allowance for chip capacitance. Value Unit 0.1 20% 0.1 20% 1.0 30% 0.1 20% F F F F 0.1 20% F 32.768 kHz 15 10% pF 10 10% pF Recommended Operating Conditions Unless otherwise specified, all parameters listed in 6.4 Performance Specifications and 6.5 Timing Specifications are valid over the Recommended Operating Conditions provided in Table 95 below. Table 95: Recommended Operating Conditions Parameter V3P3SYS and V3P3A Supply Voltage for precision metering operation (MSN mode). Voltages at VBAT and VBAT_RTC need not be present. VBAT Voltage (BRN mode). V3P3SYS is below the 2.8 V comparator threshold. Either V3P3SYS or VBAT_RTC must be high enough to power the RTC module. Condition Min VBAT=0 V to 3.8 V VBAT_RTC =0 V to 3.8 V V3P3SYS < 2.8 V and Max (VBAT_RTC, V3P3SYS) > 2.0 V VBAT_RTC Voltage. VBAT_RTC is not needed to support the RTC and nonV3P3SYS<2.0 V volatile memory unless V3P3SYS < 2.0 V Operating Temperature Notes: 1. GNDA and GNDD must be connected together. 2. V3P3SYS and V3P3A must be connected together. 140 Typ Max Unit 3.0 3.6 V 2.5 3.8 V 2.0 3.8 V -40 +85 C Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4 Performance Specifications 6.4.1 Input Logic Levels Table 96: Input Logic Levels Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Unit 1 Digital high-level input voltage , VIH 2 1 Digital low-level input voltage , VIL 0.8 Input pullup current, IIL E_RXTX, E_RST, E_TCLK VIN=0 V, 10 100 OPT_RX, OPT_TX ICE_E=3.3 V 10 100 SPI_CSZ (SEGDIO36) 10 10 Other digital inputs -1 0 1 Input pull down current, IIH VIN=V3P3D ICE_E, RESET, TEST 10 100 Other digital inputs -1 0 1 Note: 1. In battery powered modes, digital inputs should be below 0.1 V or above VBAT - 0.1 V to minimize battery current. 6.4.2 V V A A A A A Output Logic Levels Table 97: Output Logic Levels Parameter Digital high-level output voltage VOH Digital low-level output voltage VOL Condition ILOAD = 1 mA ILOAD = 15 mA (see notes 1, 2) ILOAD = 1 mA ILOAD = 15 mA (see note 1) Min V3P3D-0.4 V3P3D-0.6 0 0 Typ Max Unit V V 0.4 0.8 V V Note: 1. Guaranteed by design, not production tested. 2. Caution: The sum of all pull up currents must be compatible with the on-resistance of the internal V3P3D switch. See 6.4.6 V3P3D Switch on page 144. Rev 5 141 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.3 Battery Monitor Table 98: Battery Monitor Performance Specifications (TEMP_BAT= 1) Parameter BV: Battery Voltage (definition) Measurement Error BV 100 - 1 VBAT Input impedance in continuous measurement, MSN mode. V(VBAT_RTC)/I(VBAT_RTC) Load applied with BCURR IBAT(BCURR=1) - IBAT(BCURR=0) 6.4.4 Condition Min Typ Max Unit = 3.3 + ( - 142) 0.0246 + 297 MSN mode, TEMP_PWR = 1 V = 3.291 + ( - 142) 0.0255 + 328 BRN mode, TEMP_PWR=TEMP_BSEL VBAT = 2.0 V 2.5 V 3.0 V 4.0 V -7.5 -5 -3 -3 V3P3 = 3.3 V, TEMP_BSEL = 0, TEMP_PER = 111, VBAT_RTC = 3.6 V, 7.5 5 3 5 1 M 50 V3P3 = 3.3 V % 100 140 A Temperature Monitor Table 99. Temperature Monitor Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Unit In MSN, TEMP_PWR=1: Temperature Measurement Equation Temperature Error VBAT_RTC charge per measurement Temp = 0.325 STEMP + 22 = 0.325 + 0.00218 2 - 0.609 + 64.4 TA=+22C TEMP_BSEL = 0, TEMP_PWR=0, SLP Mode, VBAT_RTC = 3.6 V TEMP_PWR = 0, Duration of temperature TEMP_PER = 7, measurement after setting SLP Mode, TEMP_START VBAT_RTC = 3.6 V (see note 1) Force V3P3D = 1.0 V Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. 142 C In BRN, TEMP_PWR = TEMP_BSEL: -2 +2 16 15 C C 60 ms Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.5 Supply Current The supply currents provided in Table 100 below include only the current consumed by the 71M654x. Refer to the 71M6xxx Data Sheet for additional current required when using a 71M6x01 remote sensor. Table 100: Supply Current Performance Specifications Parameter Condition I1: V3P3A + V3P3SYS current, Half-Speed (ADC_DIV=1) (see note 1) Single-phase: 2 Currents, 1 Voltage V3P3A = V3P3SYS = 3.3 V, MPU_DIV [2:0]= 3 (614 kHz MPU clock), No Flash memory write, RTM_E=0, PRE_E=0, CE_E=1, ADC_E=1, ADC_DIV=1, MUX_DIV[3:0]=3, FIR_LEN[1:0]=1, PLL_FAST=1 I1a: V3P3A + V3P3SYS current, Half-Speed (ADC_DIV=1) (see note 1) I1b: V3P3A + V3P3SYS current, Half-Speed (ADC_DIV=1) (see note 1) I1c: V3P3A + V3P3SYS current, Half-Speed (ADC_DIV=1) (see note 1) I2: V3P3A + V3P3SYS dynamic current Min Typ Max Unit 5.5 6.7 mA 2.6 3.5 mA Same as I1, except PRE_E = 1 5.7 6.9 mA Same as I1, except PLL_FAST = 0 and PRE_E = 1 2.6 3.6 mA 0.4 0.6 mA/ MHz 0 2.4 0.4 24 3.0 1.1 0 300 3.2 108 36 11 3.4 +300 nA mA nA A A A nA 0 240 1.8 0.7 1.5 300 320 4.1 1.7 3.2 nA nA A A A 7.1 8.7 mA Same as I1, except PLL_FAST=0 Same as I1, except with variation of MPU_DIV[2:0]. I MPU_DIV = 0 - I MPU_DIV = 3 4.3 VBAT current I3: MSN Mode I4: BRN Mode I5: LCD Mode (ext. VLCD) Note 1 I6: LCD Mode (boost, DAC) Note 1 I7: LCD Mode (DAC) Note 1 I8: LCD Mode (VBAT) I9: SLP Mode -300 CE_E=0 LCD_VMODE[1:0]=3, also see note 2 LCD_VMODE[1:0]=2, also see note 3 LCD_VMODE[1:0]=1, also see note 3 LCD_VMODE[1:0]=0, also see note 3 SLP Mode -300 VBAT_RTC current I10: MSN I11: BRN I12: LCD Mode I13: SLP Mode I14: SLP Mode (see note 1) I15: V3P3A + V3P3SYS current, Write Flash with ICE -300 LCD_VMODE[1:0]=2, also see note 2 TA 25 C TA = 85 C Same as I1, except write Flash at maximum rate, CE_E=0, ADC_E=0. Notes: 1. 2. 3. Rev 5 Guaranteed by design; not production tested. LCD_DAC[4:0]=5 (2.9V), LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6, all LCD_MAPn bits = 1, LCD_BLANK=0, LCD_ON=1. LCD_DAC[4:0]=5 (2.9V), LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6, all LCD_MAPn bits = 0. 143 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.6 V3P3D Switch Table 101: V3P3D Switch Performance Specifications Parameter Condition On resistance - V3P3SYS to V3P3D On resistance - VBAT to V3P3D | IV3P3D | 1 mA | IV3P3D | 1 mA, VBAT>2.5V V3P3SYS = 3V V3P3D = 2.9V VBAT = 2.6V V3P3D = 2.5V V3P3D IOH, MSN V3P3D IOH, BRN 6.4.7 Min Typ Max Unit 10 10 10 mA 10 mA Internal Power Fault Comparators Table 102. Internal Power Fault Comparator Specifications Parameter Condition Overall response time 100mV overdrive, falling 100mV overdrive, rising Falling Threshold 3.0 V Comparator 2.8 V Comparator Difference 3.0V and 2.8V Comparators Falling Threshold 2.25 V Comparator 2.0 V Comparator VDD (@VBAT=3.0V) - 2.25V Comparator Difference 2.25V and 2.0V Comparators Hysteresis, (Rising Threshold - Falling Threshold) 3.0 V Comparator 2.8 V Comparator 2.25 V Comparator 2.0 V Comparator 6.4.8 Min Typ 20 Max Unit 200 200 s s V3P3 falling 2.83 2.75 50 2.93 2.81 136 3.03 2.87 220 V V mV 2.2 1.90 0.25 0.15 2.25 2.00 0.35 0.25 2.5 2.20 0.45 0.35 V V V V 22 25 10 10 45 42 33 28 65 60 60 60 mV mV mV mV VDD falling TA = 22 C 2.5 V Voltage Regulator - System Power Table 103: 2.5 V Voltage Regulator Performance Specifications Parameter V2P5 V2P5 load regulation Voltage overhead V3P3SYS-V2P5 144 Condition V3P3 = 3.0 V - 3.8 V ILOAD = 0 mA VBAT = 3.3 V , V3P3 = 0 V ILOAD = 0 mA to 1 mA ILOAD = 5 mA, Reduce V3P3D until V2P5 drops 200 mV Min Typ Max Unit 2.55 2.65 2.75 V 40 mV 440 mV Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.9 2.5 V Voltage Regulator - Battery Power Unless otherwise specified, V3P3SYS = V3P3A = 0, PB=GND (BRN). Table 104: Low-Power Voltage Regulator Performance Specifications Parameter Condition VBAT = 3.0 V - 3.8 V, V3P3 = 0 V, ILOAD = 0 mA VBAT = 3.3 V, V3P3 = 0 V, ILOAD = 0 mA to 1 mA ILOAD = 0ma, VBAT = 2.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V. V2P5 V2P5 load regulation Voltage Overhead 2V - VBAT-VDD Min Typ Max Unit 2.55 2.65 2.75 V 40 mV 200 mV 6.4.10 Crystal Oscillator Measurement conditions: Crystal disconnected, test load of 200 pF/100 k between XOUT and GNDD. Table 105: Crystal Oscillator Performance Specifications Parameter Condition Maximum Output Power to Crystal XIN to XOUT Capacitance (see note 1) Crystal connected, see note 1 Capacitance change on XOUT Min RTCA_ADJ = 7F to 0, Bias voltage = unbiased Vpp = 0.1 V Typ Max Unit 1 W 3 pF 15 pF Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. 6.4.11 Phase-Locked Loop (PLL) Table 106: PLL Performance Specifications Parameter PLL Power up Settling Time (see note 1) PLL_FAST settling time PLL_FAST rise (see note 1) PLL_FAST fall (see note 1) PLL SLP to MSN Settling Time (see note 2) PLL power up overshoot (see note 1) Condition PLL_FAST = 0, V3P3 = 0 V to 3.3 V step, measured from first edge of MCK V3P3 = 0 V, VBAT = 3.8 V to 2.0 V Min Typ Max Unit 5 ms 5 5 ms ms PLL_FAST = 0 5 ms PLL_FAST = 0 2.5 MHz Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. Rev 5 145 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.12 LCD Drivers Table 107: LCD Driver Performance Specifications Parameter VLCD Current (see Notes 1 to 4) Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 146 Condition Min Typ VLCD=3.3, all LCD map bits=0 VLCD=5.0, all LCD map bits=0 Max 2 3 Unit uA uA These specifications apply to all COM and SEG pins. VLCD = 2.5 V to 5 V. LCD_VMODE=3, LCD_ON=1, LCD_BLANK=0, LCD_MODE=6, LCD_CLK=2. Output load is 74 pF per SEG and COM pin. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.13 VLCD Generator Table 108: LCD Driver Performance Specifications Parameter Condition VSYS to VLCD switch impedance VBAT to VLCD switch impedance LCD Boost Frequency VLCD IOH current (VLCD(0)-VLCD(IOH)<0.25) V3P3 = 3.3 V, RVLCD=removed, LCD_BAT=0, LCD_VMODE[1:0]=0, ILCD=10 A V3P3 = 0 V, VBAT = 2.5 V, RVLCD =removed, LCD_BAT =1, LCD_VMODE[1:0]=0, ILCD=10 A LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, RVLCD = removed, CVLCD = removed PLL_FAST=1 PLL_FAST=0 LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, LCD_CLK[1:0] = 2, RVLCD = removed, V3P3 = 3.3V, LCD_DAC[4:0] = 1F Min 1 Typ Max Unit 750 700 820 786 kHz kHz 10 A From LCDADJ0 and LCDADJ12 fuses: 12 - 0 _ 12 _ (_) = 2.65 + 2.65 + (_) 31 The above equations describe the nominal value of VLCD for a specific LCD_DAC value. The specifications below list the maximum deviation between actual VLCD and VLCDnom. Note that when VCC and boost are insufficient, the LCD DAC will not reach its target value and a large negative error will occur. (_) = 5 0 + LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom (see note 2) Full Scale, with Boost V3P3 =3.6 V V3P3 =3.0 V VBAT=4.0 V, V3P3=0, BRN Mode VBAT=2.5 V, V3P3=0, BRN Mode LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom DAC=12, with Boost V3P3 = 3.6 V V3P3 = 3.0 V VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom Zero Scale, with Boost V3P3 = 3.6 V V3P3 = 3.0 V VBAT = 4.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode (see note 2) VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom Full Scale, no Boost V3P3 = 3.6 V (see note 2) V3P3 = 3.0 V (see note 2) VBAT = 4.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode Rev 5 LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, LCD_DAC[4:0] = 1F, LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, LCD_DAC[4:0] = C, LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, LCD_DAC[4:0] =0, LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 1, LCD_DAC[4:0] = 1F, LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 -0.15 -0.4 -0.15 -1.3 0.15 0.15 0.15 V V V V -0.15 -0.15 -0.15 0.15 0.15 0.15 V V V -0.15 -0.15 -0.15 0.15 0.15 0.15 V V V -0.15 0.15 V -2.1 -2.8 -1.8 -3.2 V V V V 147 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Parameter Condition Min Typ Max Unit LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 1, LCD_DAC[4:0] = C, DAC=12, no Boost LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, -0.5 V V3P3 = 3.6 V LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 -1.1 V V3P3 = 3.0 V 2 2 -0.15 0.15 V VBAT = 4.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode 2 -1.5 V VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 1, LCD_DAC[4:0] = 0, Zero Scale, no Boost LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, -0.15 0.15 V V3P3 = 3.6 V LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 -0.15 0.15 V V3P3 = 3.0 V -0.15 0.15 V VBAT = 4.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode -0.45 0.15 V VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V, BRN Mode LCD_DAC Error. VLCD-VLCDnom LCD_VMODE[1:0] = 2, LCD_DAC[4:0] = 1F, Full Scale, with Boost, LCD mode LCD_CLK[1:0]=2, -0.15 0.15 V VBAT = 4.0 V, V3P3 = 0 V LCD_MODE[2:0]=6 -1.3 V VBAT = 2.5 V, V3P3 = 0 V Notes: 1. The following test conditions also apply to all parameters provided in this table: bypass capacitor CVLCD 0.1 F, test load RVLCD = 500 k, no display, all SEGDIO pins configured as DIO. 2. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. 148 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.14 VREF Table 109 shows the performance specifications for the ADC reference voltage (VREF). Table 109: VREF Performance Specifications Parameter VREF output voltage, VREF(22) VREF output voltage, VREF(22) Condition TA = 22 C VREF power supply sensitivity VREF / V3P3A V3P3A = 3.0 to 3.6 V VNOM definition (see note 2) VNOM temperature coefficients: TC1 = TC2 = Max Unit 1.193 1.195 1.197 V 1.195 VREF_CAL = 1, ILOAD = 10 A, -10 A VREF chop step, trimmed Typ PLL_FAST=0 VREF output impedance VREF input impedance Min VREF_DIS = 1, VREF = 1.3 V to 1.7 V VREF(CHOP=01) - VREF(CHOP=10) -1.5 V 3.2 k 1.5 mV/V k 100 -10 0 10 VNOM (T ) = VREF (22) + (T - 22)TC1 + (T - 22) 2 TC 2 275 - 4.95 TRIMT mV V V/C 2 V/C -0.557 - 0.00028 TRIMT VREF(T) deviation from VNOM(T) (see note 1): VREF (T ) - VNOM (T ) 106 VNOM (T ) 62 VREF aging -40 +40 25 ppm/C ppm/ year Notes: 1. 2. 3. Rev 5 Guaranteed by design; not production tested. This relationship describes the nominal behavior of VREF at different temperatures, as governed by a st nd second order polynomial of 1 and 2 order coefficients TC1 and TC2. For the parameters in this table, unless otherwise specified, VREF_DIS = 0, PLL_FAST=1. 149 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.4.15 ADC Converter Table 110. ADC Converter Performance Specifications Parameter Condition Recommended Input Range (Vin - V3P3A) Voltage to Current Crosstalk 6 10 *Vcrosstalk cos(Vin - Vcrosstalk ) Vin (see note 1) Input Impedance, no pre-amp ADC Gain Error vs %Power Supply Variation 10 6 Nout PK 357nV / VIN 100 V 3P3 A / 3.3 Input Offset IADC0=IADC1=V3P3A IADC0=V3P3A THD @ 250mVpk Name FIR_LEN A B C D E F G H J ADC_DIV 0 1 0 1 2 0 0 1 2 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PLL_FAST 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 MUX_DIV 3 2 11 6 4 2 6 3 2 FIR_LEN A B C D E F G H J ADC_DIV 0 1 0 1 2 0 0 1 2 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PLL_FAST 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 MUX_DIV 3 2 11 6 4 2 6 3 2 Typ Max Unit -250 250 mV peak -10 10 V/V 40 90 k 50 ppm / % 10 10 mV mV Vin=200 mV pk, 65 Hz V3P3A=3.0 V, 3.6 V DIFF0_E=1, PRE_E=0 DIFF0_E=0, PRE_E=0 THD @ 20mVpk Name Vin = 200 mV peak, 65 Hz, on VADC10 (VA) or VADC9 (VB) 71M6542F/G only. Vcrosstalk = largest measurement on IAP-IAN or IBP-IBN Vin=65 Hz Min VIN = 65Hz, 250mVpk, 64kpts FFT, Blackman Harris Window. VIN = 65Hz, 20mVpk, 64kpts FFT, Blackman Harris Window. -10 -10 A B C D E F G H J -82 -84 -83 -86 A B C D E F G H J -75 -75 -75 -75 -75 -75 -75 -75 -75 dB A B C D E F G H J -85 -91 -85 -91 -93 -85 -85 -91 -93 dB A B C D E F G H J 3470 406 3040 357 151 3470 3040 357 151 nV LSB Size: Name A B C D E F G H J FIR_LEN ADC_DIV 0 1 0 1 2 0 0 1 2 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PLL_FAST 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 MUX_DIV 3 2 11 6 4 2 6 3 2 Digital Full-Scale: Name A B C D E F G H J 150 FIR_LEN 0 1 0 1 2 0 0 1 2 ADC_DIV 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PLL_FAST 0 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 MUX_DIV 3 2 11 6 4 2 6 3 2 Vin=65Hz, 20mVpk, 64kpts FFT, BlackmanHarris window A: 91125 B: 778688 C: 103823 D: 884736 E: 2097152 F: 91125 G: 103823 H: 884736 J: 2097152 LSB Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. 2. Unless stated otherwise, the following test conditions apply to all the parameters provided in this table: FIR_LEN[1:0]=1, VREF_DIS=0, PLL_FAST=1, ADC_DIV=0, MUX_DIV=6, LSB values do not include the 9-bit left shift at CE input. 6.4.16 Pre-Amplifier for IAP-IAN Table 111: Pre-Amplifier Performance Specifications PARAMETER Differential Gain Vin=30mV differential Vin=15mV differential (see note 1) Gain Variation vs V3P3 Vin=30mV differential (see note 1) Gain Variation vs Temp Vin=30mV differential (see note 1) Phase Shift, Vin=30mV differential (see note 1) Preamp input current IADC0 IADC1 Preamp+ADC THD Vin=30mV differential Vin=15mV differential CONDITION TA= +25C, V3P3=3.3 V, PRE_E=1, FIR_LEN=2, DIFF0_E=1, 2520Hz sample rate V3P3 = 2.97 V, 3.63 V TA = -40C, 85C TA=25C, V3P3=3.3 V PRE_E=1, FIR_LEN=2, DIFF0_E=1 2520Hz sample rate, IADC0=IADC1=V3P3 TA=25C, V3P3=3.3 V, PRE_E=1, FIR_LEN=2, DIFF0_E=1, 2520Hz sample rate. TA=25C, V3P3=3.3 V, PRE_E=1, FIR_LEN=2, DIFF0_E=1, 2520Hz sample rate Preamp Offset IADC0=IADC1=V3P3+30mV IADC0=IADC1= V3P3+15mV IADC0=IADC1= V3P3 IADC0=IADC1= V3P3-15mV IADC0=IADC1= V3P3-30mV Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. Rev 5 MIN TYP MAX UNIT 7.8 7.8 7.92 7.92 8.0 8.0 V/V V/V 100 ppm/% -80 ppm/C 6 m 16 16 uA uA -100 10 -25 -6 4 4 9 9 -82 -86 dB dB -0.63 -0.57 -0.56 -0.56 -0.55 mV mV mV mV mV 151 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.5 Timing Specifications 6.5.1 Flash Memory Table 112: Flash Memory Timing Specifications Parameter Condition Flash write cycles Flash data retention -40 C to +85 C 25 C 85 C Min Typ Max 20,000 100 10 Cycles Years Flash byte writes between page or mass erase operations Write Time per Byte Page Erase (1024 bytes) Mass Erase 6.5.2 Unit 2 Cycles 21 21 21 s ms Ms SPI Slave Table 113. SPI Slave Timing Specifications Parameter SPI Setup Time SPI Hold Time SPI Output Delay SPI Recovery Time SPI Removal Time SPI Clock High SPI Clock Low SPI Clock Freq SPI Transaction Space 6.5.3 Condition SPI_DI to SPI_CK rise SPI_CK rise to SPI_DI SPI_CK fall to SPI_D0 SPI_CSZ fall to SPI_CK SPI_CK to SPI_CSZ rise SPI Freq/MPU Freq SPI_CSZ rise to SPI_CSZ fall Min 10 10 Typ Max 40 10 15 40 40 2.0 4.5 Unit ns ns ns ns ns ns ns MHz/MHz MPU Cycles EEPROM Interface Table 114: EEPROM Interface Timing Parameter Condition 2 Write Clock frequency (I C) Write Clock frequency (3-wire) 152 CKMPU = 4.9 MHz, Using interrupts CKMPU = 4.9 MHz, bit-banging DIO2/3 PLL_FAST = 0 CKMPU = 4.9 MHz PLL_FAST = 0 PLL_FAST = 1 Min Typ Max Unit 310 kHz 100 kHz 160 500 kHz Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.5.4 RESET Pin Table 115: RESET Pin Timing Parameter Condition Reset pulse width Reset pulse fall time (see note 1) Notes: 1. Guaranteed by design; not production tested. 6.5.5 Min Typ Max Unit 1 s s 5 RTC Table 116: RTC Range for Date Parameter Range for date Rev 5 Condition Min Typ Max Unit 2000 - 2255 Year 153 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.6 Package Outline Drawings 6.6.1 64-Pin LQFP Outline Package Drawing 11.7 12.3 11.7 + 12.3 PIN No. 1 Indicator 9.8 10.2 0.50 Typ. 0.60 Typ. 0.00 0.20 0.14 0.28 1.40 1.60 Figure 47: 64-pin LQFP Package Outline 154 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.6.2 100-Pin LQFP Package Outline Drawing Controlling dimensions are in mm. 15.7(0.618) 16.3(0.641) 1 15.7(0.618) 16.3(0.641) Top View 14.000 +/- 0.200 MAX. 1.600 1.50 +/- 0.10 0.225 +/- 0.045 0.50 TYP. 0.10 +/- 0.10 0.60 TYP> Side View Figure 48: 100-pin LQFP Package Outline Rev 5 155 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Package Markings 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 71M6541DIGT.428AB 104224TH 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 71M6542G-IGT 110124TK 445AP 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 6.7 Figure 49. Package Markings (Examples) Figure 49 provides an example of the package markings for the 64-pin and 100-pin packages. Package markings comprise three lines of text and are as described in Table 117 and Table 118 below. Table 117. 71M6541 Package Markings Line No. Markings Description 1 71M6541D- 2 IGT.428AB Part number (`IGT' wraps to the next line) Refer to Table 122. The five characters to the right of the dot (i.e., 428AB) are the lot code. 3 104224TH The first four digits to the left are the year and week of manufacture as YYWW. In this example, the date code is 1042 which represents year 2010, week 42. The last four characters (i.e., 24TH) are reserved for Maxim internal use only. Table 118. 71M6542 Package Markings Line No. Markings 1 71M6542G-IGT 2 110124TK Description Part number. Refer to Table 122. The first four digits to the left are the year and week of manufacture as YYWW. In this example, the date code is 1101 which represents year 2011, week 1. The last four characters (i.e., 24TK) are reserved for Maxim internal use only. 3 156 445AP A five character lot code. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Pinout Diagrams 6.8.1 71M6541D/F/G LQFP-64 Package Pinout 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 SPI_CKI/SEGDIO39 SEGDIO44 SEGDIO45 TMUX2OUT/SEG46 TMUXOUT/SEG47 RESET PB VLCD VREF IAP IAN V3P3A VA TEST GNDA XOUT 6.8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 71M6541D 71M6541F 71M6541G 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 XIN VBAT_RTC VBAT V3P3SYS IBP IBN GNDD V3P3D VDD ICE_E E_RXTX/SEG48 E_TCLK/SEG49 E_RST/SEG50 RX TX OPT_TX/SEGDIO51 SEGDIO14 SEGDIO13 SEGDIO12 SEGDIO11 SEGDIO10 SEGDIO9 SEGDIO8/DI SEGDIO7/YPULSE SEGDIO6/XPULSE SEGDIO5 SEGDIO4 SEGDIO3/SDATA SEGDIO2/SDCK SEGDIO1/VPULSE SEGDIO0/WPULSE OPT_RX/SEGDIO55 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 SPI_DI/SEGDIO38 SPI_DO/SEGDIO37 SPI_CSZ/SEGDIO36 COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 SEGDIO27/COM4 SEGDIO26/COM5 SEGDIO25 SEGDIO24 SEGDIO23 SEGDIO22 SEGDIO21 SEGDIO20 SEGDIO19 Figure 50: Pinout for the 71M6541D/F/G (LQFP-64 Package) Rev 5 157 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 71M6542F/G LQFP-100 Package Pinout 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 SPI_CKI/SEGDIO39 SEGDIO40 SEGDIO41 SEGDIO42 SEGDIO43 SEGDIO44 SEGDIO45 TMUX2OUT/SEG46 TMUXOUT/SEG47 RESET PB VLCD VREF IAP IAN V3P3A NC VB VA TEST GNDA NC NC NC XOUT 6.8.2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 71M6542F 71M6542G 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 XIN NC NC GNDA VBAT_RTC VBAT V3P3SYS IBP IBN NC NC NC NC GNDD V3P3D VDD ICE_E E_RXTX/SEG48 E_TCLK/SEG49 E_RST/SEG50 RX TX OPT_TX/SEGDIO51 SEGDIO52 SEGDIO53 NC SEGDIO17 SEGDIO16 SEGDIO15 SEGDIO14 SEGDIO13 SEGDIO12 SEGDIO11 SEGDIO10 SEGDIO9 SEGDIO8/DI SEGDIO7/YPULSE SEGDIO6/XPULSE SEGDIO5 NC SEGDIO4 SEGDIO3/SDATA SEGDIO2/SDCK SEGDIO1/VPULSE SEGDIO0/WPULSE OPT_RX/SEGDIO55 SEGDIO54 NC NC NC 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 SPI_DI/SEGDIO38 SPI_DO/SEGDIO37 SPI_CSZ/SEGDIO36 SEGDIO35 SEGDIO34 SEGDIO33 SEGDIO32 SEGDIO31 SEGDIO30 SEGDIO29 SEGDIO28 COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 SEGDIO27/COM4 SEGDIO26/COM5 SEGDIO25 SEGDIO24 SEGDIO23 SEGDIO22 SEGDIO21 SEGDIO20 SEGDIO19 SEGDIO18 Figure 51: Pinout for the 71M6542F/G (LQFP-100 Package) 158 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.9 Pin Descriptions 6.9.1 Power and Ground Pins Pin types: P = Power, O = Output, I = Input, I/O = Input/Output. The circuit number denotes the equivalent circuit, as specified under 6.9.4 I/O Equivalent Circuits. . Table 119: Power and Ground Pins Pin Pin (64 pin) (100-pin) 50 Name Type Circuit 72, 80 GNDA P - 42 62 GNDD P - 53 85 V3P3A P - 45 69 V3P3SYS P - 41 61 V3P3D O 13 40 60 VDD O - 57 89 VLCD O - 46 70 VBAT P 12 47 71 VBAT_RTC P 12 Rev 5 Description Analog ground: This pin should be connected directly to the ground plane. Digital ground: This pin should be connected directly to the ground plane. Analog power supply: A 3.3 V power supply should be connected to this pin. V3P3A must be the same voltage as V3P3SYS. System 3.3 V supply. This pin should be connected to a 3.3 V power supply. Auxiliary voltage output of the chip. In mission mode, this pin is connected to V3P3SYS by the internal selection switch. In BRN mode, it is internally connected to VBAT. V3P3D is floating in LCD and sleep mode. A 0.1 F bypass capacitor to ground must be connected to this pin. The output of the 2.5V regulator. This pin is powered in MSN and BRN modes. A 0.1 F bypass capacitor to ground should be connected to this pin. The output of the LCD DAC. A 0.1 F bypass capacitor to ground should be connected to this pin. Battery backup pin to support the battery modes (BRN, LCD). A battery or super-capacitor is to be connected between VBAT and GNDD. If no battery is used, connect VBAT to V3P3SYS. RTC and oscillator power supply. A battery or supercapacitor is to be connected between VBAT and GNDD. If no battery is used, connect VBAT_RTC to V3P3SYS. 159 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.9.2 Analog Pins Table 120: Analog Pins Pin Pin (64 pin) (100-pin) Name 55 54 87 86 IAPIAN 44 43 68 67 IBPIBN 52 -- 82 83 56 48 49 Type Circuit I 6 VA VB I 6 88 VREF O 9 75 76 XIN XOUT I O 8 Description Differential or single-ended Line Current Sense Inputs: These pins are voltage inputs to the internal A/D converter. Typically, they are connected to the outputs of current sensors. Unused pins must be tied to V3P3A. Pins IBP-IBN may be configured for communication with the remote sensor interface (71M6x01). When RMT_E = 1 (I/O RAM 0x2709[3]), the IBP-IBN pins become balanced differential pair. If unused, RMT_E must be zero and IBP-IBN must tied to V3P3A. Line Voltage Sense Inputs: These pins are voltage inputs to the internal A/D converter. Typically, they are connected to the outputs of resistor dividers. Unused pins must be tied to V3P3A. Voltage Reference for the ADC. This pin should be left unconnected (floating). Crystal Inputs: A 32 kHz crystal should be connected across these pins. Typically, a 15 pF capacitor is also connected from XIN to GNDA and a 10 pF capacitor is connected from XOUT to GNDA. It is important to minimize the capacitance between these pins. See the crystal manufacturer datasheet for details. If an external clock is used, a 150 mV (p-p) clock signal should be applied to XIN, and XOUT should be left unconnected. Pin VB only available on 71M6542F/G. 160 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.9.3 Digital Pins Table 121 lists the digital pins. Pin types: P = Power, O = Output, I = Input, I/O = Input/Output, N/C = no connect. The circuit number denotes the equivalent circuit, as specified in 6.9.4 I/O Equivalent Circuits. Table 121: Digital Pins Pin (64-pin) Pin (100-pin) Name Type Circuit 4-7 12-15 COM0-COM3 O 5 31 45 SEGDIO0/WPULSE 30 44 SEGDIO1/VPULSE 29 43 SEGDIO2/SDCK 28 42 SEGDIO3/SDATA 27 41 SEGDIO4 26 39 SEGDIO5 25 38 SEGDIO6/XPULSE 24 37 SEGDIO7/YPULSE 23 36 SEGDIO8/DI 22-17 35-30 SEGDIO[9:14] -- 29-27 SEGDIO[15:17] -- 25 SEGDIO[18] 16-10 24-18 SEGDIO[19:25] -- 11-4 SEGDIO[28:35] 63-62 95-94 SEGDIO[44:45] -- 99-96 SEGDIO[40:43] -- 52 SEGDIO52 -- 51 SEGDIO53 -- 47 SEGDIO54 9 17 SEGDIO26/COM5 8 16 SEGDIO27/COM4 3 3 SPI_CSZ/SEGDIO36 2 2 SPI_DO/SEGDIO37 1 1 SPI_DI/SEGDIO38 64 100 SPI_CKI/SEGDIO39 33 53 OPT_TX/SEGDIO51 32 46 OPT_RX/SEGDIO55 38 36 37 58 56 57 E_RXTX/SEG48 E_RST/SEG50 E_TCLK/SEG49 Rev 5 I/O 3, 4, 5 Function LCD Common Outputs. These four pins provide the select signals for the LCD display. Multiple-Use Pins. Configurable as either LCD segment driver or DIO. Alternative functions with proper selection of associated I/O RAM registers are: SEGDIO0 = WPULSE SEGDIO1 = VPULSE SEGDIO2 = SDCK SEGDIO3 = SDATA SEGDIO6 = XPULSE SEGDIO7 = YPULSE SEGDIO8 = DI Unused pins must be configured as outputs or terminated to V3P3/GNDD. I/O 3, 4, 5 Multiple-Use Pins. Configurable as either LCD segment driver or DIO with alternative function (LCD common drivers). I/O 3, 4, 5 Multiple-Use Pins. Configurable as either LCD segment driver or DIO with alternative function (SPI interface). I/O 3, 4, 5 Multiple-Use Pins, configurable as either LCD segment driver or DIO with alternative function (optical port/UART1) I/O 1, 4, 5 O 4, 5 Multiuse Pins. Configurable as either emulator port pins (when ICE_E pulled high) or LCD segment drivers (when ICE_E tied to GND). 161 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Pin (64-pin) Pin (100-pin) Name 39 59 ICE_E 60 92 TMUXOUT/SEG47 61 93 TMUX2OUT/SEG46 Type Circuit I 2 ICE Enable. When zero, E_RST, E_TCLK, and E_RXTX become SEG50, SEG49, and SEG48 respectively. For production units, this pin should be pulled to GND to disable the emulator port. O 4, 5 Multiple-Use Pins. Configurable as either multiplexer/clock output or LCD segment driver using the I/O RAM registers. 59 91 RESET I 2 35 55 RX I 3 34 54 TX O 4 51 81 TEST I 7 58 90 PB I 3 -- 26, 40, 48, 49, 50, 63, 64, 65, 66, 73, 74, 77, 78, 79, 84 NC N/C -- 162 Function Chip Reset. This input pin is used to reset the chip into a known state. For normal operation, this pin is pulled low. To reset the chip, this pin should be pulled high. This pin has an internal 30 A (nominal) current source pulldown. No external reset circuitry is necessary. UART0 Input. If this pin is unused it must be terminated to V3P3D or GNDD. UART0 Output Enables Production Test. This pin must be grounded in normal operation. Pushbutton Input. This pin must be at GNDD when not active or unused. A rising edge sets the WF_PB flag. It also causes the part to wake up if it is in SLP or LCD mode. PB does not have an internal pullup or pulldown resistor. No Connection. Do not connect this pin. Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 6.9.4 I/O Equivalent Circuits V3P3D V3P3A V3P3D 110K Digital Input Pin from internal reference LCD SEG Output Pin LCD Driver CMOS Input VREF Pin GNDD GNDA GNDD LCD Output Equivalent Circuit Type 5: LCD SEG or pin configured as LCD SEG Digital Input Equivalent Circuit Type 1: Standard Digital Input or pin configured as DIO Input with Internal Pull-Up VREF Equivalent Circuit Type 9: VREF V3P3A V3P3D V3P3D Digital Input Pin CMOS Input Analog Input Pin GNDD GNDD Analog Input Equivalent Circuit Type 6 : ADC Input Digital Input Type 2: Pin configured as DIO Input with Internal Pull-Down V3P3D V2P5 Equivalent Circuit Type 10: V2P5 V3P3A Comparator Input Pin To Comparator VLCD Pin LCD Drivers GNDA Digital Input Pin V2P5 Pin GNDA 110K GNDD from internal reference To MUX CMOS Input GNDD Comparator Input Equivalent Circuit Type 7: Comparator Input VLCD Equivalent Circuit Type 11: VLCD Power GNDD Digital Input Type 3: Standard Digital Input or pin configured as DIO Input Oscillator Pin To Oscillator Power Down Circuits VBAT Pin GNDD V3P3D Oscillator Equivalent Circuit Type 8: Oscillator I/O V3P3D Digital Output Pin CMOS Output GNDD from V3P3SYS V3P3D Pin GNDD GNDD Digital Output Equivalent Circuit Type 4: Standard Digital Output or pin configured as DIO Output 10 VBAT Equivalent Circuit Type 12: VBAT Power from VBAT 10 V3P3D Equivalent Circuit Type 13: V3P3D Figure 52: I/O Equivalent Circuits Rev 5 163 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet 7 Ordering Information 7.1 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Table 122. Ordering Information Part Part Description (Package, Typical Accuracy) 71M6541D 64-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6541D 64-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6541F 64-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6541F 64-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6541G 71M6542F 64-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 100-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6542F 100-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6542G 100-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 71M6542G 100-pin LQFP Lead-Free, 0.1% 8 Flash Size Packaging 32 KB bulk tape and 32 KB reel 64 KB bulk tape and 64 KB reel 128 KB bulk 64 KB bulk tape and reel 128 KB bulk tape and 128 KB reel 64 KB Order Number Package Marking 71M6541D-IGT/F 71M6541D-IGT 71M6541D-IGTR/F 71M6541D-IGT 71M6541F-IGT/F 71M6541F-IGT 71M6541F-IGTR/F 71M6541F-IGT 71M6541G-IGT/F 71M6542F-IGT/F 71M6541G-IGT 71M6542F-IGT 71M6542F-IGTR/F 71M6542F-IGT 71M6542G-IGT/F 71M6542G-IGT 71M6542G-IGTR/F 71M6542G-IGT Related Information Users need these additional documents related to the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G: * * * * 9 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet (this document) 71M6xxx Data Sheet 71M6541 Demo Board User's Manual 71M654x Software User's Guide Contact Information For more information about Maxim products or to check the availability of the 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G, contact technical support at www.maximintegrated.com/support. 164 Rev 5 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Appendix A: Acronyms AFE AMR ANSI CE DIO DSP FIR 2 IC ICE IEC MPU PLL RMS SFR SOC SPI TOU UART Rev 5 Analog Front End Automatic Meter Reading American National Standards Institute Compute Engine Digital I /O Digital Signal Processor Finite Impulse Response Inter-IC Bus In-Circuit Emulator International Electrotechnical Commission Microprocessor Unit (CPU) Phase-locked loop Root Mean Square Special Function Register System on Chip Serial Peripheral Interface Time of Use Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 165 71M6541D/F/G and 71M6542F/G Data Sheet Appendix B: Revision History REVISION NUMBER 1.0 REVISION DATE 3/11 1.1 4/11 2 11/11 3 10/13 4 3/14 5 1/15 DESCRIPTION Initial release Removed the information about 18mW typ consumption at 3.3V in sleep mode from the Features section Updated the Temperature Measurement Equation and Temperature Error parameters in Table 99 Promoted 71M6542G to production level (Table 122) Added references to 71M6541G/2G throughout the document, as appropriate. Added missing data sheet title header to odd and even pages. Corrected errata detected since the previous v1.1 (see indicated pages changed). Added section 6.7 on page 156. Added warning note on SPI Flash Mode section, added page numbers and footers for the document, updated IEN0 Bit Function and External MPU Interrupts table, changed CECONFIG bit 23 to reserved, corrected SPI Slave port diagram (Figure 27), added 010 and 011 combination on the RCMD[4:0] Bits table, updated the text description of the Signal Input Pins section, combined columns 3 and 4 of Table 34, updated the Interrupt Structure diagram, changed FLSHPG to PGADR on Table 12, included additional LSBs for ce41a04 (Table 85, Table 87, Table 90, and Table 91), corrected the OPT_TXE active definition, updated the required CE code and settings notes about MUX_DIV[3:0] Removed future status from 71M6541G and removed 71M6541G-IGTR/F in the Ordering Information table (Table 122) Updated the Benefits and Features section PAGES CHANGED -- 1 141 1, 9, 10, 27, 49, 54, 56, 62, 97, 120 All 164 1 Maxim Integrated cannot assume responsibility for use of any circuitry other than circuitry entirely embodied in a Maxim Integrated product. No circuit patent licenses are implied. Maxim Integrated reserves the right to change the circuitry and specifications without notice at any time. The parametric values (min and max limits) shown in the Electrical Characteristics table are guaranteed. Other parametric values quoted in this data sheet are provided for guidance. 166 (c) 2015 Maxim Integrated Products, Inc. Maxim Integrated and the Maxim Integrated logo are trademarks of Maxim Integrated Products, Inc.